1 //===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===// 2 // 3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4 // 5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7 // 8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9 // 10 // This file implements semantic analysis for expressions. 11 // 12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13 14 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 15 #include "TreeTransform.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h" 28 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h" 29 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 30 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 31 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 32 #include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h" 33 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" 34 #include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h" 35 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" 36 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" 37 #include "clang/Sema/Designator.h" 38 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 39 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 40 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" 41 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h" 42 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" 43 #include "clang/Sema/SemaFixItUtils.h" 44 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 45 #include "llvm/Support/ConvertUTF.h" 46 using namespace clang; 47 using namespace sema; 48 49 /// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, without 50 /// emitting diagnostics. 51 bool Sema::CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D) { 52 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing. 53 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) 54 return false; 55 56 // See if this is a deleted function. 57 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 58 if (FD->isDeleted()) 59 return false; 60 61 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it, 62 // then we can't use it either. 63 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 64 DeduceReturnType(FD, SourceLocation(), /*Diagnose*/ false)) 65 return false; 66 } 67 68 // See if this function is unavailable. 69 if (D->getAvailability() == AR_Unavailable && 70 cast<Decl>(CurContext)->getAvailability() != AR_Unavailable) 71 return false; 72 73 return true; 74 } 75 76 static void DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) { 77 // Warn if this is used but marked unused. 78 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) { 79 const Decl *DC = cast_or_null<Decl>(S.getCurObjCLexicalContext()); 80 if (DC && !DC->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 81 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName(); 82 } 83 } 84 85 static AvailabilityResult DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(Sema &S, 86 NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc, 87 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass, 88 bool ObjCPropertyAccess) { 89 // See if this declaration is unavailable or deprecated. 90 std::string Message; 91 92 // Forward class declarations get their attributes from their definition. 93 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) { 94 if (IDecl->getDefinition()) 95 D = IDecl->getDefinition(); 96 } 97 AvailabilityResult Result = D->getAvailability(&Message); 98 if (const EnumConstantDecl *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D)) 99 if (Result == AR_Available) { 100 const DeclContext *DC = ECD->getDeclContext(); 101 if (const EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(DC)) 102 Result = TheEnumDecl->getAvailability(&Message); 103 } 104 105 const ObjCPropertyDecl *ObjCPDecl = nullptr; 106 if (Result == AR_Deprecated || Result == AR_Unavailable) { 107 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) { 108 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = MD->findPropertyDecl()) { 109 AvailabilityResult PDeclResult = PD->getAvailability(nullptr); 110 if (PDeclResult == Result) 111 ObjCPDecl = PD; 112 } 113 } 114 } 115 116 switch (Result) { 117 case AR_Available: 118 case AR_NotYetIntroduced: 119 break; 120 121 case AR_Deprecated: 122 if (S.getCurContextAvailability() != AR_Deprecated) 123 S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Deprecation, 124 D, Message, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl, 125 ObjCPropertyAccess); 126 break; 127 128 case AR_Unavailable: 129 if (S.getCurContextAvailability() != AR_Unavailable) 130 S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Unavailable, 131 D, Message, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl, 132 ObjCPropertyAccess); 133 break; 134 135 } 136 return Result; 137 } 138 139 /// \brief Emit a note explaining that this function is deleted. 140 void Sema::NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl *Decl) { 141 assert(Decl->isDeleted()); 142 143 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl); 144 145 if (Method && Method->isDeleted() && Method->isDefaulted()) { 146 // If the method was explicitly defaulted, point at that declaration. 147 if (!Method->isImplicit()) 148 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_implicitly_deleted); 149 150 // Try to diagnose why this special member function was implicitly 151 // deleted. This might fail, if that reason no longer applies. 152 CXXSpecialMember CSM = getSpecialMember(Method); 153 if (CSM != CXXInvalid) 154 ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Method, CSM, /*Diagnose=*/true); 155 156 return; 157 } 158 159 if (CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Decl)) { 160 if (CXXConstructorDecl *BaseCD = 161 const_cast<CXXConstructorDecl*>(CD->getInheritedConstructor())) { 162 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_inherited_deleted_here); 163 if (BaseCD->isDeleted()) { 164 NoteDeletedFunction(BaseCD); 165 } else { 166 // FIXME: An explanation of why exactly it can't be inherited 167 // would be nice. 168 Diag(BaseCD->getLocation(), diag::note_cannot_inherit); 169 } 170 return; 171 } 172 } 173 174 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_availability_specified_here) 175 << Decl << true; 176 } 177 178 /// \brief Determine whether a FunctionDecl was ever declared with an 179 /// explicit storage class. 180 static bool hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(const FunctionDecl *D) { 181 for (auto I : D->redecls()) { 182 if (I->getStorageClass() != SC_None) 183 return true; 184 } 185 return false; 186 } 187 188 /// \brief Check whether we're in an extern inline function and referring to a 189 /// variable or function with internal linkage (C11 6.7.4p3). 190 /// 191 /// This is only a warning because we used to silently accept this code, but 192 /// in many cases it will not behave correctly. This is not enabled in C++ mode 193 /// because the restriction language is a bit weaker (C++11 [basic.def.odr]p6) 194 /// and so while there may still be user mistakes, most of the time we can't 195 /// prove that there are errors. 196 static void diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(Sema &S, 197 const NamedDecl *D, 198 SourceLocation Loc) { 199 // This is disabled under C++; there are too many ways for this to fire in 200 // contexts where the warning is a false positive, or where it is technically 201 // correct but benign. 202 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 203 return; 204 205 // Check if this is an inlined function or method. 206 FunctionDecl *Current = S.getCurFunctionDecl(); 207 if (!Current) 208 return; 209 if (!Current->isInlined()) 210 return; 211 if (!Current->isExternallyVisible()) 212 return; 213 214 // Check if the decl has internal linkage. 215 if (D->getFormalLinkage() != InternalLinkage) 216 return; 217 218 // Downgrade from ExtWarn to Extension if 219 // (1) the supposedly external inline function is in the main file, 220 // and probably won't be included anywhere else. 221 // (2) the thing we're referencing is a pure function. 222 // (3) the thing we're referencing is another inline function. 223 // This last can give us false negatives, but it's better than warning on 224 // wrappers for simple C library functions. 225 const FunctionDecl *UsedFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 226 bool DowngradeWarning = S.getSourceManager().isInMainFile(Loc); 227 if (!DowngradeWarning && UsedFn) 228 DowngradeWarning = UsedFn->isInlined() || UsedFn->hasAttr<ConstAttr>(); 229 230 S.Diag(Loc, DowngradeWarning ? diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline_quiet 231 : diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline) 232 << /*IsVar=*/!UsedFn << D; 233 234 S.MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(Current); 235 236 S.Diag(D->getCanonicalDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 237 << D; 238 } 239 240 void Sema::MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl *Cur) { 241 const FunctionDecl *First = Cur->getFirstDecl(); 242 243 // Suggest "static" on the function, if possible. 244 if (!hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(First)) { 245 SourceLocation DeclBegin = First->getSourceRange().getBegin(); 246 Diag(DeclBegin, diag::note_convert_inline_to_static) 247 << Cur << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DeclBegin, "static "); 248 } 249 } 250 251 /// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and 252 /// emit any corresponding diagnostics. 253 /// 254 /// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing 255 /// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example, 256 /// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being 257 /// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted 258 /// function is being used. 259 /// 260 /// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be 261 /// referenced), false otherwise. 262 /// 263 bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc, 264 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass, 265 bool ObjCPropertyAccess) { 266 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 267 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction, 268 // emit them now. 269 SuppressedDiagnosticsMap::iterator 270 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl()); 271 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) { 272 SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second; 273 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I) 274 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second); 275 276 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit 277 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't obsolete this 278 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these 279 // diagnostics again. 280 Suppressed.clear(); 281 } 282 283 // C++ [basic.start.main]p3: 284 // The function 'main' shall not be used within a program. 285 if (cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isMain()) 286 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_main_used); 287 } 288 289 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing. 290 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) { 291 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer) 292 << D->getDeclName(); 293 return true; 294 } 295 296 // See if this is a deleted function. 297 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 298 if (FD->isDeleted()) { 299 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use); 300 NoteDeletedFunction(FD); 301 return true; 302 } 303 304 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it, 305 // then we can't use it either. 306 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 307 DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc)) 308 return true; 309 } 310 DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(*this, D, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPropertyAccess); 311 312 DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(*this, D, Loc); 313 314 diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(*this, D, Loc); 315 316 return false; 317 } 318 319 /// \brief Retrieve the message suffix that should be added to a 320 /// diagnostic complaining about the given function being deleted or 321 /// unavailable. 322 std::string Sema::getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 323 std::string Message; 324 if (FD->getAvailability(&Message)) 325 return ": " + Message; 326 327 return std::string(); 328 } 329 330 /// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks whether a call or 331 /// message-send is to a declaration with the sentinel attribute, and 332 /// if so, it checks that the requirements of the sentinel are 333 /// satisfied. 334 void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc, 335 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 336 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>(); 337 if (!attr) 338 return; 339 340 // The number of formal parameters of the declaration. 341 unsigned numFormalParams; 342 343 // The kind of declaration. This is also an index into a %select in 344 // the diagnostic. 345 enum CalleeType { CT_Function, CT_Method, CT_Block } calleeType; 346 347 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) { 348 numFormalParams = MD->param_size(); 349 calleeType = CT_Method; 350 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 351 numFormalParams = FD->param_size(); 352 calleeType = CT_Function; 353 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(D)) { 354 QualType type = cast<ValueDecl>(D)->getType(); 355 const FunctionType *fn = nullptr; 356 if (const PointerType *ptr = type->getAs<PointerType>()) { 357 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 358 if (!fn) return; 359 calleeType = CT_Function; 360 } else if (const BlockPointerType *ptr = type->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 361 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 362 calleeType = CT_Block; 363 } else { 364 return; 365 } 366 367 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(fn)) { 368 numFormalParams = proto->getNumParams(); 369 } else { 370 numFormalParams = 0; 371 } 372 } else { 373 return; 374 } 375 376 // "nullPos" is the number of formal parameters at the end which 377 // effectively count as part of the variadic arguments. This is 378 // useful if you would prefer to not have *any* formal parameters, 379 // but the language forces you to have at least one. 380 unsigned nullPos = attr->getNullPos(); 381 assert((nullPos == 0 || nullPos == 1) && "invalid null position on sentinel"); 382 numFormalParams = (nullPos > numFormalParams ? 0 : numFormalParams - nullPos); 383 384 // The number of arguments which should follow the sentinel. 385 unsigned numArgsAfterSentinel = attr->getSentinel(); 386 387 // If there aren't enough arguments for all the formal parameters, 388 // the sentinel, and the args after the sentinel, complain. 389 if (Args.size() < numFormalParams + numArgsAfterSentinel + 1) { 390 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName(); 391 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType); 392 return; 393 } 394 395 // Otherwise, find the sentinel expression. 396 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[Args.size() - numArgsAfterSentinel - 1]; 397 if (!sentinelExpr) return; 398 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return; 399 if (Context.isSentinelNullExpr(sentinelExpr)) return; 400 401 // Pick a reasonable string to insert. Optimistically use 'nil', 'nullptr', 402 // or 'NULL' if those are actually defined in the context. Only use 403 // 'nil' for ObjC methods, where it's much more likely that the 404 // variadic arguments form a list of object pointers. 405 SourceLocation MissingNilLoc 406 = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(sentinelExpr->getLocEnd()); 407 std::string NullValue; 408 if (calleeType == CT_Method && 409 PP.getIdentifierInfo("nil")->hasMacroDefinition()) 410 NullValue = "nil"; 411 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 412 NullValue = "nullptr"; 413 else if (PP.getIdentifierInfo("NULL")->hasMacroDefinition()) 414 NullValue = "NULL"; 415 else 416 NullValue = "(void*) 0"; 417 418 if (MissingNilLoc.isInvalid()) 419 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << int(calleeType); 420 else 421 Diag(MissingNilLoc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) 422 << int(calleeType) 423 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(MissingNilLoc, ", " + NullValue); 424 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType); 425 } 426 427 SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(Expr *E) const { 428 return E ? E->getSourceRange() : SourceRange(); 429 } 430 431 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 432 // Standard Promotions and Conversions 433 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 434 435 /// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4). 436 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *E) { 437 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here. 438 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 439 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 440 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 441 E = result.get(); 442 } 443 444 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 445 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type"); 446 447 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) { 448 // If we are here, we are not calling a function but taking 449 // its address (which is not allowed in OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3). 450 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 451 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_function_address); 452 return ExprError(); 453 } 454 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty), 455 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get(); 456 } else if (Ty->isArrayType()) { 457 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is 458 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has 459 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer 460 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression 461 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue" 462 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99). 463 // 464 // C++ 4.2p1: 465 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of 466 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T". 467 // 468 if (getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || E->isLValue()) 469 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty), 470 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 471 } 472 return E; 473 } 474 475 static void CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 476 // Check to see if we are dereferencing a null pointer. If so, 477 // and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the 478 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this 479 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This 480 // only handles the pattern "*null", which is a very syntactic check. 481 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 482 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref && 483 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()-> 484 isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) && 485 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) { 486 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO, 487 S.PDiag(diag::warn_indirection_through_null) 488 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange()); 489 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO, 490 S.PDiag(diag::note_indirection_through_null)); 491 } 492 } 493 494 static void DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(Sema &S, const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE, 495 SourceLocation AssignLoc, 496 const Expr* RHS) { 497 const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = OIRE->getDecl(); 498 if (!IV) 499 return; 500 501 DeclarationName MemberName = IV->getDeclName(); 502 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 503 if (!Member || !Member->isStr("isa")) 504 return; 505 506 const Expr *Base = OIRE->getBase(); 507 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 508 if (OIRE->isArrow()) 509 BaseType = BaseType->getPointeeType(); 510 if (const ObjCObjectType *OTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()) 511 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = OTy->getInterface()) { 512 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared = nullptr; 513 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared); 514 if (!ClassDeclared->getSuperClass() 515 && (*ClassDeclared->ivar_begin()) == IV) { 516 if (RHS) { 517 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = 518 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope, 519 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"), 520 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName); 521 if (ObjectSetClass) { 522 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS->getLocEnd()); 523 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) << 524 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") << 525 FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), 526 AssignLoc), ",") << 527 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")"); 528 } 529 else 530 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign); 531 } else { 532 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = 533 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope, 534 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"), 535 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName); 536 if (ObjectGetClass) 537 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) << 538 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") << 539 FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 540 SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), 541 OIRE->getLocEnd()), ")"); 542 else 543 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use); 544 } 545 S.Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_ivar_decl); 546 } 547 } 548 } 549 550 ExprResult Sema::DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *E) { 551 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here. 552 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 553 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 554 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 555 E = result.get(); 556 } 557 558 // C++ [conv.lval]p1: 559 // A glvalue of a non-function, non-array type T can be 560 // converted to a prvalue. 561 if (!E->isGLValue()) return E; 562 563 QualType T = E->getType(); 564 assert(!T.isNull() && "r-value conversion on typeless expression?"); 565 566 // We don't want to throw lvalue-to-rvalue casts on top of 567 // expressions of certain types in C++. 568 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 569 (E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy || 570 T->isDependentType() || 571 T->isRecordType())) 572 return E; 573 574 // The C standard is actually really unclear on this point, and 575 // DR106 tells us what the result should be but not why. It's 576 // generally best to say that void types just doesn't undergo 577 // lvalue-to-rvalue at all. Note that expressions of unqualified 578 // 'void' type are never l-values, but qualified void can be. 579 if (T->isVoidType()) 580 return E; 581 582 // OpenCL usually rejects direct accesses to values of 'half' type. 583 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp16 && 584 T->isHalfType()) { 585 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_half_load_store) 586 << 0 << T; 587 return ExprError(); 588 } 589 590 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, E); 591 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 592 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope, 593 &Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"), 594 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName); 595 if (ObjectGetClass) 596 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) << 597 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OISA->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") << 598 FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 599 SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OISA->getIsaMemberLoc()), ")"); 600 else 601 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use); 602 } 603 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE = 604 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 605 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, SourceLocation(), /* Expr*/nullptr); 606 607 // C++ [conv.lval]p1: 608 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the 609 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the 610 // rvalue is T. 611 // 612 // C99 6.3.2.1p2: 613 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified 614 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the 615 // type of the lvalue. 616 if (T.hasQualifiers()) 617 T = T.getUnqualifiedType(); 618 619 UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E); 620 621 // Loading a __weak object implicitly retains the value, so we need a cleanup to 622 // balance that. 623 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 624 E->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) 625 ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 626 627 ExprResult Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_LValueToRValue, E, 628 nullptr, VK_RValue); 629 630 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 631 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 632 // of the type of the lvalue ... 633 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = T->getAs<AtomicType>()) { 634 T = Atomic->getValueType().getUnqualifiedType(); 635 Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_AtomicToNonAtomic, Res.get(), 636 nullptr, VK_RValue); 637 } 638 639 return Res; 640 } 641 642 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *E) { 643 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E); 644 if (Res.isInvalid()) 645 return ExprError(); 646 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get()); 647 if (Res.isInvalid()) 648 return ExprError(); 649 return Res; 650 } 651 652 /// CallExprUnaryConversions - a special case of an unary conversion 653 /// performed on a function designator of a call expression. 654 ExprResult Sema::CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr *E) { 655 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 656 ExprResult Res = E; 657 // Only do implicit cast for a function type, but not for a pointer 658 // to function type. 659 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) { 660 Res = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty), 661 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get(); 662 if (Res.isInvalid()) 663 return ExprError(); 664 } 665 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get()); 666 if (Res.isInvalid()) 667 return ExprError(); 668 return Res.get(); 669 } 670 671 /// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most 672 /// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are 673 /// sometimes suppressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't 674 /// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators. 675 /// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called. 676 ExprResult Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *E) { 677 // First, convert to an r-value. 678 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E); 679 if (Res.isInvalid()) 680 return ExprError(); 681 E = Res.get(); 682 683 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 684 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type"); 685 686 // Half FP have to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported 687 if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) 688 return ImpCastExprToType(Res.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast); 689 690 // Try to perform integral promotions if the object has a theoretically 691 // promotable type. 692 if (Ty->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 693 // C99 6.3.1.1p2: 694 // 695 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or 696 // unsigned int may be used: 697 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer 698 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int 699 // and unsigned int. 700 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int. 701 // 702 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the 703 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an 704 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All 705 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions. 706 707 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(E); 708 if (!PTy.isNull()) { 709 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 710 return E; 711 } 712 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 713 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty); 714 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PT, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 715 return E; 716 } 717 } 718 return E; 719 } 720 721 /// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that 722 /// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float or __fp16 723 /// are promoted to double. All other argument types are converted by 724 /// UsualUnaryConversions(). 725 ExprResult Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *E) { 726 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 727 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type"); 728 729 ExprResult Res = UsualUnaryConversions(E); 730 if (Res.isInvalid()) 731 return ExprError(); 732 E = Res.get(); 733 734 // If this is a 'float' or '__fp16' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to 735 // double. 736 const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 737 if (BTy && (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half || 738 BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)) 739 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 740 741 // C++ performs lvalue-to-rvalue conversion as a default argument 742 // promotion, even on class types, but note: 743 // C++11 [conv.lval]p2: 744 // When an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion occurs in an unevaluated 745 // operand or a subexpression thereof the value contained in the 746 // referenced object is not accessed. Otherwise, if the glvalue 747 // has a class type, the conversion copy-initializes a temporary 748 // of type T from the glvalue and the result of the conversion 749 // is a prvalue for the temporary. 750 // FIXME: add some way to gate this entire thing for correctness in 751 // potentially potentially evaluated contexts. 752 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->isGLValue() && !isUnevaluatedContext()) { 753 ExprResult Temp = PerformCopyInitialization( 754 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(E->getType()), 755 E->getExprLoc(), E); 756 if (Temp.isInvalid()) 757 return ExprError(); 758 E = Temp.get(); 759 } 760 761 return E; 762 } 763 764 /// Determine the degree of POD-ness for an expression. 765 /// Incomplete types are considered POD, since this check can be performed 766 /// when we're in an unevaluated context. 767 Sema::VarArgKind Sema::isValidVarArgType(const QualType &Ty) { 768 if (Ty->isIncompleteType()) { 769 // C++11 [expr.call]p7: 770 // After these conversions, if the argument does not have arithmetic, 771 // enumeration, pointer, pointer to member, or class type, the program 772 // is ill-formed. 773 // 774 // Since we've already performed array-to-pointer and function-to-pointer 775 // decay, the only such type in C++ is cv void. This also handles 776 // initializer lists as variadic arguments. 777 if (Ty->isVoidType()) 778 return VAK_Invalid; 779 780 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 781 return VAK_Invalid; 782 return VAK_Valid; 783 } 784 785 if (Ty.isCXX98PODType(Context)) 786 return VAK_Valid; 787 788 // C++11 [expr.call]p7: 789 // Passing a potentially-evaluated argument of class type (Clause 9) 790 // having a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial move constructor, 791 // or a non-trivial destructor, with no corresponding parameter, 792 // is conditionally-supported with implementation-defined semantics. 793 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !Ty->isDependentType()) 794 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 795 if (!Record->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor() && 796 !Record->hasNonTrivialMoveConstructor() && 797 !Record->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) 798 return VAK_ValidInCXX11; 799 800 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && Ty->isObjCLifetimeType()) 801 return VAK_Valid; 802 803 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 804 return VAK_Invalid; 805 806 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 807 return VAK_MSVCUndefined; 808 809 // FIXME: In C++11, these cases are conditionally-supported, meaning we're 810 // permitted to reject them. We should consider doing so. 811 return VAK_Undefined; 812 } 813 814 void Sema::checkVariadicArgument(const Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT) { 815 // Don't allow one to pass an Objective-C interface to a vararg. 816 const QualType &Ty = E->getType(); 817 VarArgKind VAK = isValidVarArgType(Ty); 818 819 // Complain about passing non-POD types through varargs. 820 switch (VAK) { 821 case VAK_ValidInCXX11: 822 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 823 E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 824 PDiag(diag::warn_cxx98_compat_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) 825 << Ty << CT); 826 // Fall through. 827 case VAK_Valid: 828 if (Ty->isRecordType()) { 829 // This is unlikely to be what the user intended. If the class has a 830 // 'c_str' member function, the user probably meant to call that. 831 DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 832 PDiag(diag::warn_pass_class_arg_to_vararg) 833 << Ty << CT << hasCStrMethod(E) << ".c_str()"); 834 } 835 break; 836 837 case VAK_Undefined: 838 case VAK_MSVCUndefined: 839 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 840 E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 841 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) 842 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 << Ty << CT); 843 break; 844 845 case VAK_Invalid: 846 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 847 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 848 E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 849 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg) 850 << Ty << CT); 851 else 852 Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_cannot_pass_to_vararg) 853 << isa<InitListExpr>(E) << Ty << CT; 854 break; 855 } 856 } 857 858 /// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but 859 /// will create a trap if the resulting type is not a POD type. 860 ExprResult Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT, 861 FunctionDecl *FDecl) { 862 if (const BuiltinType *PlaceholderTy = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 863 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable. 864 if (PlaceholderTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 865 (CT == VariadicMethod || 866 (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>()))) { 867 E = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 868 869 // Otherwise, do normal placeholder checking. 870 } else { 871 ExprResult ExprRes = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 872 if (ExprRes.isInvalid()) 873 return ExprError(); 874 E = ExprRes.get(); 875 } 876 } 877 878 ExprResult ExprRes = DefaultArgumentPromotion(E); 879 if (ExprRes.isInvalid()) 880 return ExprError(); 881 E = ExprRes.get(); 882 883 // Diagnostics regarding non-POD argument types are 884 // emitted along with format string checking in Sema::CheckFunctionCall(). 885 if (isValidVarArgType(E->getType()) == VAK_Undefined) { 886 // Turn this into a trap. 887 CXXScopeSpec SS; 888 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc; 889 UnqualifiedId Name; 890 Name.setIdentifier(PP.getIdentifierInfo("__builtin_trap"), 891 E->getLocStart()); 892 ExprResult TrapFn = ActOnIdExpression(TUScope, SS, TemplateKWLoc, 893 Name, true, false); 894 if (TrapFn.isInvalid()) 895 return ExprError(); 896 897 ExprResult Call = ActOnCallExpr(TUScope, TrapFn.get(), 898 E->getLocStart(), None, 899 E->getLocEnd()); 900 if (Call.isInvalid()) 901 return ExprError(); 902 903 ExprResult Comma = ActOnBinOp(TUScope, E->getLocStart(), tok::comma, 904 Call.get(), E); 905 if (Comma.isInvalid()) 906 return ExprError(); 907 return Comma.get(); 908 } 909 910 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 911 RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), E->getType(), 912 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)) 913 return ExprError(); 914 915 return E; 916 } 917 918 /// \brief Converts an integer to complex float type. Helper function of 919 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 920 /// 921 /// \return false if the integer expression is an integer type and is 922 /// successfully converted to the complex type. 923 static bool handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &IntExpr, 924 ExprResult &ComplexExpr, 925 QualType IntTy, 926 QualType ComplexTy, 927 bool SkipCast) { 928 if (IntTy->isComplexType() || IntTy->isRealFloatingType()) return true; 929 if (SkipCast) return false; 930 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) { 931 QualType fpTy = cast<ComplexType>(ComplexTy)->getElementType(); 932 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), fpTy, CK_IntegralToFloating); 933 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy, 934 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 935 } else { 936 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType()); 937 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy, 938 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex); 939 } 940 return false; 941 } 942 943 /// \brief Handle arithmetic conversion with complex types. Helper function of 944 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 945 static QualType handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 946 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 947 QualType RHSType, 948 bool IsCompAssign) { 949 // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type. 950 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, 951 /*skipCast*/false)) 952 return LHSType; 953 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 954 /*skipCast*/IsCompAssign)) 955 return RHSType; 956 957 // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex. 958 // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the 959 // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds 960 // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands. 961 // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains. 962 // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real 963 // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's 964 // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example, 965 // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the 966 // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex". 967 968 // Compute the rank of the two types, regardless of whether they are complex. 969 int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 970 971 auto *LHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(LHSType); 972 auto *RHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(RHSType); 973 QualType LHSElementType = 974 LHSComplexType ? LHSComplexType->getElementType() : LHSType; 975 QualType RHSElementType = 976 RHSComplexType ? RHSComplexType->getElementType() : RHSType; 977 978 QualType ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(LHSElementType); 979 if (Order < 0) { 980 // Promote the precision of the LHS if not an assignment. 981 ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(RHSElementType); 982 if (!IsCompAssign) { 983 if (LHSComplexType) 984 LHS = 985 S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast); 986 else 987 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast); 988 } 989 } else if (Order > 0) { 990 // Promote the precision of the RHS. 991 if (RHSComplexType) 992 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast); 993 else 994 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast); 995 } 996 return ResultType; 997 } 998 999 /// \brief Hande arithmetic conversion from integer to float. Helper function 1000 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1001 static QualType handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &FloatExpr, 1002 ExprResult &IntExpr, 1003 QualType FloatTy, QualType IntTy, 1004 bool ConvertFloat, bool ConvertInt) { 1005 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) { 1006 if (ConvertInt) 1007 // Convert intExpr to the lhs floating point type. 1008 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), FloatTy, 1009 CK_IntegralToFloating); 1010 return FloatTy; 1011 } 1012 1013 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float. 1014 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType()); 1015 QualType result = S.Context.getComplexType(FloatTy); 1016 1017 // _Complex int -> _Complex float 1018 if (ConvertInt) 1019 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), result, 1020 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex); 1021 1022 // float -> _Complex float 1023 if (ConvertFloat) 1024 FloatExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(FloatExpr.get(), result, 1025 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 1026 1027 return result; 1028 } 1029 1030 /// \brief Handle arithmethic conversion with floating point types. Helper 1031 /// function of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1032 static QualType handleFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1033 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1034 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) { 1035 bool LHSFloat = LHSType->isRealFloatingType(); 1036 bool RHSFloat = RHSType->isRealFloatingType(); 1037 1038 // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand 1039 // to the bigger result. 1040 if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) { 1041 int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 1042 if (order > 0) { 1043 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_FloatingCast); 1044 return LHSType; 1045 } 1046 1047 assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison"); 1048 if (!IsCompAssign) 1049 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_FloatingCast); 1050 return RHSType; 1051 } 1052 1053 if (LHSFloat) 1054 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1055 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign, 1056 /*convertInt=*/ true); 1057 assert(RHSFloat); 1058 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, 1059 /*convertInt=*/ true, 1060 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign); 1061 } 1062 1063 typedef ExprResult PerformCastFn(Sema &S, Expr *operand, QualType toType); 1064 1065 namespace { 1066 /// These helper callbacks are placed in an anonymous namespace to 1067 /// permit their use as function template parameters. 1068 ExprResult doIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) { 1069 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, toType, CK_IntegralCast); 1070 } 1071 1072 ExprResult doComplexIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) { 1073 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, S.Context.getComplexType(toType), 1074 CK_IntegralComplexCast); 1075 } 1076 } 1077 1078 /// \brief Handle integer arithmetic conversions. Helper function of 1079 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 1080 template <PerformCastFn doLHSCast, PerformCastFn doRHSCast> 1081 static QualType handleIntegerConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1082 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1083 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) { 1084 // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8 1085 int order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 1086 bool LHSSigned = LHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 1087 bool RHSSigned = RHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 1088 if (LHSSigned == RHSSigned) { 1089 // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type 1090 if (order >= 0) { 1091 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1092 return LHSType; 1093 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1094 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1095 return RHSType; 1096 } else if (order != (LHSSigned ? 1 : -1)) { 1097 // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the 1098 // signed type, so use the unsigned type 1099 if (RHSSigned) { 1100 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1101 return LHSType; 1102 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1103 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1104 return RHSType; 1105 } else if (S.Context.getIntWidth(LHSType) != S.Context.getIntWidth(RHSType)) { 1106 // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that 1107 // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so 1108 // use the signed type. 1109 if (LHSSigned) { 1110 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1111 return LHSType; 1112 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1113 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1114 return RHSType; 1115 } else { 1116 // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type, 1117 // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long 1118 // on most 32-bit systems). Use the unsigned type corresponding 1119 // to the signed type. 1120 QualType result = 1121 S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(LHSSigned ? LHSType : RHSType); 1122 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), result); 1123 if (!IsCompAssign) 1124 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), result); 1125 return result; 1126 } 1127 } 1128 1129 /// \brief Handle conversions with GCC complex int extension. Helper function 1130 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1131 static QualType handleComplexIntConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1132 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1133 QualType RHSType, 1134 bool IsCompAssign) { 1135 const ComplexType *LHSComplexInt = LHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType(); 1136 const ComplexType *RHSComplexInt = RHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType(); 1137 1138 if (LHSComplexInt && RHSComplexInt) { 1139 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1140 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1141 QualType ScalarType = 1142 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast> 1143 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign); 1144 1145 return S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1146 } 1147 1148 if (LHSComplexInt) { 1149 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1150 QualType ScalarType = 1151 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 1152 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSType, IsCompAssign); 1153 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1154 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ComplexType, 1155 CK_IntegralRealToComplex); 1156 1157 return ComplexType; 1158 } 1159 1160 assert(RHSComplexInt); 1161 1162 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1163 QualType ScalarType = 1164 handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast> 1165 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign); 1166 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1167 1168 if (!IsCompAssign) 1169 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ComplexType, 1170 CK_IntegralRealToComplex); 1171 return ComplexType; 1172 } 1173 1174 /// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to 1175 /// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this 1176 /// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is 1177 /// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics. 1178 QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 1179 bool IsCompAssign) { 1180 if (!IsCompAssign) { 1181 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 1182 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 1183 return QualType(); 1184 } 1185 1186 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 1187 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 1188 return QualType(); 1189 1190 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 1191 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 1192 QualType LHSType = 1193 Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 1194 QualType RHSType = 1195 Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 1196 1197 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any atomic qualifier on the LHS. 1198 if (const AtomicType *AtomicLHS = LHSType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1199 LHSType = AtomicLHS->getValueType(); 1200 1201 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 1202 if (LHSType == RHSType) 1203 return LHSType; 1204 1205 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done. 1206 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int). 1207 if (!LHSType->isArithmeticType() || !RHSType->isArithmeticType()) 1208 return QualType(); 1209 1210 // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type. 1211 QualType LHSUnpromotedType = LHSType; 1212 if (LHSType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 1213 LHSType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSType); 1214 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get()); 1215 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull()) 1216 LHSType = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy; 1217 if (LHSType != LHSUnpromotedType && !IsCompAssign) 1218 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast); 1219 1220 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 1221 if (LHSType == RHSType) 1222 return LHSType; 1223 1224 // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types. 1225 1226 // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1). 1227 if (LHSType->isComplexType() || RHSType->isComplexType()) 1228 return handleComplexFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1229 IsCompAssign); 1230 1231 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double). 1232 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) 1233 return handleFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1234 IsCompAssign); 1235 1236 // Handle GCC complex int extension. 1237 if (LHSType->isComplexIntegerType() || RHSType->isComplexIntegerType()) 1238 return handleComplexIntConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1239 IsCompAssign); 1240 1241 // Finally, we have two differing integer types. 1242 return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 1243 (*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, IsCompAssign); 1244 } 1245 1246 1247 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1248 // Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types 1249 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1250 1251 1252 ExprResult 1253 Sema::ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, 1254 SourceLocation DefaultLoc, 1255 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 1256 Expr *ControllingExpr, 1257 ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes, 1258 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgExprs) { 1259 unsigned NumAssocs = ArgTypes.size(); 1260 assert(NumAssocs == ArgExprs.size()); 1261 1262 TypeSourceInfo **Types = new TypeSourceInfo*[NumAssocs]; 1263 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1264 if (ArgTypes[i]) 1265 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ArgTypes[i], &Types[i]); 1266 else 1267 Types[i] = nullptr; 1268 } 1269 1270 ExprResult ER = CreateGenericSelectionExpr(KeyLoc, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1271 ControllingExpr, 1272 llvm::makeArrayRef(Types, NumAssocs), 1273 ArgExprs); 1274 delete [] Types; 1275 return ER; 1276 } 1277 1278 ExprResult 1279 Sema::CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, 1280 SourceLocation DefaultLoc, 1281 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 1282 Expr *ControllingExpr, 1283 ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> Types, 1284 ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs) { 1285 unsigned NumAssocs = Types.size(); 1286 assert(NumAssocs == Exprs.size()); 1287 if (ControllingExpr->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 1288 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(ControllingExpr); 1289 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 1290 ControllingExpr = result.get(); 1291 } 1292 1293 // The controlling expression is an unevaluated operand, so side effects are 1294 // likely unintended. 1295 if (ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() && 1296 ControllingExpr->HasSideEffects(Context, false)) 1297 Diag(ControllingExpr->getExprLoc(), 1298 diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context); 1299 1300 bool TypeErrorFound = false, 1301 IsResultDependent = ControllingExpr->isTypeDependent(), 1302 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack 1303 = ControllingExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(); 1304 1305 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1306 if (Exprs[i]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) 1307 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true; 1308 1309 if (Types[i]) { 1310 if (Types[i]->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) 1311 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true; 1312 1313 if (Types[i]->getType()->isDependentType()) { 1314 IsResultDependent = true; 1315 } else { 1316 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The type name in a generic association shall specify a 1317 // complete object type other than a variably modified type." 1318 unsigned D = 0; 1319 if (Types[i]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) 1320 D = diag::err_assoc_type_incomplete; 1321 else if (!Types[i]->getType()->isObjectType()) 1322 D = diag::err_assoc_type_nonobject; 1323 else if (Types[i]->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) 1324 D = diag::err_assoc_type_variably_modified; 1325 1326 if (D != 0) { 1327 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), D) 1328 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1329 << Types[i]->getType(); 1330 TypeErrorFound = true; 1331 } 1332 1333 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "No two generic associations in the same generic 1334 // selection shall specify compatible types." 1335 for (unsigned j = i+1; j < NumAssocs; ++j) 1336 if (Types[j] && !Types[j]->getType()->isDependentType() && 1337 Context.typesAreCompatible(Types[i]->getType(), 1338 Types[j]->getType())) { 1339 Diag(Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1340 diag::err_assoc_compatible_types) 1341 << Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1342 << Types[j]->getType() 1343 << Types[i]->getType(); 1344 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1345 diag::note_compat_assoc) 1346 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1347 << Types[i]->getType(); 1348 TypeErrorFound = true; 1349 } 1350 } 1351 } 1352 } 1353 if (TypeErrorFound) 1354 return ExprError(); 1355 1356 // If we determined that the generic selection is result-dependent, don't 1357 // try to compute the result expression. 1358 if (IsResultDependent) 1359 return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr( 1360 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1361 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack); 1362 1363 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> CompatIndices; 1364 unsigned DefaultIndex = -1U; 1365 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1366 if (!Types[i]) 1367 DefaultIndex = i; 1368 else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(ControllingExpr->getType(), 1369 Types[i]->getType())) 1370 CompatIndices.push_back(i); 1371 } 1372 1373 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The controlling expression of a generic selection shall have 1374 // type compatible with at most one of the types named in its generic 1375 // association list." 1376 if (CompatIndices.size() > 1) { 1377 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically 1378 // parenthesized in macro definitions. 1379 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens(); 1380 Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_multi_match) 1381 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType() 1382 << (unsigned) CompatIndices.size(); 1383 for (SmallVectorImpl<unsigned>::iterator I = CompatIndices.begin(), 1384 E = CompatIndices.end(); I != E; ++I) { 1385 Diag(Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1386 diag::note_compat_assoc) 1387 << Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1388 << Types[*I]->getType(); 1389 } 1390 return ExprError(); 1391 } 1392 1393 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "If a generic selection has no default generic association, 1394 // its controlling expression shall have type compatible with exactly one of 1395 // the types named in its generic association list." 1396 if (DefaultIndex == -1U && CompatIndices.size() == 0) { 1397 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically 1398 // parenthesized in macro definitions. 1399 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens(); 1400 Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_no_match) 1401 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType(); 1402 return ExprError(); 1403 } 1404 1405 // C11 6.5.1.1p3 "If a generic selection has a generic association with a 1406 // type name that is compatible with the type of the controlling expression, 1407 // then the result expression of the generic selection is the expression 1408 // in that generic association. Otherwise, the result expression of the 1409 // generic selection is the expression in the default generic association." 1410 unsigned ResultIndex = 1411 CompatIndices.size() ? CompatIndices[0] : DefaultIndex; 1412 1413 return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr( 1414 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1415 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack, ResultIndex); 1416 } 1417 1418 /// getUDSuffixLoc - Create a SourceLocation for a ud-suffix, given the 1419 /// location of the token and the offset of the ud-suffix within it. 1420 static SourceLocation getUDSuffixLoc(Sema &S, SourceLocation TokLoc, 1421 unsigned Offset) { 1422 return Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(TokLoc, Offset, S.getSourceManager(), 1423 S.getLangOpts()); 1424 } 1425 1426 /// BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall - A user-defined literal was found. Look up 1427 /// the corresponding cooked (non-raw) literal operator, and build a call to it. 1428 static ExprResult BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(Sema &S, Scope *Scope, 1429 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix, 1430 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc, 1431 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 1432 SourceLocation LitEndLoc) { 1433 assert(Args.size() <= 2 && "too many arguments for literal operator"); 1434 1435 QualType ArgTy[2]; 1436 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 1437 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = Args[ArgIdx]->getType(); 1438 if (ArgTy[ArgIdx]->isArrayType()) 1439 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(ArgTy[ArgIdx]); 1440 } 1441 1442 DeclarationName OpName = 1443 S.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 1444 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 1445 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 1446 1447 LookupResult R(S, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 1448 if (S.LookupLiteralOperator(Scope, R, llvm::makeArrayRef(ArgTy, Args.size()), 1449 /*AllowRaw*/false, /*AllowTemplate*/false, 1450 /*AllowStringTemplate*/false) == Sema::LOLR_Error) 1451 return ExprError(); 1452 1453 return S.BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, LitEndLoc); 1454 } 1455 1456 /// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string 1457 /// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string 1458 /// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from 1459 /// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one 1460 /// string. 1461 /// 1462 ExprResult 1463 Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks, Scope *UDLScope) { 1464 assert(!StringToks.empty() && "Must have at least one string!"); 1465 1466 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, PP); 1467 if (Literal.hadError) 1468 return ExprError(); 1469 1470 SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs; 1471 for (unsigned i = 0; i != StringToks.size(); ++i) 1472 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation()); 1473 1474 QualType CharTy = Context.CharTy; 1475 StringLiteral::StringKind Kind = StringLiteral::Ascii; 1476 if (Literal.isWide()) { 1477 CharTy = Context.getWideCharType(); 1478 Kind = StringLiteral::Wide; 1479 } else if (Literal.isUTF8()) { 1480 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF8; 1481 } else if (Literal.isUTF16()) { 1482 CharTy = Context.Char16Ty; 1483 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF16; 1484 } else if (Literal.isUTF32()) { 1485 CharTy = Context.Char32Ty; 1486 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF32; 1487 } else if (Literal.isPascal()) { 1488 CharTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 1489 } 1490 1491 QualType CharTyConst = CharTy; 1492 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1). 1493 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || getLangOpts().ConstStrings) 1494 CharTyConst.addConst(); 1495 1496 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes 1497 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal 1498 // strings. 1499 QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(CharTyConst, 1500 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1), 1501 ArrayType::Normal, 0); 1502 1503 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: a string literal is in the constant address space. 1504 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 1505 StrTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(StrTy, LangAS::opencl_constant); 1506 } 1507 1508 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory! 1509 StringLiteral *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(), 1510 Kind, Literal.Pascal, StrTy, 1511 &StringTokLocs[0], 1512 StringTokLocs.size()); 1513 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty()) 1514 return Lit; 1515 1516 // We're building a user-defined literal. 1517 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 1518 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 1519 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, StringTokLocs[Literal.getUDSuffixToken()], 1520 Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 1521 1522 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 1523 if (!UDLScope) 1524 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_string_udl)); 1525 1526 // C++11 [lex.ext]p5: The literal L is treated as a call of the form 1527 // operator "" X (str, len) 1528 QualType SizeType = Context.getSizeType(); 1529 1530 DeclarationName OpName = 1531 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 1532 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 1533 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 1534 1535 QualType ArgTy[] = { 1536 Context.getArrayDecayedType(StrTy), SizeType 1537 }; 1538 1539 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1540 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, ArgTy, 1541 /*AllowRaw*/false, /*AllowTemplate*/false, 1542 /*AllowStringTemplate*/true)) { 1543 1544 case LOLR_Cooked: { 1545 llvm::APInt Len(Context.getIntWidth(SizeType), Literal.GetNumStringChars()); 1546 IntegerLiteral *LenArg = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Len, SizeType, 1547 StringTokLocs[0]); 1548 Expr *Args[] = { Lit, LenArg }; 1549 1550 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, StringTokLocs.back()); 1551 } 1552 1553 case LOLR_StringTemplate: { 1554 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs; 1555 1556 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(CharTy); 1557 bool CharIsUnsigned = CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 1558 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned); 1559 1560 TemplateArgument TypeArg(CharTy); 1561 TemplateArgumentLocInfo TypeArgInfo(Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharTy)); 1562 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(TypeArg, TypeArgInfo)); 1563 1564 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Lit->getLength(); I != N; ++I) { 1565 Value = Lit->getCodeUnit(I); 1566 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, CharTy); 1567 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo; 1568 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo)); 1569 } 1570 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, StringTokLocs.back(), 1571 &ExplicitArgs); 1572 } 1573 case LOLR_Raw: 1574 case LOLR_Template: 1575 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 1576 case LOLR_Error: 1577 return ExprError(); 1578 } 1579 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 1580 } 1581 1582 ExprResult 1583 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1584 SourceLocation Loc, 1585 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) { 1586 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc); 1587 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, SS); 1588 } 1589 1590 /// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build an expression that references a 1591 /// declaration that does not require a closure capture. 1592 ExprResult 1593 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1594 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1595 const CXXScopeSpec *SS, NamedDecl *FoundD, 1596 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 1597 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 1598 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 1599 if (const FunctionDecl *Callee = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1600 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Callee)) { 1601 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_ref_bad_target) 1602 << IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) << D->getIdentifier() 1603 << IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller); 1604 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 1605 << D->getIdentifier(); 1606 return ExprError(); 1607 } 1608 } 1609 1610 bool RefersToCapturedVariable = 1611 isa<VarDecl>(D) && 1612 NeedToCaptureVariable(cast<VarDecl>(D), NameInfo.getLoc()); 1613 1614 DeclRefExpr *E; 1615 if (isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) { 1616 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec = 1617 cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D); 1618 1619 E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context) 1620 : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), 1621 VarSpec->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), D, 1622 RefersToCapturedVariable, NameInfo.getLoc(), Ty, VK, 1623 FoundD, TemplateArgs); 1624 } else { 1625 assert(!TemplateArgs && "No template arguments for non-variable" 1626 " template specialization references"); 1627 E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context) 1628 : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), 1629 SourceLocation(), D, RefersToCapturedVariable, 1630 NameInfo, Ty, VK, FoundD); 1631 } 1632 1633 MarkDeclRefReferenced(E); 1634 1635 if (getLangOpts().ObjCARCWeak && isa<VarDecl>(D) && 1636 Ty.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak && 1637 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, E->getLocStart())) 1638 recordUseOfEvaluatedWeak(E); 1639 1640 // Just in case we're building an illegal pointer-to-member. 1641 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D); 1642 if (FD && FD->isBitField()) 1643 E->setObjectKind(OK_BitField); 1644 1645 return E; 1646 } 1647 1648 /// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and 1649 /// possibly a list of template arguments. 1650 /// 1651 /// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call 1652 /// DecomposeTemplateName. 1653 /// 1654 /// This actually loses a lot of source location information for 1655 /// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in 1656 /// some way. 1657 void 1658 Sema::DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id, 1659 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer, 1660 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1661 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) { 1662 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) { 1663 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc); 1664 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 1665 1666 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), 1667 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs); 1668 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer); 1669 1670 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get(); 1671 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc; 1672 NameInfo = Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc); 1673 TemplateArgs = &Buffer; 1674 } else { 1675 NameInfo = GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id); 1676 TemplateArgs = nullptr; 1677 } 1678 } 1679 1680 static void emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic( 1681 const TypoCorrection &TC, Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1682 DeclarationName Typo, SourceLocation TypoLoc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 1683 unsigned DiagnosticID, unsigned DiagnosticSuggestID) { 1684 DeclContext *Ctx = 1685 SS.isEmpty() ? nullptr : SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false); 1686 if (!TC) { 1687 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups. 1688 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?) 1689 if (Ctx) 1690 SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Typo << Ctx 1691 << SS.getRange(); 1692 else 1693 SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, DiagnosticID) << Typo; 1694 return; 1695 } 1696 1697 std::string CorrectedStr = TC.getAsString(SemaRef.getLangOpts()); 1698 bool DroppedSpecifier = 1699 TC.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Typo.getAsString() == CorrectedStr; 1700 unsigned NoteID = 1701 (TC.getCorrectionDecl() && isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(TC.getCorrectionDecl())) 1702 ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl 1703 : diag::note_previous_decl; 1704 if (!Ctx) 1705 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(DiagnosticSuggestID) << Typo, 1706 SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID)); 1707 else 1708 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest) 1709 << Typo << Ctx << DroppedSpecifier 1710 << SS.getRange(), 1711 SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID)); 1712 } 1713 1714 /// Diagnose an empty lookup. 1715 /// 1716 /// \return false if new lookup candidates were found 1717 bool 1718 Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 1719 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC, 1720 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 1721 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, TypoExpr **Out) { 1722 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName(); 1723 1724 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use; 1725 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest; 1726 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName || 1727 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName || 1728 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) { 1729 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use; 1730 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest; 1731 } 1732 1733 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an 1734 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the 1735 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a 1736 // dependent name. 1737 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isEmpty() && !CallsUndergoingInstantiation.empty()) 1738 ? CurContext : nullptr; 1739 while (DC) { 1740 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 1741 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 1742 1743 if (!R.empty()) { 1744 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup. 1745 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 1746 1747 // During a default argument instantiation the CurContext points 1748 // to a CXXMethodDecl; but we can't apply a this-> fixit inside a 1749 // function parameter list, hence add an explicit check. 1750 bool isDefaultArgument = !ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() && 1751 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.back().Kind == 1752 ActiveTemplateInstantiation::DefaultFunctionArgumentInstantiation; 1753 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext); 1754 bool isInstance = CurMethod && 1755 CurMethod->isInstance() && 1756 DC == CurMethod->getParent() && !isDefaultArgument; 1757 1758 1759 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'. 1760 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases. 1761 // Actually quite difficult! 1762 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 1763 diagnostic = diag::ext_found_via_dependent_bases_lookup; 1764 if (isInstance) { 1765 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name 1766 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->"); 1767 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>( 1768 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee()); 1769 1770 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod; 1771 if (CurMethod->isDependentContext()) 1772 DepMethod = CurMethod; 1773 else if (CurMethod->getTemplatedKind() == 1774 FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplateSpecialization) 1775 DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurMethod->getPrimaryTemplate()-> 1776 getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl()); 1777 else 1778 DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>( 1779 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()); 1780 assert(DepMethod && "No template pattern found"); 1781 1782 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context); 1783 CheckCXXThisCapture(R.getNameLoc()); 1784 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr( 1785 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false); 1786 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList; 1787 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 1788 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList); 1789 1790 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1791 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 1792 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr = 1793 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create( 1794 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(), 1795 SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 1796 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), nullptr, 1797 R.getLookupNameInfo(), 1798 ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() ? &TList : nullptr); 1799 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr); 1800 } else { 1801 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name; 1802 } 1803 1804 // Do we really want to note all of these? 1805 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) 1806 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use); 1807 1808 // Return true if we are inside a default argument instantiation 1809 // and the found name refers to an instance member function, otherwise 1810 // the function calling DiagnoseEmptyLookup will try to create an 1811 // implicit member call and this is wrong for default argument. 1812 if (isDefaultArgument && ((*R.begin())->isCXXInstanceMember())) { 1813 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_member_call_without_object); 1814 return true; 1815 } 1816 1817 // Tell the callee to try to recover. 1818 return false; 1819 } 1820 1821 R.clear(); 1822 } 1823 1824 // In Microsoft mode, if we are performing lookup from within a friend 1825 // function definition declared at class scope then we must set 1826 // DC to the lexical parent to be able to search into the parent 1827 // class. 1828 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isa<FunctionDecl>(DC) && 1829 cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)->getFriendObjectKind() && 1830 DC->getLexicalParent()->isRecord()) 1831 DC = DC->getLexicalParent(); 1832 else 1833 DC = DC->getParent(); 1834 } 1835 1836 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo. 1837 TypoCorrection Corrected; 1838 if (S && Out) { 1839 SourceLocation TypoLoc = R.getNameLoc(); 1840 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs && 1841 "Diagnosing an empty lookup with explicit template args!"); 1842 *Out = CorrectTypoDelayed( 1843 R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S, &SS, std::move(CCC), 1844 [=](const TypoCorrection &TC) { 1845 emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(TC, *this, SS, Name, TypoLoc, Args, 1846 diagnostic, diagnostic_suggest); 1847 }, 1848 nullptr, CTK_ErrorRecovery); 1849 if (*Out) 1850 return true; 1851 } else if (S && (Corrected = 1852 CorrectTypo(R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S, 1853 &SS, std::move(CCC), CTK_ErrorRecovery))) { 1854 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 1855 bool DroppedSpecifier = 1856 Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Name.getAsString() == CorrectedStr; 1857 R.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection()); 1858 1859 bool AcceptableWithRecovery = false; 1860 bool AcceptableWithoutRecovery = false; 1861 NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl(); 1862 if (ND) { 1863 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) { 1864 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(R.getNameLoc(), 1865 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 1866 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 1867 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CD = Corrected.begin(), 1868 CDEnd = Corrected.end(); 1869 CD != CDEnd; ++CD) { 1870 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = 1871 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*CD)) 1872 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 1873 FTD, DeclAccessPair::make(FTD, AS_none), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 1874 Args, OCS); 1875 else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CD)) 1876 if (!ExplicitTemplateArgs || ExplicitTemplateArgs->size() == 0) 1877 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), 1878 Args, OCS); 1879 } 1880 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(*this, R.getNameLoc(), Best)) { 1881 case OR_Success: 1882 ND = Best->Function; 1883 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 1884 break; 1885 default: 1886 // FIXME: Arbitrarily pick the first declaration for the note. 1887 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 1888 break; 1889 } 1890 } 1891 R.addDecl(ND); 1892 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ND->isCXXClassMember()) { 1893 CXXRecordDecl *Record = nullptr; 1894 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) { 1895 const Type *Ty = Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()->getAsType(); 1896 Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 1897 } 1898 if (!Record) 1899 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>( 1900 ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()); 1901 R.setNamingClass(Record); 1902 } 1903 1904 AcceptableWithRecovery = 1905 isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND); 1906 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or 1907 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser 1908 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo 1909 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going 1910 // to recover well anyway. 1911 AcceptableWithoutRecovery = 1912 isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND); 1913 } else { 1914 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it 1915 // because we aren't able to recover. 1916 AcceptableWithoutRecovery = true; 1917 } 1918 1919 if (AcceptableWithRecovery || AcceptableWithoutRecovery) { 1920 unsigned NoteID = (Corrected.getCorrectionDecl() && 1921 isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(Corrected.getCorrectionDecl())) 1922 ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl 1923 : diag::note_previous_decl; 1924 if (SS.isEmpty()) 1925 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diagnostic_suggest) << Name, 1926 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery); 1927 else 1928 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest) 1929 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 1930 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange(), 1931 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery); 1932 1933 // Tell the callee whether to try to recover. 1934 return !AcceptableWithRecovery; 1935 } 1936 } 1937 R.clear(); 1938 1939 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups. 1940 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?) 1941 if (!SS.isEmpty()) { 1942 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 1943 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 1944 << SS.getRange(); 1945 return true; 1946 } 1947 1948 // Give up, we can't recover. 1949 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name; 1950 return true; 1951 } 1952 1953 /// In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class whose parent class has 1954 /// dependent base classes, and we can't resolve an unqualified identifier, then 1955 /// assume the identifier is a member of a dependent base class. We can only 1956 /// recover successfully in static methods, instance methods, and other contexts 1957 /// where 'this' is available. This doesn't precisely match MSVC's 1958 /// instantiation model, but it's close enough. 1959 static Expr * 1960 recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(Sema &S, ASTContext &Context, 1961 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1962 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, 1963 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 1964 // Only try to recover from lookup into dependent bases in static methods or 1965 // contexts where 'this' is available. 1966 QualType ThisType = S.getCurrentThisType(); 1967 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr; 1968 if (!ThisType.isNull()) 1969 RD = ThisType->getPointeeType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 1970 else if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(S.CurContext)) 1971 RD = MD->getParent(); 1972 if (!RD || !RD->hasAnyDependentBases()) 1973 return nullptr; 1974 1975 // Diagnose this as unqualified lookup into a dependent base class. If 'this' 1976 // is available, suggest inserting 'this->' as a fixit. 1977 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 1978 auto DB = S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base); 1979 DB << NameInfo.getName() << RD; 1980 1981 if (!ThisType.isNull()) { 1982 DB << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "this->"); 1983 return CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create( 1984 Context, /*This=*/nullptr, ThisType, /*IsArrow=*/true, 1985 /*Op=*/SourceLocation(), NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), TemplateKWLoc, 1986 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, NameInfo, TemplateArgs); 1987 } 1988 1989 // Synthesize a fake NNS that points to the derived class. This will 1990 // perform name lookup during template instantiation. 1991 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1992 auto *NNS = 1993 NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, true, RD->getTypeForDecl()); 1994 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(Loc, Loc)); 1995 return DependentScopeDeclRefExpr::Create( 1996 Context, SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 1997 TemplateArgs); 1998 } 1999 2000 ExprResult 2001 Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2002 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Id, 2003 bool HasTrailingLParen, bool IsAddressOfOperand, 2004 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC, 2005 bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier, Token *KeywordReplacement) { 2006 assert(!(IsAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) && 2007 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen"); 2008 if (SS.isInvalid()) 2009 return ExprError(); 2010 2011 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer; 2012 2013 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data. 2014 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo; 2015 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs; 2016 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs); 2017 2018 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 2019 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 2020 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2021 2022 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3: 2023 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains: 2024 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type, 2025 // (note: handled after lookup) 2026 // -- a template-id that is dependent, 2027 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr) 2028 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type, 2029 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that 2030 // names a dependent type. 2031 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization; 2032 // we need to handle these differently. 2033 bool DependentID = false; 2034 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName && 2035 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) { 2036 DependentID = true; 2037 } else if (SS.isSet()) { 2038 if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) { 2039 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 2040 return ExprError(); 2041 } else { 2042 DependentID = true; 2043 } 2044 } 2045 2046 if (DependentID) 2047 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2048 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2049 2050 // Perform the required lookup. 2051 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, 2052 (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam) 2053 ? LookupObjCImplicitSelfParam : LookupOrdinaryName); 2054 if (TemplateArgs) { 2055 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in 2056 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the 2057 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If 2058 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those 2059 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it. 2060 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 2061 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false, 2062 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization); 2063 2064 if (MemberOfUnknownSpecialization || 2065 (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)) 2066 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2067 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2068 } else { 2069 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = II && !SS.isSet() && getCurMethodDecl(); 2070 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp); 2071 2072 // If the result might be in a dependent base class, this is a dependent 2073 // id-expression. 2074 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation) 2075 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2076 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2077 2078 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do 2079 // some special Objective-C lookup, too. 2080 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) { 2081 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true)); 2082 if (E.isInvalid()) 2083 return ExprError(); 2084 2085 if (Expr *Ex = E.getAs<Expr>()) 2086 return Ex; 2087 } 2088 } 2089 2090 if (R.isAmbiguous()) 2091 return ExprError(); 2092 2093 // This could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal in C90, 2094 // extension in C99, forbidden in C++). 2095 if (R.empty() && HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2096 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S); 2097 if (D) R.addDecl(D); 2098 } 2099 2100 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for 2101 // argument-dependent lookup. 2102 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen); 2103 2104 if (R.empty() && !ADL) { 2105 if (SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 2106 if (Expr *E = recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(*this, Context, NameInfo, 2107 TemplateKWLoc, TemplateArgs)) 2108 return E; 2109 } 2110 2111 // Don't diagnose an empty lookup for inline assembly. 2112 if (IsInlineAsmIdentifier) 2113 return ExprError(); 2114 2115 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function 2116 // call, diagnose the problem. 2117 TypoExpr *TE = nullptr; 2118 auto DefaultValidator = llvm::make_unique<CorrectionCandidateCallback>( 2119 II, SS.isValid() ? SS.getScopeRep() : nullptr); 2120 DefaultValidator->IsAddressOfOperand = IsAddressOfOperand; 2121 assert((!CCC || CCC->IsAddressOfOperand == IsAddressOfOperand) && 2122 "Typo correction callback misconfigured"); 2123 if (CCC) { 2124 // Make sure the callback knows what the typo being diagnosed is. 2125 CCC->setTypoName(II); 2126 if (SS.isValid()) 2127 CCC->setTypoNNS(SS.getScopeRep()); 2128 } 2129 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, 2130 CCC ? std::move(CCC) : std::move(DefaultValidator), 2131 nullptr, None, &TE)) { 2132 if (TE && KeywordReplacement) { 2133 auto &State = getTypoExprState(TE); 2134 auto BestTC = State.Consumer->getNextCorrection(); 2135 if (BestTC.isKeyword()) { 2136 auto *II = BestTC.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 2137 if (State.DiagHandler) 2138 State.DiagHandler(BestTC); 2139 KeywordReplacement->startToken(); 2140 KeywordReplacement->setKind(II->getTokenID()); 2141 KeywordReplacement->setIdentifierInfo(II); 2142 KeywordReplacement->setLocation(BestTC.getCorrectionRange().getBegin()); 2143 // Clean up the state associated with the TypoExpr, since it has 2144 // now been diagnosed (without a call to CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr). 2145 clearDelayedTypo(TE); 2146 // Signal that a correction to a keyword was performed by returning a 2147 // valid-but-null ExprResult. 2148 return (Expr*)nullptr; 2149 } 2150 State.Consumer->resetCorrectionStream(); 2151 } 2152 return TE ? TE : ExprError(); 2153 } 2154 2155 assert(!R.empty() && 2156 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results"); 2157 2158 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let 2159 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to 2160 // reference the ivar. 2161 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) { 2162 R.clear(); 2163 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier())); 2164 // In a hopelessly buggy code, Objective-C instance variable 2165 // lookup fails and no expression will be built to reference it. 2166 if (!E.isInvalid() && !E.get()) 2167 return ExprError(); 2168 return E; 2169 } 2170 } 2171 2172 // This is guaranteed from this point on. 2173 assert(!R.empty() || ADL); 2174 2175 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access. 2176 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3: 2177 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access 2178 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the 2179 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup 2180 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type 2181 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a 2182 // class member access expression using (*this) as the 2183 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator. 2184 // 2185 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R 2186 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the 2187 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a 2188 // non-static member function: 2189 // 2190 // C++ [expr.ref]p4: 2191 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . . 2192 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a 2193 // member function call. 2194 // 2195 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important 2196 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a 2197 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent 2198 // instance method. 2199 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) { 2200 bool MightBeImplicitMember; 2201 if (!IsAddressOfOperand) 2202 MightBeImplicitMember = true; 2203 else if (!SS.isEmpty()) 2204 MightBeImplicitMember = false; 2205 else if (R.isOverloadedResult()) 2206 MightBeImplicitMember = false; 2207 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult()) 2208 MightBeImplicitMember = true; 2209 else 2210 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) || 2211 isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) || 2212 isa<MSPropertyDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()); 2213 2214 if (MightBeImplicitMember) 2215 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, 2216 R, TemplateArgs); 2217 } 2218 2219 if (TemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) { 2220 2221 // In C++1y, if this is a variable template id, then check it 2222 // in BuildTemplateIdExpr(). 2223 // The single lookup result must be a variable template declaration. 2224 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId && Id.TemplateId && 2225 Id.TemplateId->Kind == TNK_Var_template) { 2226 assert(R.getAsSingle<VarTemplateDecl>() && 2227 "There should only be one declaration found."); 2228 } 2229 2230 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, ADL, TemplateArgs); 2231 } 2232 2233 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL); 2234 } 2235 2236 /// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified 2237 /// declaration name, generally during template instantiation. 2238 /// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along 2239 /// this path. 2240 ExprResult 2241 Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2242 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 2243 bool IsAddressOfOperand, 2244 TypeSourceInfo **RecoveryTSI) { 2245 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false); 2246 if (!DC) 2247 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2248 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2249 2250 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 2251 return ExprError(); 2252 2253 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName); 2254 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 2255 2256 if (R.isAmbiguous()) 2257 return ExprError(); 2258 2259 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation) 2260 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2261 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2262 2263 if (R.empty()) { 2264 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 2265 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange(); 2266 return ExprError(); 2267 } 2268 2269 if (const TypeDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>()) { 2270 // Diagnose a missing typename if this resolved unambiguously to a type in 2271 // a dependent context. If we can recover with a type, downgrade this to 2272 // a warning in Microsoft compatibility mode. 2273 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing; 2274 if (RecoveryTSI && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 2275 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing; 2276 SourceLocation Loc = SS.getBeginLoc(); 2277 auto D = Diag(Loc, DiagID); 2278 D << SS.getScopeRep() << NameInfo.getName().getAsString() 2279 << SourceRange(Loc, NameInfo.getEndLoc()); 2280 2281 // Don't recover if the caller isn't expecting us to or if we're in a SFINAE 2282 // context. 2283 if (!RecoveryTSI) 2284 return ExprError(); 2285 2286 // Only issue the fixit if we're prepared to recover. 2287 D << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "typename "); 2288 2289 // Recover by pretending this was an elaborated type. 2290 QualType Ty = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD); 2291 TypeLocBuilder TLB; 2292 TLB.pushTypeSpec(Ty).setNameLoc(NameInfo.getLoc()); 2293 2294 QualType ET = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, Ty); 2295 ElaboratedTypeLoc QTL = TLB.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(ET); 2296 QTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 2297 QTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 2298 2299 *RecoveryTSI = TLB.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, ET); 2300 2301 return ExprEmpty(); 2302 } 2303 2304 // Defend against this resolving to an implicit member access. We usually 2305 // won't get here if this might be a legitimate a class member (we end up in 2306 // BuildMemberReferenceExpr instead), but this can be valid if we're forming 2307 // a pointer-to-member or in an unevaluated context in C++11. 2308 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember() && !IsAddressOfOperand) 2309 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, 2310 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2311 R, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2312 2313 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /* ADL */ false); 2314 } 2315 2316 /// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has 2317 /// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some 2318 /// additional lookup. 2319 /// 2320 /// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's 2321 /// actually quite a lot of extra work involved. 2322 /// 2323 /// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success. 2324 ExprResult 2325 Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S, 2326 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) { 2327 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc(); 2328 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl(); 2329 2330 // Check for error condition which is already reported. 2331 if (!CurMethod) 2332 return ExprError(); 2333 2334 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed, 2335 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have 2336 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e. 2337 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with 2338 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl. 2339 2340 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for 2341 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an 2342 // ivar, that's an error. 2343 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod(); 2344 2345 bool LookForIvars; 2346 if (Lookup.empty()) 2347 LookForIvars = true; 2348 else if (IsClassMethod) 2349 LookForIvars = false; 2350 else 2351 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() && 2352 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()); 2353 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr; 2354 if (LookForIvars) { 2355 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface(); 2356 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared; 2357 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = nullptr; 2358 if (IFace && (IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared))) { 2359 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method. 2360 if (IsClassMethod) 2361 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method) 2362 << IV->getDeclName()); 2363 2364 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent 2365 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl. 2366 if (IV->isInvalidDecl()) 2367 return ExprError(); 2368 2369 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)). 2370 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc)) 2371 return ExprError(); 2372 2373 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class. 2374 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private && 2375 !declaresSameEntity(ClassDeclared, IFace) && 2376 !getLangOpts().DebuggerSupport) 2377 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName(); 2378 2379 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't 2380 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something. 2381 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self"); 2382 UnqualifiedId SelfName; 2383 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation()); 2384 SelfName.setKind(UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam); 2385 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec; 2386 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc; 2387 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec, TemplateKWLoc, 2388 SelfName, false, false); 2389 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid()) 2390 return ExprError(); 2391 2392 SelfExpr = DefaultLvalueConversion(SelfExpr.get()); 2393 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid()) 2394 return ExprError(); 2395 2396 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, IV, true); 2397 2398 ObjCMethodFamily MF = CurMethod->getMethodFamily(); 2399 if (MF != OMF_init && MF != OMF_dealloc && MF != OMF_finalize && 2400 !IvarBacksCurrentMethodAccessor(IFace, CurMethod, IV)) 2401 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_direct_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName(); 2402 2403 ObjCIvarRefExpr *Result = new (Context) 2404 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc, IV->getLocation(), 2405 SelfExpr.get(), true, true); 2406 2407 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 2408 if (IV->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) { 2409 if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, Loc)) 2410 recordUseOfEvaluatedWeak(Result); 2411 } 2412 if (CurContext->isClosure()) 2413 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self) 2414 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "self->"); 2415 } 2416 2417 return Result; 2418 } 2419 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) { 2420 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar. 2421 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface()) { 2422 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared; 2423 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) { 2424 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private || 2425 declaresSameEntity(IFace, ClassDeclared)) 2426 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName(); 2427 } 2428 } 2429 } else if (Lookup.isSingleResult() && 2430 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()) { 2431 // If accessing a stand-alone ivar in a class method, this is an error. 2432 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Lookup.getFoundDecl())) 2433 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method) 2434 << IV->getDeclName()); 2435 } 2436 2437 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) { 2438 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName. 2439 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) { 2440 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2441 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) { 2442 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID, 2443 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(), 2444 Lookup.getNameLoc()); 2445 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D); 2446 } 2447 } 2448 } 2449 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special. 2450 return ExprResult((Expr *)nullptr); 2451 } 2452 2453 /// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type. 2454 /// 2455 /// Logically this happens in three phases: 2456 /// 2457 /// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class. 2458 /// The naming class is the class into which we were looking 2459 /// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a 2460 /// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type. 2461 /// 2462 /// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class. 2463 /// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by 2464 /// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's 2465 /// the class declaring the member. 2466 /// 2467 /// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true" 2468 /// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not 2469 /// obey access control. 2470 ExprResult 2471 Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From, 2472 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 2473 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 2474 NamedDecl *Member) { 2475 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext()); 2476 if (!RD) 2477 return From; 2478 2479 QualType DestRecordType; 2480 QualType DestType; 2481 QualType FromRecordType; 2482 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2483 bool PointerConversions = false; 2484 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) { 2485 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD)); 2486 2487 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2488 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType); 2489 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2490 PointerConversions = true; 2491 } else { 2492 DestType = DestRecordType; 2493 FromRecordType = FromType; 2494 } 2495 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) { 2496 if (Method->isStatic()) 2497 return From; 2498 2499 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context); 2500 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType(); 2501 2502 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2503 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2504 PointerConversions = true; 2505 } else { 2506 FromRecordType = FromType; 2507 DestType = DestRecordType; 2508 } 2509 } else { 2510 // No conversion necessary. 2511 return From; 2512 } 2513 2514 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType()) 2515 return From; 2516 2517 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary. 2518 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType)) 2519 return From; 2520 2521 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange(); 2522 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin(); 2523 2524 ExprValueKind VK = From->getValueKind(); 2525 2526 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8: 2527 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its 2528 // class name. 2529 // 2530 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a 2531 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type 2532 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows 2533 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as: 2534 // 2535 // class Base { public: int x; }; 2536 // class Derived1 : public Base { }; 2537 // class Derived2 : public Base { }; 2538 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); }; 2539 // 2540 // void VeryDerived::f() { 2541 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects 2542 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1 2543 // } 2544 if (Qualifier && Qualifier->getAsType()) { 2545 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0); 2546 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type"); 2547 2548 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0); 2549 2550 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base 2551 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it. 2552 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts. 2553 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) { 2554 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2555 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType, 2556 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath)) 2557 return ExprError(); 2558 2559 if (PointerConversions) 2560 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType); 2561 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2562 VK, &BasePath).get(); 2563 2564 FromType = QType; 2565 FromRecordType = QRecordType; 2566 2567 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type, 2568 // we're done. 2569 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType)) 2570 return From; 2571 } 2572 } 2573 2574 bool IgnoreAccess = false; 2575 2576 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast 2577 // down to the using declaration's type. 2578 // 2579 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a 2580 // class ever has member declarations. 2581 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) { 2582 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl)); 2583 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType( 2584 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext())); 2585 2586 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class 2587 // conversion is non-trivial. 2588 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) { 2589 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType)); 2590 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2591 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType, 2592 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath)) 2593 return ExprError(); 2594 2595 QualType UType = URecordType; 2596 if (PointerConversions) 2597 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType); 2598 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2599 VK, &BasePath).get(); 2600 FromType = UType; 2601 FromRecordType = URecordType; 2602 } 2603 2604 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the 2605 // declaring class to the true declaring class. 2606 IgnoreAccess = true; 2607 } 2608 2609 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2610 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType, 2611 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath, 2612 IgnoreAccess)) 2613 return ExprError(); 2614 2615 return ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2616 VK, &BasePath); 2617 } 2618 2619 bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2620 const LookupResult &R, 2621 bool HasTrailingLParen) { 2622 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call. 2623 if (!HasTrailingLParen) 2624 return false; 2625 2626 // Never if a scope specifier was provided. 2627 if (SS.isSet()) 2628 return false; 2629 2630 // Only in C++ or ObjC++. 2631 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 2632 return false; 2633 2634 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during 2635 // normal lookup: 2636 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) { 2637 NamedDecl *D = *I; 2638 2639 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2640 // -- a declaration of a class member 2641 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the 2642 // original decl. 2643 if (D->isCXXClassMember()) 2644 return false; 2645 2646 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2647 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 2648 // using-declaration 2649 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we 2650 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types 2651 // turn off ADL anyway). 2652 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 2653 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 2654 else if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 2655 return false; 2656 2657 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2658 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 2659 // template 2660 // And also for builtin functions. 2661 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2662 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 2663 2664 // But also builtin functions. 2665 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit()) 2666 return false; 2667 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 2668 return false; 2669 } 2670 2671 return true; 2672 } 2673 2674 2675 /// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration 2676 /// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that 2677 /// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration 2678 /// will in fact be used. 2679 static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) { 2680 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 2681 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName(); 2682 return true; 2683 } 2684 2685 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) { 2686 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName(); 2687 return true; 2688 } 2689 2690 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) { 2691 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName(); 2692 return true; 2693 } 2694 2695 return false; 2696 } 2697 2698 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2699 LookupResult &R, bool NeedsADL, 2700 bool AcceptInvalidDecl) { 2701 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL, 2702 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref. 2703 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>()) 2704 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getFoundDecl(), 2705 R.getRepresentativeDecl(), nullptr, 2706 AcceptInvalidDecl); 2707 2708 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one 2709 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be 2710 // functions and function templates. 2711 if (R.isSingleResult() && 2712 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl())) 2713 return ExprError(); 2714 2715 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress 2716 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when 2717 // we've picked a target. 2718 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 2719 2720 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE 2721 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, R.getNamingClass(), 2722 SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 2723 R.getLookupNameInfo(), 2724 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(), 2725 R.begin(), R.end()); 2726 2727 return ULE; 2728 } 2729 2730 /// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration. 2731 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr( 2732 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, NamedDecl *D, 2733 NamedDecl *FoundD, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs, 2734 bool AcceptInvalidDecl) { 2735 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration"); 2736 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) && 2737 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template"); 2738 2739 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2740 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D)) 2741 return ExprError(); 2742 2743 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) { 2744 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing 2745 // a template argument list. 2746 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref) << (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(D) ? 1 : 0) 2747 << Template << SS.getRange(); 2748 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here); 2749 return ExprError(); 2750 } 2751 2752 // Make sure that we're referring to a value. 2753 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D); 2754 if (!VD) { 2755 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value) 2756 << D << SS.getRange(); 2757 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 2758 return ExprError(); 2759 } 2760 2761 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress 2762 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup 2763 // on this function name, because this might not be the function 2764 // that overload resolution actually selects. 2765 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc)) 2766 return ExprError(); 2767 2768 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's. 2769 if (VD->isInvalidDecl() && !AcceptInvalidDecl) 2770 return ExprError(); 2771 2772 // Handle members of anonymous structs and unions. If we got here, 2773 // and the reference is to a class member indirect field, then this 2774 // must be the subject of a pointer-to-member expression. 2775 if (IndirectFieldDecl *indirectField = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 2776 if (!indirectField->isCXXClassMember()) 2777 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SS, NameInfo.getLoc(), 2778 indirectField); 2779 2780 { 2781 QualType type = VD->getType(); 2782 ExprValueKind valueKind = VK_RValue; 2783 2784 switch (D->getKind()) { 2785 // Ignore all the non-ValueDecl kinds. 2786 #define ABSTRACT_DECL(kind) 2787 #define VALUE(type, base) 2788 #define DECL(type, base) \ 2789 case Decl::type: 2790 #include "clang/AST/DeclNodes.inc" 2791 llvm_unreachable("invalid value decl kind"); 2792 2793 // These shouldn't make it here. 2794 case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField: 2795 case Decl::ObjCIvar: 2796 llvm_unreachable("forming non-member reference to ivar?"); 2797 2798 // Enum constants are always r-values and never references. 2799 // Unresolved using declarations are dependent. 2800 case Decl::EnumConstant: 2801 case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue: 2802 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2803 break; 2804 2805 // Fields and indirect fields that got here must be for 2806 // pointer-to-member expressions; we just call them l-values for 2807 // internal consistency, because this subexpression doesn't really 2808 // exist in the high-level semantics. 2809 case Decl::Field: 2810 case Decl::IndirectField: 2811 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2812 "building reference to field in C?"); 2813 2814 // These can't have reference type in well-formed programs, but 2815 // for internal consistency we do this anyway. 2816 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 2817 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2818 break; 2819 2820 // Non-type template parameters are either l-values or r-values 2821 // depending on the type. 2822 case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: { 2823 if (const ReferenceType *reftype = type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 2824 type = reftype->getPointeeType(); 2825 valueKind = VK_LValue; // even if the parameter is an r-value reference 2826 break; 2827 } 2828 2829 // For non-references, we need to strip qualifiers just in case 2830 // the template parameter was declared as 'const int' or whatever. 2831 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2832 type = type.getUnqualifiedType(); 2833 break; 2834 } 2835 2836 case Decl::Var: 2837 case Decl::VarTemplateSpecialization: 2838 case Decl::VarTemplatePartialSpecialization: 2839 // In C, "extern void blah;" is valid and is an r-value. 2840 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2841 !type.hasQualifiers() && 2842 type->isVoidType()) { 2843 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2844 break; 2845 } 2846 // fallthrough 2847 2848 case Decl::ImplicitParam: 2849 case Decl::ParmVar: { 2850 // These are always l-values. 2851 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2852 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 2853 2854 // FIXME: Does the addition of const really only apply in 2855 // potentially-evaluated contexts? Since the variable isn't actually 2856 // captured in an unevaluated context, it seems that the answer is no. 2857 if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) { 2858 QualType CapturedType = getCapturedDeclRefType(cast<VarDecl>(VD), Loc); 2859 if (!CapturedType.isNull()) 2860 type = CapturedType; 2861 } 2862 2863 break; 2864 } 2865 2866 case Decl::Function: { 2867 if (unsigned BID = cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->getBuiltinID()) { 2868 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BID)) { 2869 type = Context.BuiltinFnTy; 2870 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2871 break; 2872 } 2873 } 2874 2875 const FunctionType *fty = type->castAs<FunctionType>(); 2876 2877 // If we're referring to a function with an __unknown_anytype 2878 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype. 2879 if (fty->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 2880 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy; 2881 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2882 break; 2883 } 2884 2885 // Functions are l-values in C++. 2886 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2887 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2888 break; 2889 } 2890 2891 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a 2892 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only 2893 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing 2894 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function 2895 // type. 2896 if (!cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->hasPrototype() && 2897 isa<FunctionProtoType>(fty)) 2898 type = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(fty->getReturnType(), 2899 fty->getExtInfo()); 2900 2901 // Functions are r-values in C. 2902 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2903 break; 2904 } 2905 2906 case Decl::MSProperty: 2907 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2908 break; 2909 2910 case Decl::CXXMethod: 2911 // If we're referring to a method with an __unknown_anytype 2912 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype. 2913 // This should only be possible with a type written directly. 2914 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto 2915 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(VD->getType())) 2916 if (proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 2917 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy; 2918 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2919 break; 2920 } 2921 2922 // C++ methods are l-values if static, r-values if non-static. 2923 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isStatic()) { 2924 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2925 break; 2926 } 2927 // fallthrough 2928 2929 case Decl::CXXConversion: 2930 case Decl::CXXDestructor: 2931 case Decl::CXXConstructor: 2932 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2933 break; 2934 } 2935 2936 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, type, valueKind, NameInfo, &SS, FoundD, 2937 TemplateArgs); 2938 } 2939 } 2940 2941 static void ConvertUTF8ToWideString(unsigned CharByteWidth, StringRef Source, 2942 SmallString<32> &Target) { 2943 Target.resize(CharByteWidth * (Source.size() + 1)); 2944 char *ResultPtr = &Target[0]; 2945 const UTF8 *ErrorPtr; 2946 bool success = ConvertUTF8toWide(CharByteWidth, Source, ResultPtr, ErrorPtr); 2947 (void)success; 2948 assert(success); 2949 Target.resize(ResultPtr - &Target[0]); 2950 } 2951 2952 ExprResult Sema::BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, 2953 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT) { 2954 // Pick the current block, lambda, captured statement or function. 2955 Decl *currentDecl = nullptr; 2956 if (const BlockScopeInfo *BSI = getCurBlock()) 2957 currentDecl = BSI->TheDecl; 2958 else if (const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda()) 2959 currentDecl = LSI->CallOperator; 2960 else if (const CapturedRegionScopeInfo *CSI = getCurCapturedRegion()) 2961 currentDecl = CSI->TheCapturedDecl; 2962 else 2963 currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl(); 2964 2965 if (!currentDecl) { 2966 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function); 2967 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 2968 } 2969 2970 QualType ResTy; 2971 StringLiteral *SL = nullptr; 2972 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) 2973 ResTy = Context.DependentTy; 2974 else { 2975 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of 2976 // the string. 2977 auto Str = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl); 2978 unsigned Length = Str.length(); 2979 2980 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1); 2981 if (IT == PredefinedExpr::LFunction) { 2982 ResTy = Context.WideCharTy.withConst(); 2983 SmallString<32> RawChars; 2984 ConvertUTF8ToWideString(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ResTy).getQuantity(), 2985 Str, RawChars); 2986 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 2987 /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0); 2988 SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, RawChars, StringLiteral::Wide, 2989 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc); 2990 } else { 2991 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst(); 2992 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 2993 /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0); 2994 SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Str, StringLiteral::Ascii, 2995 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc); 2996 } 2997 } 2998 2999 return new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT, SL); 3000 } 3001 3002 ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind) { 3003 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT; 3004 3005 switch (Kind) { 3006 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown simple primary expr!"); 3007 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2] 3008 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break; 3009 case tok::kw___FUNCDNAME__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncDName; break; // [MS] 3010 case tok::kw___FUNCSIG__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncSig; break; // [MS] 3011 case tok::kw_L__FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::LFunction; break; 3012 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break; 3013 } 3014 3015 return BuildPredefinedExpr(Loc, IT); 3016 } 3017 3018 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) { 3019 SmallString<16> CharBuffer; 3020 bool Invalid = false; 3021 StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid); 3022 if (Invalid) 3023 return ExprError(); 3024 3025 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(), 3026 PP, Tok.getKind()); 3027 if (Literal.hadError()) 3028 return ExprError(); 3029 3030 QualType Ty; 3031 if (Literal.isWide()) 3032 Ty = Context.WideCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C and C++. 3033 else if (Literal.isUTF16()) 3034 Ty = Context.Char16Ty; // u'x' -> char16_t in C11 and C++11. 3035 else if (Literal.isUTF32()) 3036 Ty = Context.Char32Ty; // U'x' -> char32_t in C11 and C++11. 3037 else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || Literal.isMultiChar()) 3038 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' -> int in C, 'wxyz' -> int in C++. 3039 else 3040 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++ 3041 3042 CharacterLiteral::CharacterKind Kind = CharacterLiteral::Ascii; 3043 if (Literal.isWide()) 3044 Kind = CharacterLiteral::Wide; 3045 else if (Literal.isUTF16()) 3046 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF16; 3047 else if (Literal.isUTF32()) 3048 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF32; 3049 3050 Expr *Lit = new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(), Kind, Ty, 3051 Tok.getLocation()); 3052 3053 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty()) 3054 return Lit; 3055 3056 // We're building a user-defined literal. 3057 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 3058 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 3059 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 3060 3061 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 3062 if (!UDLScope) 3063 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_character_udl)); 3064 3065 // C++11 [lex.ext]p6: The literal L is treated as a call of the form 3066 // operator "" X (ch) 3067 return BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(*this, UDLScope, UDSuffix, UDSuffixLoc, 3068 Lit, Tok.getLocation()); 3069 } 3070 3071 ExprResult Sema::ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc, uint64_t Val) { 3072 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 3073 return IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val), 3074 Context.IntTy, Loc); 3075 } 3076 3077 static Expr *BuildFloatingLiteral(Sema &S, NumericLiteralParser &Literal, 3078 QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc) { 3079 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty); 3080 3081 using llvm::APFloat; 3082 APFloat Val(Format); 3083 3084 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val); 3085 3086 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if 3087 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow). 3088 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) || 3089 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) { 3090 unsigned diagnostic; 3091 SmallString<20> buffer; 3092 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) { 3093 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow; 3094 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer); 3095 } else { 3096 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow; 3097 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer); 3098 } 3099 3100 S.Diag(Loc, diagnostic) 3101 << Ty 3102 << StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size()); 3103 } 3104 3105 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK); 3106 return FloatingLiteral::Create(S.Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Loc); 3107 } 3108 3109 bool Sema::CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 3110 assert(E && "Invalid expression"); 3111 3112 if (E->isValueDependent()) 3113 return false; 3114 3115 QualType QT = E->getType(); 3116 if (!QT->isIntegerType() || QT->isBooleanType() || QT->isCharType()) { 3117 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_type) << QT; 3118 return true; 3119 } 3120 3121 llvm::APSInt ValueAPS; 3122 ExprResult R = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, &ValueAPS); 3123 3124 if (R.isInvalid()) 3125 return true; 3126 3127 bool ValueIsPositive = ValueAPS.isStrictlyPositive(); 3128 if (!ValueIsPositive || ValueAPS.getActiveBits() > 31) { 3129 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_value) 3130 << ValueAPS.toString(10) << ValueIsPositive; 3131 return true; 3132 } 3133 3134 return false; 3135 } 3136 3137 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) { 3138 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit 3139 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or suffix. 3140 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) { 3141 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok); 3142 return ActOnIntegerConstant(Tok.getLocation(), Val-'0'); 3143 } 3144 3145 SmallString<128> SpellingBuffer; 3146 // NumericLiteralParser wants to overread by one character. Add padding to 3147 // the buffer in case the token is copied to the buffer. If getSpelling() 3148 // returns a StringRef to the memory buffer, it should have a null char at 3149 // the EOF, so it is also safe. 3150 SpellingBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength() + 1); 3151 3152 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc. 3153 bool Invalid = false; 3154 StringRef TokSpelling = PP.getSpelling(Tok, SpellingBuffer, &Invalid); 3155 if (Invalid) 3156 return ExprError(); 3157 3158 NumericLiteralParser Literal(TokSpelling, Tok.getLocation(), PP); 3159 if (Literal.hadError) 3160 return ExprError(); 3161 3162 if (Literal.hasUDSuffix()) { 3163 // We're building a user-defined literal. 3164 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 3165 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 3166 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 3167 3168 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 3169 if (!UDLScope) 3170 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_numeric_udl)); 3171 3172 QualType CookedTy; 3173 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3174 // C++11 [lex.ext]p4: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type 3175 // long double, the literal is treated as a call of the form 3176 // operator "" X (f L) 3177 CookedTy = Context.LongDoubleTy; 3178 } else { 3179 // C++11 [lex.ext]p3: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type 3180 // unsigned long long, the literal is treated as a call of the form 3181 // operator "" X (n ULL) 3182 CookedTy = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3183 } 3184 3185 DeclarationName OpName = 3186 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 3187 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 3188 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 3189 3190 SourceLocation TokLoc = Tok.getLocation(); 3191 3192 // Perform literal operator lookup to determine if we're building a raw 3193 // literal or a cooked one. 3194 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 3195 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, CookedTy, 3196 /*AllowRaw*/true, /*AllowTemplate*/true, 3197 /*AllowStringTemplate*/false)) { 3198 case LOLR_Error: 3199 return ExprError(); 3200 3201 case LOLR_Cooked: { 3202 Expr *Lit; 3203 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3204 Lit = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, CookedTy, Tok.getLocation()); 3205 } else { 3206 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(), 0); 3207 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) 3208 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large) 3209 << /* Unsigned */ 1; 3210 Lit = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, CookedTy, 3211 Tok.getLocation()); 3212 } 3213 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc); 3214 } 3215 3216 case LOLR_Raw: { 3217 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: If S contains a raw literal operator, the 3218 // literal is treated as a call of the form 3219 // operator "" X ("n") 3220 unsigned Length = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); 3221 QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType( 3222 Context.CharTy.withConst(), llvm::APInt(32, Length + 1), 3223 ArrayType::Normal, 0); 3224 Expr *Lit = StringLiteral::Create( 3225 Context, StringRef(TokSpelling.data(), Length), StringLiteral::Ascii, 3226 /*Pascal*/false, StrTy, &TokLoc, 1); 3227 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc); 3228 } 3229 3230 case LOLR_Template: { 3231 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: Otherwise (S contains a literal operator 3232 // template), L is treated as a call fo the form 3233 // operator "" X <'c1', 'c2', ... 'ck'>() 3234 // where n is the source character sequence c1 c2 ... ck. 3235 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs; 3236 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(Context.CharTy); 3237 bool CharIsUnsigned = Context.CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 3238 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned); 3239 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); I != N; ++I) { 3240 Value = TokSpelling[I]; 3241 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, Context.CharTy); 3242 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo; 3243 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo)); 3244 } 3245 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, TokLoc, 3246 &ExplicitArgs); 3247 } 3248 case LOLR_StringTemplate: 3249 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 3250 } 3251 } 3252 3253 Expr *Res; 3254 3255 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3256 QualType Ty; 3257 if (Literal.isFloat) 3258 Ty = Context.FloatTy; 3259 else if (!Literal.isLong) 3260 Ty = Context.DoubleTy; 3261 else 3262 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy; 3263 3264 Res = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, Ty, Tok.getLocation()); 3265 3266 if (Ty == Context.DoubleTy) { 3267 if (getLangOpts().SinglePrecisionConstants) { 3268 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 3269 } else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 3270 !((getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 120) || 3271 getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp64)) { 3272 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_double_const_requires_fp64); 3273 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 3274 } 3275 } 3276 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) { 3277 return ExprError(); 3278 } else { 3279 QualType Ty; 3280 3281 // 'long long' is a C99 or C++11 feature. 3282 if (!getLangOpts().C99 && Literal.isLongLong) { 3283 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 3284 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), 3285 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? 3286 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_longlong : diag::ext_cxx11_longlong); 3287 else 3288 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_longlong); 3289 } 3290 3291 // Get the value in the widest-possible width. 3292 unsigned MaxWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntMaxTWidth(); 3293 // The microsoft literal suffix extensions support 128-bit literals, which 3294 // may be wider than [u]intmax_t. 3295 // FIXME: Actually, they don't. We seem to have accidentally invented the 3296 // i128 suffix. 3297 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 128 && MaxWidth < 128 && 3298 Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()) 3299 MaxWidth = 128; 3300 llvm::APInt ResultVal(MaxWidth, 0); 3301 3302 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) { 3303 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, error and force to ull. 3304 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large) 3305 << /* Unsigned */ 1; 3306 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3307 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() && 3308 "long long is not intmax_t?"); 3309 } else { 3310 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into 3311 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5. 3312 3313 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to 3314 // be an unsigned int. 3315 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10; 3316 3317 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can. 3318 unsigned Width = 0; 3319 3320 // Microsoft specific integer suffixes are explicitly sized. 3321 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger) { 3322 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger > MaxWidth) { 3323 // If this target doesn't support __int128, error and force to ull. 3324 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_int128_unsupported); 3325 Width = MaxWidth; 3326 Ty = Context.getIntMaxType(); 3327 } else { 3328 Width = Literal.MicrosoftInteger; 3329 Ty = Context.getIntTypeForBitwidth(Width, 3330 /*Signed=*/!Literal.isUnsigned); 3331 } 3332 } 3333 3334 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) { 3335 // Are int/unsigned possibilities? 3336 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 3337 3338 // Does it fit in a unsigned int? 3339 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) { 3340 // Does it fit in a signed int? 3341 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0) 3342 Ty = Context.IntTy; 3343 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3344 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy; 3345 Width = IntSize; 3346 } 3347 } 3348 3349 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities? 3350 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) { 3351 unsigned LongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth(); 3352 3353 // Does it fit in a unsigned long? 3354 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) { 3355 // Does it fit in a signed long? 3356 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0) 3357 Ty = Context.LongTy; 3358 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3359 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 3360 Width = LongSize; 3361 } 3362 } 3363 3364 // Check long long if needed. 3365 if (Ty.isNull()) { 3366 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3367 3368 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long? 3369 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) { 3370 // Does it fit in a signed long long? 3371 // To be compatible with MSVC, hex integer literals ending with the 3372 // LL or i64 suffix are always signed in Microsoft mode. 3373 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && (ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0 || 3374 (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && Literal.isLongLong))) 3375 Ty = Context.LongLongTy; 3376 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3377 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3378 Width = LongLongSize; 3379 } 3380 } 3381 3382 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that 3383 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix. 3384 if (Ty.isNull()) { 3385 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_integer_literal_too_large_for_signed); 3386 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3387 Width = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3388 } 3389 3390 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width) 3391 ResultVal = ResultVal.trunc(Width); 3392 } 3393 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation()); 3394 } 3395 3396 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper. 3397 if (Literal.isImaginary) 3398 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res, 3399 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType())); 3400 3401 return Res; 3402 } 3403 3404 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E) { 3405 assert(E && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr"); 3406 return new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E); 3407 } 3408 3409 static bool CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 3410 SourceLocation Loc, 3411 SourceRange ArgRange) { 3412 // [OpenCL 1.1 6.11.12] "The vec_step built-in function takes a built-in 3413 // scalar or vector data type argument..." 3414 // Every built-in scalar type (OpenCL 1.1 6.1.1) is either an arithmetic 3415 // type (C99 6.2.5p18) or void. 3416 if (!(T->isArithmeticType() || T->isVoidType() || T->isVectorType())) { 3417 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_vecstep_non_scalar_vector_type) 3418 << T << ArgRange; 3419 return true; 3420 } 3421 3422 assert((T->isVoidType() || !T->isIncompleteType()) && 3423 "Scalar types should always be complete"); 3424 return false; 3425 } 3426 3427 static bool CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 3428 SourceLocation Loc, 3429 SourceRange ArgRange, 3430 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) { 3431 // Invalid types must be hard errors for SFINAE in C++. 3432 if (S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus) 3433 return true; 3434 3435 // C99 6.5.3.4p1: 3436 if (T->isFunctionType() && 3437 (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf || TraitKind == UETT_AlignOf)) { 3438 // sizeof(function)/alignof(function) is allowed as an extension. 3439 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3440 << TraitKind << ArgRange; 3441 return false; 3442 } 3443 3444 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension, unless in OpenCL where 3445 // this is an error (OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.k) 3446 if (T->isVoidType()) { 3447 unsigned DiagID = S.LangOpts.OpenCL ? diag::err_opencl_sizeof_alignof_type 3448 : diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_void_type; 3449 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << TraitKind << ArgRange; 3450 return false; 3451 } 3452 3453 return true; 3454 } 3455 3456 static bool CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema &S, QualType T, 3457 SourceLocation Loc, 3458 SourceRange ArgRange, 3459 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) { 3460 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) if the 3461 // runtime doesn't allow it. 3462 if (!S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsSizeofAlignof() && T->isObjCObjectType()) { 3463 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface) 3464 << T << (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf) 3465 << ArgRange; 3466 return true; 3467 } 3468 3469 return false; 3470 } 3471 3472 /// \brief Check whether E is a pointer from a decayed array type (the decayed 3473 /// pointer type is equal to T) and emit a warning if it is. 3474 static void warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, 3475 Expr *E) { 3476 // Don't warn if the operation changed the type. 3477 if (T != E->getType()) 3478 return; 3479 3480 // Now look for array decays. 3481 ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E); 3482 if (!ICE || ICE->getCastKind() != CK_ArrayToPointerDecay) 3483 return; 3484 3485 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_sizeof_array_decay) << ICE->getSourceRange() 3486 << ICE->getType() 3487 << ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(); 3488 } 3489 3490 /// \brief Check the constraints on expression operands to unary type expression 3491 /// and type traits. 3492 /// 3493 /// Completes any types necessary and validates the constraints on the operand 3494 /// expression. The logic mostly mirrors the type-based overload, but may modify 3495 /// the expression as it completes the type for that expression through template 3496 /// instantiation, etc. 3497 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr *E, 3498 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3499 QualType ExprTy = E->getType(); 3500 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType()); 3501 3502 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) 3503 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3504 E->getSourceRange()); 3505 3506 // Whitelist some types as extensions 3507 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3508 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind)) 3509 return false; 3510 3511 // 'alignof' applied to an expression only requires the base element type of 3512 // the expression to be complete. 'sizeof' requires the expression's type to 3513 // be complete (and will attempt to complete it if it's an array of unknown 3514 // bound). 3515 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) { 3516 if (RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), 3517 Context.getBaseElementType(E->getType()), 3518 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, ExprKind, 3519 E->getSourceRange())) 3520 return true; 3521 } else { 3522 if (RequireCompleteExprType(E, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, 3523 ExprKind, E->getSourceRange())) 3524 return true; 3525 } 3526 3527 // Completing the expression's type may have changed it. 3528 ExprTy = E->getType(); 3529 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType()); 3530 3531 if (ExprTy->isFunctionType()) { 3532 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3533 << ExprKind << E->getSourceRange(); 3534 return true; 3535 } 3536 3537 // The operand for sizeof and alignof is in an unevaluated expression context, 3538 // so side effects could result in unintended consequences. 3539 if ((ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf || ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) && 3540 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() && E->HasSideEffects(Context, false)) 3541 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context); 3542 3543 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3544 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind)) 3545 return true; 3546 3547 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf) { 3548 if (DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())) { 3549 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(DeclRef->getFoundDecl())) { 3550 QualType OType = PVD->getOriginalType(); 3551 QualType Type = PVD->getType(); 3552 if (Type->isPointerType() && OType->isArrayType()) { 3553 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_sizeof_array_param) 3554 << Type << OType; 3555 Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 3556 } 3557 } 3558 } 3559 3560 // Warn on "sizeof(array op x)" and "sizeof(x op array)", where the array 3561 // decays into a pointer and returns an unintended result. This is most 3562 // likely a typo for "sizeof(array) op x". 3563 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParens())) { 3564 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(), 3565 BO->getLHS()); 3566 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(), 3567 BO->getRHS()); 3568 } 3569 } 3570 3571 return false; 3572 } 3573 3574 /// \brief Check the constraints on operands to unary expression and type 3575 /// traits. 3576 /// 3577 /// This will complete any types necessary, and validate the various constraints 3578 /// on those operands. 3579 /// 3580 /// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine. 3581 /// C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] all state: 3582 /// Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator ... 3583 /// 3584 /// C++ [expr.sizeof]p4 3585 /// The lvalue-to-rvalue, array-to-pointer, and function-to-pointer 3586 /// standard conversions are not applied to the operand of sizeof. 3587 /// 3588 /// This policy is followed for all of the unary trait expressions. 3589 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType, 3590 SourceLocation OpLoc, 3591 SourceRange ExprRange, 3592 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3593 if (ExprType->isDependentType()) 3594 return false; 3595 3596 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: 3597 // When applied to a reference or a reference type, the result 3598 // is the size of the referenced type. 3599 // C++11 [expr.alignof]p3: 3600 // When alignof is applied to a reference type, the result 3601 // shall be the alignment of the referenced type. 3602 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 3603 ExprType = Ref->getPointeeType(); 3604 3605 // C11 6.5.3.4/3, C++11 [expr.alignof]p3: 3606 // When alignof or _Alignof is applied to an array type, the result 3607 // is the alignment of the element type. 3608 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) 3609 ExprType = Context.getBaseElementType(ExprType); 3610 3611 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) 3612 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange); 3613 3614 // Whitelist some types as extensions 3615 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange, 3616 ExprKind)) 3617 return false; 3618 3619 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, ExprType, 3620 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, 3621 ExprKind, ExprRange)) 3622 return true; 3623 3624 if (ExprType->isFunctionType()) { 3625 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3626 << ExprKind << ExprRange; 3627 return true; 3628 } 3629 3630 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange, 3631 ExprKind)) 3632 return true; 3633 3634 return false; 3635 } 3636 3637 static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 3638 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 3639 3640 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent. 3641 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 3642 return false; 3643 3644 if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { 3645 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) 3646 << 1 << E->getSourceRange(); 3647 return true; 3648 } 3649 3650 ValueDecl *D = nullptr; 3651 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 3652 D = DRE->getDecl(); 3653 } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 3654 D = ME->getMemberDecl(); 3655 } 3656 3657 // If it's a field, require the containing struct to have a 3658 // complete definition so that we can compute the layout. 3659 // 3660 // This can happen in C++11 onwards, either by naming the member 3661 // in a way that is not transformed into a member access expression 3662 // (in an unevaluated operand, for instance), or by naming the member 3663 // in a trailing-return-type. 3664 // 3665 // For the record, since __alignof__ on expressions is a GCC 3666 // extension, GCC seems to permit this but always gives the 3667 // nonsensical answer 0. 3668 // 3669 // We don't really need the layout here --- we could instead just 3670 // directly check for all the appropriate alignment-lowing 3671 // attributes --- but that would require duplicating a lot of 3672 // logic that just isn't worth duplicating for such a marginal 3673 // use-case. 3674 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(D)) { 3675 // Fast path this check, since we at least know the record has a 3676 // definition if we can find a member of it. 3677 if (!FD->getParent()->isCompleteDefinition()) { 3678 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_alignof_member_of_incomplete_type) 3679 << E->getSourceRange(); 3680 return true; 3681 } 3682 3683 // Otherwise, if it's a field, and the field doesn't have 3684 // reference type, then it must have a complete type (or be a 3685 // flexible array member, which we explicitly want to 3686 // white-list anyway), which makes the following checks trivial. 3687 if (!FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 3688 return false; 3689 } 3690 3691 return S.CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_AlignOf); 3692 } 3693 3694 bool Sema::CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E) { 3695 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 3696 3697 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent. 3698 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 3699 return false; 3700 3701 return CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_VecStep); 3702 } 3703 3704 /// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand. 3705 ExprResult 3706 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 3707 SourceLocation OpLoc, 3708 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, 3709 SourceRange R) { 3710 if (!TInfo) 3711 return ExprError(); 3712 3713 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 3714 3715 if (!T->isDependentType() && 3716 CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(T, OpLoc, R, ExprKind)) 3717 return ExprError(); 3718 3719 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t. 3720 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr( 3721 ExprKind, TInfo, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, R.getEnd()); 3722 } 3723 3724 /// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression 3725 /// operand. 3726 ExprResult 3727 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc, 3728 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3729 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 3730 if (PE.isInvalid()) 3731 return ExprError(); 3732 3733 E = PE.get(); 3734 3735 // Verify that the operand is valid. 3736 bool isInvalid = false; 3737 if (E->isTypeDependent()) { 3738 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions. 3739 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) { 3740 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E); 3741 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) { 3742 isInvalid = CheckVecStepExpr(E); 3743 } else if (E->refersToBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1. 3744 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0; 3745 isInvalid = true; 3746 } else { 3747 isInvalid = CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_SizeOf); 3748 } 3749 3750 if (isInvalid) 3751 return ExprError(); 3752 3753 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf && E->getType()->isVariableArrayType()) { 3754 PE = TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E); 3755 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3756 E = PE.get(); 3757 } 3758 3759 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t. 3760 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr( 3761 ExprKind, E, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, E->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 3762 } 3763 3764 /// ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c 3765 /// expr and the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof 3766 /// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false. 3767 ExprResult 3768 Sema::ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, 3769 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, bool IsType, 3770 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) { 3771 // If error parsing type, ignore. 3772 if (!TyOrEx) return ExprError(); 3773 3774 if (IsType) { 3775 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 3776 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo); 3777 return CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, ExprKind, ArgRange); 3778 } 3779 3780 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx; 3781 ExprResult Result = CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, ExprKind); 3782 return Result; 3783 } 3784 3785 static QualType CheckRealImagOperand(Sema &S, ExprResult &V, SourceLocation Loc, 3786 bool IsReal) { 3787 if (V.get()->isTypeDependent()) 3788 return S.Context.DependentTy; 3789 3790 // _Real and _Imag are only l-values for normal l-values. 3791 if (V.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary) { 3792 V = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(V.get()); 3793 if (V.isInvalid()) 3794 return QualType(); 3795 } 3796 3797 // These operators return the element type of a complex type. 3798 if (const ComplexType *CT = V.get()->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>()) 3799 return CT->getElementType(); 3800 3801 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here. 3802 if (V.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType()) 3803 return V.get()->getType(); 3804 3805 // Test for placeholders. 3806 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(V.get()); 3807 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 3808 if (PR.get() != V.get()) { 3809 V = PR; 3810 return CheckRealImagOperand(S, V, Loc, IsReal); 3811 } 3812 3813 // Reject anything else. 3814 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V.get()->getType() 3815 << (IsReal ? "__real" : "__imag"); 3816 return QualType(); 3817 } 3818 3819 3820 3821 ExprResult 3822 Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 3823 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) { 3824 UnaryOperatorKind Opc; 3825 switch (Kind) { 3826 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!"); 3827 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break; 3828 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break; 3829 } 3830 3831 // Since this might is a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 3832 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Input); 3833 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3834 Input = Result.get(); 3835 3836 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input); 3837 } 3838 3839 /// \brief Diagnose if arithmetic on the given ObjC pointer is illegal. 3840 /// 3841 /// \return true on error 3842 static bool checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(Sema &S, 3843 SourceLocation opLoc, 3844 Expr *op) { 3845 assert(op->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()); 3846 if (S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsPointerArithmetic() && 3847 !S.LangOpts.ObjCSubscriptingLegacyRuntime) 3848 return false; 3849 3850 S.Diag(opLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface) 3851 << op->getType()->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType() 3852 << op->getSourceRange(); 3853 return true; 3854 } 3855 3856 ExprResult 3857 Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *base, SourceLocation lbLoc, 3858 Expr *idx, SourceLocation rbLoc) { 3859 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 3860 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(base)) { 3861 ExprResult result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, base); 3862 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3863 base = result.get(); 3864 } 3865 3866 // Handle any non-overload placeholder types in the base and index 3867 // expressions. We can't handle overloads here because the other 3868 // operand might be an overloadable type, in which case the overload 3869 // resolution for the operator overload should get the first crack 3870 // at the overload. 3871 if (base->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 3872 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(base); 3873 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3874 base = result.get(); 3875 } 3876 if (idx->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 3877 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(idx); 3878 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3879 idx = result.get(); 3880 } 3881 3882 // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent. 3883 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3884 (base->isTypeDependent() || idx->isTypeDependent())) { 3885 return new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(base, idx, Context.DependentTy, 3886 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc); 3887 } 3888 3889 // Use C++ overloaded-operator rules if either operand has record 3890 // type. The spec says to do this if either type is *overloadable*, 3891 // but enum types can't declare subscript operators or conversion 3892 // operators, so there's nothing interesting for overload resolution 3893 // to do if there aren't any record types involved. 3894 // 3895 // ObjC pointers have their own subscripting logic that is not tied 3896 // to overload resolution and so should not take this path. 3897 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3898 (base->getType()->isRecordType() || 3899 (!base->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 3900 idx->getType()->isRecordType()))) { 3901 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(lbLoc, rbLoc, base, idx); 3902 } 3903 3904 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, rbLoc); 3905 } 3906 3907 ExprResult 3908 Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc, 3909 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) { 3910 Expr *LHSExp = Base; 3911 Expr *RHSExp = Idx; 3912 3913 // Perform default conversions. 3914 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) { 3915 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp); 3916 if (Result.isInvalid()) 3917 return ExprError(); 3918 LHSExp = Result.get(); 3919 } 3920 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp); 3921 if (Result.isInvalid()) 3922 return ExprError(); 3923 RHSExp = Result.get(); 3924 3925 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType(); 3926 ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue; 3927 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 3928 3929 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent 3930 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be 3931 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base 3932 // and index from the expression types. 3933 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr; 3934 QualType ResultType; 3935 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) { 3936 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 3937 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 3938 ResultType = Context.DependentTy; 3939 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3940 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 3941 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 3942 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 3943 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = 3944 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3945 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 3946 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 3947 3948 // Use custom logic if this should be the pseudo-object subscript 3949 // expression. 3950 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) 3951 return BuildObjCSubscriptExpression(RLoc, BaseExpr, IndexExpr, nullptr, 3952 nullptr); 3953 3954 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 3955 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3956 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]". 3957 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 3958 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 3959 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 3960 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = 3961 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3962 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]". 3963 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 3964 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 3965 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 3966 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) { 3967 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface) 3968 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 3969 return ExprError(); 3970 } 3971 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) { 3972 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123] 3973 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 3974 VK = LHSExp->getValueKind(); 3975 if (VK != VK_RValue) 3976 OK = OK_VectorComponent; 3977 3978 // FIXME: need to deal with const... 3979 ResultType = VTy->getElementType(); 3980 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) { 3981 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by 3982 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that 3983 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't 3984 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then 3985 // force the promotion here. 3986 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) << 3987 LHSExp->getSourceRange(); 3988 LHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy), 3989 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 3990 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(); 3991 3992 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 3993 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 3994 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 3995 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) { 3996 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case 3997 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) << 3998 RHSExp->getSourceRange(); 3999 RHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy), 4000 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 4001 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType(); 4002 4003 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 4004 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 4005 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 4006 } else { 4007 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value) 4008 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange()); 4009 } 4010 // C99 6.5.2.1p1 4011 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) 4012 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer) 4013 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange()); 4014 4015 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) || 4016 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U)) 4017 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) 4018 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange(); 4019 4020 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly, 4021 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object 4022 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance) 4023 // incomplete types are not object types. 4024 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) { 4025 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type) 4026 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4027 return ExprError(); 4028 } 4029 4030 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4031 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void 4032 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_subscript_void_type) 4033 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4034 4035 // C forbids expressions of unqualified void type from being l-values. 4036 // See IsCForbiddenLValueType. 4037 if (!ResultType.hasQualifiers()) VK = VK_RValue; 4038 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && 4039 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType, 4040 diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type, BaseExpr)) 4041 return ExprError(); 4042 4043 assert(VK == VK_RValue || LangOpts.CPlusPlus || 4044 !ResultType.isCForbiddenLValueType()); 4045 4046 return new (Context) 4047 ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp, ResultType, VK, OK, RLoc); 4048 } 4049 4050 ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc, 4051 FunctionDecl *FD, 4052 ParmVarDecl *Param) { 4053 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) { 4054 Diag(CallLoc, 4055 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) << 4056 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName(); 4057 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param], 4058 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here); 4059 return ExprError(); 4060 } 4061 4062 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) { 4063 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg(); 4064 4065 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(*this, PotentiallyEvaluated, 4066 Param); 4067 4068 // Instantiate the expression. 4069 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList MutiLevelArgList 4070 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, nullptr, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true); 4071 4072 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, 4073 MutiLevelArgList.getInnermost()); 4074 if (Inst.isInvalid()) 4075 return ExprError(); 4076 4077 ExprResult Result; 4078 { 4079 // C++ [dcl.fct.default]p5: 4080 // The names in the [default argument] expression are bound, and 4081 // the semantic constraints are checked, at the point where the 4082 // default argument expression appears. 4083 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, FD); 4084 LocalInstantiationScope Local(*this); 4085 Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, MutiLevelArgList); 4086 } 4087 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4088 return ExprError(); 4089 4090 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter. 4091 InitializedEntity Entity 4092 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param); 4093 InitializationKind Kind 4094 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(), 4095 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getLocStart()); 4096 Expr *ResultE = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 4097 4098 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE); 4099 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE); 4100 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4101 return ExprError(); 4102 4103 Expr *Arg = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 4104 CheckCompletedExpr(Arg, Param->getOuterLocStart()); 4105 // Build the default argument expression. 4106 return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param, Arg); 4107 } 4108 4109 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to 4110 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll 4111 // be properly destroyed. 4112 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new 4113 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810. 4114 // We don't need to do that with block decls, though, because 4115 // blocks in default argument expression can never capture anything. 4116 if (isa<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())) { 4117 // Set the "needs cleanups" bit regardless of whether there are 4118 // any explicit objects. 4119 ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 4120 4121 // Append all the objects to the cleanup list. Right now, this 4122 // should always be a no-op, because blocks in default argument 4123 // expressions should never be able to capture anything. 4124 assert(!cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())->getNumObjects() && 4125 "default argument expression has capturing blocks?"); 4126 } 4127 4128 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works. 4129 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression 4130 // as being "referenced". 4131 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg(), 4132 /*SkipLocalVariables=*/true); 4133 return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param); 4134 } 4135 4136 4137 Sema::VariadicCallType 4138 Sema::getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4139 Expr *Fn) { 4140 if (Proto && Proto->isVariadic()) { 4141 if (dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(FDecl)) 4142 return VariadicConstructor; 4143 else if (Fn && Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) 4144 return VariadicBlock; 4145 else if (FDecl) { 4146 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl)) 4147 if (Method->isInstance()) 4148 return VariadicMethod; 4149 } else if (Fn && Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) 4150 return VariadicMethod; 4151 return VariadicFunction; 4152 } 4153 return VariadicDoesNotApply; 4154 } 4155 4156 namespace { 4157 class FunctionCallCCC : public FunctionCallFilterCCC { 4158 public: 4159 FunctionCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, const IdentifierInfo *FuncName, 4160 unsigned NumArgs, MemberExpr *ME) 4161 : FunctionCallFilterCCC(SemaRef, NumArgs, false, ME), 4162 FunctionName(FuncName) {} 4163 4164 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 4165 if (!candidate.getCorrectionSpecifier() || 4166 candidate.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo() != FunctionName) { 4167 return false; 4168 } 4169 4170 return FunctionCallFilterCCC::ValidateCandidate(candidate); 4171 } 4172 4173 private: 4174 const IdentifierInfo *const FunctionName; 4175 }; 4176 } 4177 4178 static TypoCorrection TryTypoCorrectionForCall(Sema &S, Expr *Fn, 4179 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4180 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 4181 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn); 4182 DeclarationName FuncName = FDecl->getDeclName(); 4183 SourceLocation NameLoc = ME ? ME->getMemberLoc() : Fn->getLocStart(); 4184 4185 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = S.CorrectTypo( 4186 DeclarationNameInfo(FuncName, NameLoc), Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, 4187 S.getScopeForContext(S.CurContext), nullptr, 4188 llvm::make_unique<FunctionCallCCC>(S, FuncName.getAsIdentifierInfo(), 4189 Args.size(), ME), 4190 Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 4191 if (NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()) { 4192 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) { 4193 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(NameLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 4194 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4195 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CD = Corrected.begin(), 4196 CDEnd = Corrected.end(); 4197 CD != CDEnd; ++CD) { 4198 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CD)) 4199 S.AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), Args, 4200 OCS); 4201 } 4202 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, NameLoc, Best)) { 4203 case OR_Success: 4204 ND = Best->Function; 4205 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 4206 break; 4207 default: 4208 break; 4209 } 4210 } 4211 if (isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND)) { 4212 return Corrected; 4213 } 4214 } 4215 } 4216 return TypoCorrection(); 4217 } 4218 4219 /// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in 4220 /// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with 4221 /// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and 4222 /// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this 4223 /// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns 4224 /// true if the call is ill-formed. 4225 bool 4226 Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn, 4227 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4228 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4229 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 4230 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 4231 bool IsExecConfig) { 4232 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking. 4233 // We don't need to do this in the 4234 if (FDecl) 4235 if (unsigned ID = FDecl->getBuiltinID()) 4236 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(ID)) 4237 return false; 4238 4239 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by 4240 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ... 4241 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 4242 bool Invalid = false; 4243 unsigned MinArgs = FDecl ? FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments() : NumParams; 4244 unsigned FnKind = Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType() 4245 ? 1 /* block */ 4246 : (IsExecConfig ? 3 /* kernel function (exec config) */ 4247 : 0 /* function */); 4248 4249 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default 4250 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call. 4251 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 4252 if (Args.size() < MinArgs) { 4253 TypoCorrection TC; 4254 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) { 4255 unsigned diag_id = 4256 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4257 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_suggest 4258 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_suggest; 4259 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << MinArgs 4260 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4261 << TC.getCorrectionRange()); 4262 } else if (MinArgs == 1 && FDecl && FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 4263 Diag(RParenLoc, 4264 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4265 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_one 4266 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_one) 4267 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) << Fn->getSourceRange(); 4268 else 4269 Diag(RParenLoc, MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4270 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args 4271 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least) 4272 << FnKind << MinArgs << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4273 << Fn->getSourceRange(); 4274 4275 // Emit the location of the prototype. 4276 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig) 4277 Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl) 4278 << FDecl; 4279 4280 return true; 4281 } 4282 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams); 4283 } 4284 4285 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop 4286 // them. 4287 if (Args.size() > NumParams) { 4288 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) { 4289 TypoCorrection TC; 4290 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) { 4291 unsigned diag_id = 4292 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4293 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_suggest 4294 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_suggest; 4295 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << NumParams 4296 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4297 << TC.getCorrectionRange()); 4298 } else if (NumParams == 1 && FDecl && 4299 FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 4300 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4301 MinArgs == NumParams 4302 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_one 4303 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_one) 4304 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) 4305 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) << Fn->getSourceRange() 4306 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4307 Args.back()->getLocEnd()); 4308 else 4309 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4310 MinArgs == NumParams 4311 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args 4312 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most) 4313 << FnKind << NumParams << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4314 << Fn->getSourceRange() 4315 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4316 Args.back()->getLocEnd()); 4317 4318 // Emit the location of the prototype. 4319 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig) 4320 Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl) 4321 << FDecl; 4322 4323 // This deletes the extra arguments. 4324 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams); 4325 return true; 4326 } 4327 } 4328 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs; 4329 VariadicCallType CallType = getVariadicCallType(FDecl, Proto, Fn); 4330 4331 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getLocStart(), FDecl, 4332 Proto, 0, Args, AllArgs, CallType); 4333 if (Invalid) 4334 return true; 4335 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size(); 4336 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i) 4337 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]); 4338 4339 return false; 4340 } 4341 4342 bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4343 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4344 unsigned FirstParam, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 4345 SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &AllArgs, 4346 VariadicCallType CallType, bool AllowExplicit, 4347 bool IsListInitialization) { 4348 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 4349 bool Invalid = false; 4350 unsigned ArgIx = 0; 4351 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args). 4352 for (unsigned i = FirstParam; i < NumParams; i++) { 4353 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getParamType(i); 4354 4355 Expr *Arg; 4356 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl ? FDecl->getParamDecl(i) : nullptr; 4357 if (ArgIx < Args.size()) { 4358 Arg = Args[ArgIx++]; 4359 4360 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(), 4361 ProtoArgType, 4362 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg)) 4363 return true; 4364 4365 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable. 4366 bool CFAudited = false; 4367 if (Arg->getType() == Context.ARCUnbridgedCastTy && 4368 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() && 4369 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())) 4370 Arg = stripARCUnbridgedCast(Arg); 4371 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 4372 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() && 4373 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())) 4374 CFAudited = true; 4375 4376 InitializedEntity Entity = 4377 Param ? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param, 4378 ProtoArgType) 4379 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 4380 Context, ProtoArgType, Proto->isParamConsumed(i)); 4381 4382 // Remember that parameter belongs to a CF audited API. 4383 if (CFAudited) 4384 Entity.setParameterCFAudited(); 4385 4386 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization( 4387 Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg, IsListInitialization, AllowExplicit); 4388 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 4389 return true; 4390 4391 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 4392 } else { 4393 assert(Param && "can't use default arguments without a known callee"); 4394 4395 ExprResult ArgExpr = 4396 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param); 4397 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid()) 4398 return true; 4399 4400 Arg = ArgExpr.getAs<Expr>(); 4401 } 4402 4403 // Check for array bounds violations for each argument to the call. This 4404 // check only triggers warnings when the argument isn't a more complex Expr 4405 // with its own checking, such as a BinaryOperator. 4406 CheckArrayAccess(Arg); 4407 4408 // Check for violations of C99 static array rules (C99 6.7.5.3p7). 4409 CheckStaticArrayArgument(CallLoc, Param, Arg); 4410 4411 AllArgs.push_back(Arg); 4412 } 4413 4414 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 4415 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) { 4416 // Assume that extern "C" functions with variadic arguments that 4417 // return __unknown_anytype aren't *really* variadic. 4418 if (Proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && FDecl && 4419 FDecl->isExternC()) { 4420 for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) { 4421 QualType paramType; // ignored 4422 ExprResult arg = checkUnknownAnyArg(CallLoc, Args[i], paramType); 4423 Invalid |= arg.isInvalid(); 4424 AllArgs.push_back(arg.get()); 4425 } 4426 4427 // Otherwise do argument promotion, (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 4428 } else { 4429 for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) { 4430 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], CallType, 4431 FDecl); 4432 Invalid |= Arg.isInvalid(); 4433 AllArgs.push_back(Arg.get()); 4434 } 4435 } 4436 4437 // Check for array bounds violations. 4438 for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) 4439 CheckArrayAccess(Args[i]); 4440 } 4441 return Invalid; 4442 } 4443 4444 static void DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(Sema &S, ParmVarDecl *PVD) { 4445 TypeLoc TL = PVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc(); 4446 if (DecayedTypeLoc DTL = TL.getAs<DecayedTypeLoc>()) 4447 TL = DTL.getOriginalLoc(); 4448 if (ArrayTypeLoc ATL = TL.getAs<ArrayTypeLoc>()) 4449 S.Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_static_array) 4450 << ATL.getLocalSourceRange(); 4451 } 4452 4453 /// CheckStaticArrayArgument - If the given argument corresponds to a static 4454 /// array parameter, check that it is non-null, and that if it is formed by 4455 /// array-to-pointer decay, the underlying array is sufficiently large. 4456 /// 4457 /// C99 6.7.5.3p7: If the keyword static also appears within the [ and ] of the 4458 /// array type derivation, then for each call to the function, the value of the 4459 /// corresponding actual argument shall provide access to the first element of 4460 /// an array with at least as many elements as specified by the size expression. 4461 void 4462 Sema::CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc, 4463 ParmVarDecl *Param, 4464 const Expr *ArgExpr) { 4465 // Static array parameters are not supported in C++. 4466 if (!Param || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4467 return; 4468 4469 QualType OrigTy = Param->getOriginalType(); 4470 4471 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy); 4472 if (!AT || AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Static) 4473 return; 4474 4475 if (ArgExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 4476 Expr::NPC_NeverValueDependent)) { 4477 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_null_arg) << ArgExpr->getSourceRange(); 4478 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 4479 return; 4480 } 4481 4482 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT); 4483 if (!CAT) 4484 return; 4485 4486 const ConstantArrayType *ArgCAT = 4487 Context.getAsConstantArrayType(ArgExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType()); 4488 if (!ArgCAT) 4489 return; 4490 4491 if (ArgCAT->getSize().ult(CAT->getSize())) { 4492 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small) 4493 << ArgExpr->getSourceRange() 4494 << (unsigned) ArgCAT->getSize().getZExtValue() 4495 << (unsigned) CAT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 4496 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 4497 } 4498 } 4499 4500 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it 4501 /// to have a function type. 4502 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *fn); 4503 4504 /// Is the given type a placeholder that we need to lower out 4505 /// immediately during argument processing? 4506 static bool isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(QualType type) { 4507 // Placeholders are never sugared. 4508 const BuiltinType *placeholder = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(type); 4509 if (!placeholder) return false; 4510 4511 switch (placeholder->getKind()) { 4512 // Ignore all the non-placeholder types. 4513 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) 4514 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) case BuiltinType::ID: 4515 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 4516 return false; 4517 4518 // We cannot lower out overload sets; they might validly be resolved 4519 // by the call machinery. 4520 case BuiltinType::Overload: 4521 return false; 4522 4523 // Unbridged casts in ARC can be handled in some call positions and 4524 // should be left in place. 4525 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: 4526 return false; 4527 4528 // Pseudo-objects should be converted as soon as possible. 4529 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject: 4530 return true; 4531 4532 // The debugger mode could theoretically but currently does not try 4533 // to resolve unknown-typed arguments based on known parameter types. 4534 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny: 4535 return true; 4536 4537 // These are always invalid as call arguments and should be reported. 4538 case BuiltinType::BoundMember: 4539 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: 4540 return true; 4541 } 4542 llvm_unreachable("bad builtin type kind"); 4543 } 4544 4545 /// Check an argument list for placeholders that we won't try to 4546 /// handle later. 4547 static bool checkArgsForPlaceholders(Sema &S, MultiExprArg args) { 4548 // Apply this processing to all the arguments at once instead of 4549 // dying at the first failure. 4550 bool hasInvalid = false; 4551 for (size_t i = 0, e = args.size(); i != e; i++) { 4552 if (isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(args[i]->getType())) { 4553 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(args[i]); 4554 if (result.isInvalid()) hasInvalid = true; 4555 else args[i] = result.get(); 4556 } else if (hasInvalid) { 4557 (void)S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(args[i]); 4558 } 4559 } 4560 return hasInvalid; 4561 } 4562 4563 /// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments. 4564 /// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma 4565 /// locations. 4566 ExprResult 4567 Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 4568 MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc, 4569 Expr *ExecConfig, bool IsExecConfig) { 4570 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 4571 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn); 4572 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4573 Fn = Result.get(); 4574 4575 if (checkArgsForPlaceholders(*this, ArgExprs)) 4576 return ExprError(); 4577 4578 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4579 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately. 4580 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) { 4581 if (!ArgExprs.empty()) { 4582 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments. 4583 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args) 4584 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 4585 SourceRange(ArgExprs[0]->getLocStart(), 4586 ArgExprs.back()->getLocEnd())); 4587 } 4588 4589 return new (Context) 4590 CallExpr(Context, Fn, None, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 4591 } 4592 if (Fn->getType() == Context.PseudoObjectTy) { 4593 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Fn); 4594 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4595 Fn = result.get(); 4596 } 4597 4598 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template, 4599 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now. 4600 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in 4601 // Fn. 4602 bool Dependent = false; 4603 if (Fn->isTypeDependent()) 4604 Dependent = true; 4605 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs)) 4606 Dependent = true; 4607 4608 if (Dependent) { 4609 if (ExecConfig) { 4610 return new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr( 4611 Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(ExecConfig), ArgExprs, 4612 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 4613 } else { 4614 return new (Context) CallExpr( 4615 Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 4616 } 4617 } 4618 4619 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]). 4620 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType()) 4621 return BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 4622 RParenLoc); 4623 4624 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 4625 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 4626 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4627 Fn = result.get(); 4628 } 4629 4630 if (Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) { 4631 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc); 4632 } 4633 } 4634 4635 // Check for overloaded calls. This can happen even in C due to extensions. 4636 if (Fn->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) { 4637 OverloadExpr::FindResult find = OverloadExpr::find(Fn); 4638 4639 // We aren't supposed to apply this logic for if there's an '&' involved. 4640 if (!find.HasFormOfMemberPointer) { 4641 OverloadExpr *ovl = find.Expression; 4642 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl)) { 4643 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl); 4644 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 4645 RParenLoc, ExecConfig); 4646 } else { 4647 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 4648 RParenLoc); 4649 } 4650 } 4651 } 4652 4653 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration. 4654 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 4655 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 4656 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4657 Fn = result.get(); 4658 } 4659 4660 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens(); 4661 4662 NamedDecl *NDecl = nullptr; 4663 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn)) 4664 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf) 4665 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 4666 4667 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)) 4668 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl(); 4669 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) 4670 NDecl = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)->getMemberDecl(); 4671 4672 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl)) { 4673 if (FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>()) { 4674 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = CheckEnableIf(FD, ArgExprs, true)) { 4675 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), 4676 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) ? 4677 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call : 4678 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 4679 << FD << FD->getSourceRange(); 4680 Diag(FD->getLocation(), 4681 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) 4682 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 4683 } 4684 } 4685 } 4686 4687 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, 4688 ExecConfig, IsExecConfig); 4689 } 4690 4691 /// ActOnAsTypeExpr - create a new asType (bitcast) from the arguments. 4692 /// 4693 /// __builtin_astype( value, dst type ) 4694 /// 4695 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, 4696 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 4697 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 4698 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 4699 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 4700 QualType DstTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy); 4701 QualType SrcTy = E->getType(); 4702 if (Context.getTypeSize(DstTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy)) 4703 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, 4704 diag::err_invalid_astype_of_different_size) 4705 << DstTy 4706 << SrcTy 4707 << E->getSourceRange()); 4708 return new (Context) AsTypeExpr(E, DstTy, VK, OK, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 4709 } 4710 4711 /// ActOnConvertVectorExpr - create a new convert-vector expression from the 4712 /// provided arguments. 4713 /// 4714 /// __builtin_convertvector( value, dst type ) 4715 /// 4716 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, 4717 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 4718 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 4719 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 4720 GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy, &TInfo); 4721 return SemaConvertVectorExpr(E, TInfo, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 4722 } 4723 4724 /// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression, 4725 /// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should 4726 /// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or 4727 /// block-pointer type. 4728 /// 4729 /// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available 4730 ExprResult 4731 Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl, 4732 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 4733 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 4734 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 4735 Expr *Config, bool IsExecConfig) { 4736 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl); 4737 unsigned BuiltinID = (FDecl ? FDecl->getBuiltinID() : 0); 4738 4739 // Promote the function operand. 4740 // We special-case function promotion here because we only allow promoting 4741 // builtin functions to function pointers in the callee of a call. 4742 ExprResult Result; 4743 if (BuiltinID && 4744 Fn->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::BuiltinFn)) { 4745 Result = ImpCastExprToType(Fn, Context.getPointerType(FDecl->getType()), 4746 CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get(); 4747 } else { 4748 Result = CallExprUnaryConversions(Fn); 4749 } 4750 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4751 return ExprError(); 4752 Fn = Result.get(); 4753 4754 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup 4755 // of arguments and function on error. 4756 CallExpr *TheCall; 4757 if (Config) 4758 TheCall = new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr(Context, Fn, 4759 cast<CallExpr>(Config), Args, 4760 Context.BoolTy, VK_RValue, 4761 RParenLoc); 4762 else 4763 TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, Context.BoolTy, 4764 VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 4765 4766 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking. 4767 if (BuiltinID && Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID)) 4768 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall); 4769 4770 retry: 4771 const FunctionType *FuncT; 4772 if (const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4773 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall 4774 // have type pointer to function". 4775 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 4776 if (!FuncT) 4777 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function) 4778 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4779 } else if (const BlockPointerType *BPT = 4780 Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 4781 FuncT = BPT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 4782 } else { 4783 // Handle calls to expressions of unknown-any type. 4784 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 4785 ExprResult rewrite = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 4786 if (rewrite.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4787 Fn = rewrite.get(); 4788 TheCall->setCallee(Fn); 4789 goto retry; 4790 } 4791 4792 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function) 4793 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4794 } 4795 4796 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 4797 if (Config) { 4798 // CUDA: Kernel calls must be to global functions 4799 if (FDecl && !FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) 4800 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc,diag::err_kern_call_not_global_function) 4801 << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4802 4803 // CUDA: Kernel function must have 'void' return type 4804 if (!FuncT->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) 4805 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_kern_type_not_void_return) 4806 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4807 } else { 4808 // CUDA: Calls to global functions must be configured 4809 if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) 4810 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_global_call_not_config) 4811 << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4812 } 4813 } 4814 4815 // Check for a valid return type 4816 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getReturnType(), Fn->getLocStart(), TheCall, 4817 FDecl)) 4818 return ExprError(); 4819 4820 // We know the result type of the call, set it. 4821 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context)); 4822 TheCall->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(FuncT->getReturnType())); 4823 4824 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT); 4825 if (Proto) { 4826 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, RParenLoc, 4827 IsExecConfig)) 4828 return ExprError(); 4829 } else { 4830 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!"); 4831 4832 if (FDecl) { 4833 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based 4834 // on our knowledge of the function definition. 4835 const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; 4836 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && Args.size() != Def->param_size()) { 4837 Proto = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4838 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && Args.size() >= Def->param_size())) 4839 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments) 4840 << (Args.size() > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange(); 4841 } 4842 4843 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have 4844 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype. 4845 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype()) 4846 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4847 } 4848 4849 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6). 4850 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; i++) { 4851 Expr *Arg = Args[i]; 4852 4853 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumParams()) { 4854 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 4855 Context, Proto->getParamType(i), Proto->isParamConsumed(i)); 4856 ExprResult ArgE = 4857 PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg); 4858 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 4859 return true; 4860 4861 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 4862 4863 } else { 4864 ExprResult ArgE = DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg); 4865 4866 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 4867 return true; 4868 4869 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 4870 } 4871 4872 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(), 4873 Arg->getType(), 4874 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg)) 4875 return ExprError(); 4876 4877 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg); 4878 } 4879 } 4880 4881 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl)) 4882 if (!Method->isStatic()) 4883 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) 4884 << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4885 4886 // Check for sentinels 4887 if (NDecl) 4888 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args); 4889 4890 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions. 4891 if (FDecl) { 4892 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall, Proto)) 4893 return ExprError(); 4894 4895 if (BuiltinID) 4896 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall); 4897 } else if (NDecl) { 4898 if (CheckPointerCall(NDecl, TheCall, Proto)) 4899 return ExprError(); 4900 } else { 4901 if (CheckOtherCall(TheCall, Proto)) 4902 return ExprError(); 4903 } 4904 4905 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 4906 } 4907 4908 ExprResult 4909 Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty, 4910 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) { 4911 assert(Ty && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type"); 4912 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out. 4913 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression"); 4914 4915 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 4916 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo); 4917 if (!TInfo) 4918 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType); 4919 4920 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr); 4921 } 4922 4923 ExprResult 4924 Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 4925 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *LiteralExpr) { 4926 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType(); 4927 4928 if (literalType->isArrayType()) { 4929 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType), 4930 diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type, 4931 SourceRange(LParenLoc, 4932 LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()))) 4933 return ExprError(); 4934 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType()) 4935 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init) 4936 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())); 4937 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() && 4938 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType, 4939 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type, 4940 SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()))) 4941 return ExprError(); 4942 4943 InitializedEntity Entity 4944 = InitializedEntity::InitializeCompoundLiteralInit(TInfo); 4945 InitializationKind Kind 4946 = InitializationKind::CreateCStyleCast(LParenLoc, 4947 SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), 4948 /*InitList=*/true); 4949 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr); 4950 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr, 4951 &literalType); 4952 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4953 return ExprError(); 4954 LiteralExpr = Result.get(); 4955 4956 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == nullptr; 4957 if (isFileScope && 4958 !LiteralExpr->isTypeDependent() && 4959 !LiteralExpr->isValueDependent() && 4960 !literalType->isDependentType()) { // 6.5.2.5p3 4961 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(LiteralExpr, literalType)) 4962 return ExprError(); 4963 } 4964 4965 // In C, compound literals are l-values for some reason. 4966 ExprValueKind VK = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue; 4967 4968 return MaybeBindToTemporary( 4969 new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType, 4970 VK, LiteralExpr, isFileScope)); 4971 } 4972 4973 ExprResult 4974 Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList, 4975 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) { 4976 // Immediately handle non-overload placeholders. Overloads can be 4977 // resolved contextually, but everything else here can't. 4978 for (unsigned I = 0, E = InitArgList.size(); I != E; ++I) { 4979 if (InitArgList[I]->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4980 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(InitArgList[I]); 4981 4982 // Ignore failures; dropping the entire initializer list because 4983 // of one failure would be terrible for indexing/etc. 4984 if (result.isInvalid()) continue; 4985 4986 InitArgList[I] = result.get(); 4987 } 4988 } 4989 4990 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and 4991 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized. 4992 4993 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitArgList, 4994 RBraceLoc); 4995 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now. 4996 return E; 4997 } 4998 4999 /// Do an explicit extend of the given block pointer if we're in ARC. 5000 static void maybeExtendBlockObject(Sema &S, ExprResult &E) { 5001 assert(E.get()->getType()->isBlockPointerType()); 5002 assert(E.get()->isRValue()); 5003 5004 // Only do this in an r-value context. 5005 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) return; 5006 5007 E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(S.Context, E.get()->getType(), 5008 CK_ARCExtendBlockObject, E.get(), 5009 /*base path*/ nullptr, VK_RValue); 5010 S.ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 5011 } 5012 5013 /// Prepare a conversion of the given expression to an ObjC object 5014 /// pointer type. 5015 CastKind Sema::PrepareCastToObjCObjectPointer(ExprResult &E) { 5016 QualType type = E.get()->getType(); 5017 if (type->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 5018 return CK_BitCast; 5019 } else if (type->isBlockPointerType()) { 5020 maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, E); 5021 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 5022 } else { 5023 assert(type->isPointerType()); 5024 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 5025 } 5026 } 5027 5028 /// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages 5029 /// except the final cast and returning the kind required. 5030 CastKind Sema::PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult &Src, QualType DestTy) { 5031 // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer. 5032 // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with 5033 // pointers. Everything else should be possible. 5034 5035 QualType SrcTy = Src.get()->getType(); 5036 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy)) 5037 return CK_NoOp; 5038 5039 switch (Type::ScalarTypeKind SrcKind = SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5040 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5041 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5042 5043 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5044 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5045 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5046 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5047 case Type::STK_CPointer: { 5048 unsigned SrcAS = SrcTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 5049 unsigned DestAS = DestTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 5050 if (SrcAS != DestAS) 5051 return CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 5052 return CK_BitCast; 5053 } 5054 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5055 return (SrcKind == Type::STK_BlockPointer 5056 ? CK_BitCast : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 5057 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5058 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer) 5059 return CK_BitCast; 5060 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_CPointer) 5061 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 5062 maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, Src); 5063 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 5064 case Type::STK_Bool: 5065 return CK_PointerToBoolean; 5066 case Type::STK_Integral: 5067 return CK_PointerToIntegral; 5068 case Type::STK_Floating: 5069 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5070 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5071 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5072 llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer"); 5073 } 5074 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5075 5076 case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer 5077 case Type::STK_Integral: 5078 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5079 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5080 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5081 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5082 if (Src.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 5083 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 5084 return CK_NullToPointer; 5085 return CK_IntegralToPointer; 5086 case Type::STK_Bool: 5087 return CK_IntegralToBoolean; 5088 case Type::STK_Integral: 5089 return CK_IntegralCast; 5090 case Type::STK_Floating: 5091 return CK_IntegralToFloating; 5092 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5093 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5094 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5095 CK_IntegralCast); 5096 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex; 5097 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5098 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5099 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5100 CK_IntegralToFloating); 5101 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex; 5102 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5103 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5104 } 5105 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5106 5107 case Type::STK_Floating: 5108 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5109 case Type::STK_Floating: 5110 return CK_FloatingCast; 5111 case Type::STK_Bool: 5112 return CK_FloatingToBoolean; 5113 case Type::STK_Integral: 5114 return CK_FloatingToIntegral; 5115 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5116 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5117 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5118 CK_FloatingCast); 5119 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex; 5120 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5121 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5122 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5123 CK_FloatingToIntegral); 5124 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex; 5125 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5126 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5127 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5128 llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?"); 5129 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5130 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5131 } 5132 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5133 5134 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5135 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5136 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5137 return CK_FloatingComplexCast; 5138 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5139 return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex; 5140 case Type::STK_Floating: { 5141 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(); 5142 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy)) 5143 return CK_FloatingComplexToReal; 5144 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_FloatingComplexToReal); 5145 return CK_FloatingCast; 5146 } 5147 case Type::STK_Bool: 5148 return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean; 5149 case Type::STK_Integral: 5150 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5151 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5152 CK_FloatingComplexToReal); 5153 return CK_FloatingToIntegral; 5154 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5155 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5156 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5157 llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?"); 5158 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5159 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5160 } 5161 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5162 5163 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5164 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5165 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5166 return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex; 5167 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5168 return CK_IntegralComplexCast; 5169 case Type::STK_Integral: { 5170 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(); 5171 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy)) 5172 return CK_IntegralComplexToReal; 5173 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_IntegralComplexToReal); 5174 return CK_IntegralCast; 5175 } 5176 case Type::STK_Bool: 5177 return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean; 5178 case Type::STK_Floating: 5179 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5180 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5181 CK_IntegralComplexToReal); 5182 return CK_IntegralToFloating; 5183 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5184 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5185 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5186 llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?"); 5187 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5188 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5189 } 5190 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5191 } 5192 5193 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast"); 5194 } 5195 5196 static bool breakDownVectorType(QualType type, uint64_t &len, 5197 QualType &eltType) { 5198 // Vectors are simple. 5199 if (const VectorType *vecType = type->getAs<VectorType>()) { 5200 len = vecType->getNumElements(); 5201 eltType = vecType->getElementType(); 5202 assert(eltType->isScalarType()); 5203 return true; 5204 } 5205 5206 // We allow lax conversion to and from non-vector types, but only if 5207 // they're real types (i.e. non-complex, non-pointer scalar types). 5208 if (!type->isRealType()) return false; 5209 5210 len = 1; 5211 eltType = type; 5212 return true; 5213 } 5214 5215 static bool VectorTypesMatch(Sema &S, QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) { 5216 uint64_t srcLen, destLen; 5217 QualType srcElt, destElt; 5218 if (!breakDownVectorType(srcTy, srcLen, srcElt)) return false; 5219 if (!breakDownVectorType(destTy, destLen, destElt)) return false; 5220 5221 // ASTContext::getTypeSize will return the size rounded up to a 5222 // power of 2, so instead of using that, we need to use the raw 5223 // element size multiplied by the element count. 5224 uint64_t srcEltSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(srcElt); 5225 uint64_t destEltSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(destElt); 5226 5227 return (srcLen * srcEltSize == destLen * destEltSize); 5228 } 5229 5230 /// Is this a legal conversion between two known vector types? 5231 bool Sema::isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) { 5232 assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType()); 5233 5234 if (!Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions) 5235 return false; 5236 return VectorTypesMatch(*this, srcTy, destTy); 5237 } 5238 5239 bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty, 5240 CastKind &Kind) { 5241 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!"); 5242 5243 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) { 5244 if (!VectorTypesMatch(*this, Ty, VectorTy)) 5245 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 5246 Ty->isVectorType() ? 5247 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors : 5248 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer) 5249 << VectorTy << Ty << R; 5250 } else 5251 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 5252 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar) 5253 << VectorTy << Ty << R; 5254 5255 Kind = CK_BitCast; 5256 return false; 5257 } 5258 5259 ExprResult Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, 5260 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &Kind) { 5261 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!"); 5262 5263 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType(); 5264 5265 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to 5266 // an ExtVectorType. 5267 // In OpenCL, casts between vectors of different types are not allowed. 5268 // (See OpenCL 6.2). 5269 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) { 5270 if (!VectorTypesMatch(*this, SrcTy, DestTy) 5271 || (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 5272 (DestTy.getCanonicalType() != SrcTy.getCanonicalType()))) { 5273 Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors) 5274 << DestTy << SrcTy << R; 5275 return ExprError(); 5276 } 5277 Kind = CK_BitCast; 5278 return CastExpr; 5279 } 5280 5281 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate 5282 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then 5283 // splat from elt type to vector. 5284 if (SrcTy->isPointerType()) 5285 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 5286 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar) 5287 << DestTy << SrcTy << R; 5288 5289 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 5290 ExprResult CastExprRes = CastExpr; 5291 CastKind CK = PrepareScalarCast(CastExprRes, DestElemTy); 5292 if (CastExprRes.isInvalid()) 5293 return ExprError(); 5294 CastExpr = ImpCastExprToType(CastExprRes.get(), DestElemTy, CK).get(); 5295 5296 Kind = CK_VectorSplat; 5297 return CastExpr; 5298 } 5299 5300 ExprResult 5301 Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5302 Declarator &D, ParsedType &Ty, 5303 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr) { 5304 assert(!D.isInvalidType() && (CastExpr != nullptr) && 5305 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr"); 5306 5307 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo = GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(D, CastExpr->getType()); 5308 if (D.isInvalidType()) 5309 return ExprError(); 5310 5311 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5312 // Check that there are no default arguments (C++ only). 5313 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 5314 } else { 5315 // Make sure any TypoExprs have been dealt with. 5316 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CastExpr); 5317 if (!Res.isUsable()) 5318 return ExprError(); 5319 CastExpr = Res.get(); 5320 } 5321 5322 checkUnusedDeclAttributes(D); 5323 5324 QualType castType = castTInfo->getType(); 5325 Ty = CreateParsedType(castType, castTInfo); 5326 5327 bool isVectorLiteral = false; 5328 5329 // Check for an altivec or OpenCL literal, 5330 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants. 5331 ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(CastExpr); 5332 ParenListExpr *PLE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr); 5333 if ((getLangOpts().AltiVec || getLangOpts().OpenCL) 5334 && castType->isVectorType() && (PE || PLE)) { 5335 if (PLE && PLE->getNumExprs() == 0) { 5336 Diag(PLE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer); 5337 return ExprError(); 5338 } 5339 if (PE || PLE->getNumExprs() == 1) { 5340 Expr *E = (PE ? PE->getSubExpr() : PLE->getExpr(0)); 5341 if (!E->getType()->isVectorType()) 5342 isVectorLiteral = true; 5343 } 5344 else 5345 isVectorLiteral = true; 5346 } 5347 5348 // If this is a vector initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')' 5349 // then handle it as such. 5350 if (isVectorLiteral) 5351 return BuildVectorLiteral(LParenLoc, RParenLoc, CastExpr, castTInfo); 5352 5353 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially. 5354 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a 5355 // sequence of BinOp comma operators. 5356 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr)) { 5357 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, CastExpr); 5358 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5359 CastExpr = Result.get(); 5360 } 5361 5362 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !castType->isVoidType() && 5363 !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(LParenLoc)) 5364 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::warn_old_style_cast) << CastExpr->getSourceRange(); 5365 5366 CheckTollFreeBridgeCast(castType, CastExpr); 5367 5368 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedCast(castType, CastExpr); 5369 5370 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, CastExpr); 5371 } 5372 5373 ExprResult Sema::BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5374 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E, 5375 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { 5376 assert((isa<ParenListExpr>(E) || isa<ParenExpr>(E)) && 5377 "Expected paren or paren list expression"); 5378 5379 Expr **exprs; 5380 unsigned numExprs; 5381 Expr *subExpr; 5382 SourceLocation LiteralLParenLoc, LiteralRParenLoc; 5383 if (ParenListExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(E)) { 5384 LiteralLParenLoc = PE->getLParenLoc(); 5385 LiteralRParenLoc = PE->getRParenLoc(); 5386 exprs = PE->getExprs(); 5387 numExprs = PE->getNumExprs(); 5388 } else { // isa<ParenExpr> by assertion at function entrance 5389 LiteralLParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getLParen(); 5390 LiteralRParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getRParen(); 5391 subExpr = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr(); 5392 exprs = &subExpr; 5393 numExprs = 1; 5394 } 5395 5396 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType(); 5397 assert(Ty->isVectorType() && "Expected vector type"); 5398 5399 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs; 5400 const VectorType *VTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>(); 5401 unsigned numElems = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getNumElements(); 5402 5403 // '(...)' form of vector initialization in AltiVec: the number of 5404 // initializers must be one or must match the size of the vector. 5405 // If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will be 5406 // replicated to all the components of the vector 5407 if (VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) { 5408 // The number of initializers must be one or must match the size of the 5409 // vector. If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will 5410 // be replicated to all the components of the vector 5411 if (numExprs == 1) { 5412 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 5413 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]); 5414 if (Literal.isInvalid()) 5415 return ExprError(); 5416 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy, 5417 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy)); 5418 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get()); 5419 } 5420 else if (numExprs < numElems) { 5421 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), 5422 diag::err_incorrect_number_of_vector_initializers); 5423 return ExprError(); 5424 } 5425 else 5426 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs); 5427 } 5428 else { 5429 // For OpenCL, when the number of initializers is a single value, 5430 // it will be replicated to all components of the vector. 5431 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 5432 VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector && 5433 numExprs == 1) { 5434 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 5435 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]); 5436 if (Literal.isInvalid()) 5437 return ExprError(); 5438 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy, 5439 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy)); 5440 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get()); 5441 } 5442 5443 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs); 5444 } 5445 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly 5446 // braces instead of the original commas. 5447 InitListExpr *initE = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LiteralLParenLoc, 5448 initExprs, LiteralRParenLoc); 5449 initE->setType(Ty); 5450 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, initE); 5451 } 5452 5453 /// This is not an AltiVec-style cast or or C++ direct-initialization, so turn 5454 /// the ParenListExpr into a sequence of comma binary operators. 5455 ExprResult 5456 Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *OrigExpr) { 5457 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(OrigExpr); 5458 if (!E) 5459 return OrigExpr; 5460 5461 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0)); 5462 5463 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i) 5464 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(), 5465 E->getExpr(i)); 5466 5467 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5468 5469 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get()); 5470 } 5471 5472 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L, 5473 SourceLocation R, 5474 MultiExprArg Val) { 5475 Expr *expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, Val, R); 5476 return expr; 5477 } 5478 5479 /// \brief Emit a specialized diagnostic when one expression is a null pointer 5480 /// constant and the other is not a pointer. Returns true if a diagnostic is 5481 /// emitted. 5482 bool Sema::DiagnoseConditionalForNull(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 5483 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5484 Expr *NullExpr = LHSExpr; 5485 Expr *NonPointerExpr = RHSExpr; 5486 Expr::NullPointerConstantKind NullKind = 5487 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 5488 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull); 5489 5490 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) { 5491 NullExpr = RHSExpr; 5492 NonPointerExpr = LHSExpr; 5493 NullKind = 5494 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 5495 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull); 5496 } 5497 5498 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) 5499 return false; 5500 5501 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) 5502 return false; 5503 5504 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroLiteral) { 5505 // In this case, check to make sure that we got here from a "NULL" 5506 // string in the source code. 5507 NullExpr = NullExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 5508 SourceLocation loc = NullExpr->getExprLoc(); 5509 if (!findMacroSpelling(loc, "NULL")) 5510 return false; 5511 } 5512 5513 int DiagType = (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_CXX11_nullptr); 5514 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands_null) 5515 << NonPointerExpr->getType() << DiagType 5516 << NonPointerExpr->getSourceRange(); 5517 return true; 5518 } 5519 5520 /// \brief Return false if the condition expression is valid, true otherwise. 5521 static bool checkCondition(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5522 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType(); 5523 5524 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i says the condition cannot be a floating point type. 5525 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CondTy->isFloatingType()) { 5526 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat) 5527 << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange(); 5528 return true; 5529 } 5530 5531 // C99 6.5.15p2 5532 if (CondTy->isScalarType()) return false; 5533 5534 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar) 5535 << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange(); 5536 return true; 5537 } 5538 5539 /// \brief Handle when one or both operands are void type. 5540 static QualType checkConditionalVoidType(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 5541 ExprResult &RHS) { 5542 Expr *LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 5543 Expr *RHSExpr = RHS.get(); 5544 5545 if (!LHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType()) 5546 S.Diag(RHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void) 5547 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 5548 if (!RHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType()) 5549 S.Diag(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void) 5550 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 5551 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid); 5552 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid); 5553 return S.Context.VoidTy; 5554 } 5555 5556 /// \brief Return false if the NullExpr can be promoted to PointerTy, 5557 /// true otherwise. 5558 static bool checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema &S, ExprResult &NullExpr, 5559 QualType PointerTy) { 5560 if ((!PointerTy->isAnyPointerType() && !PointerTy->isBlockPointerType()) || 5561 !NullExpr.get()->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, 5562 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 5563 return true; 5564 5565 NullExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(NullExpr.get(), PointerTy, CK_NullToPointer); 5566 return false; 5567 } 5568 5569 /// \brief Checks compatibility between two pointers and return the resulting 5570 /// type. 5571 static QualType checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 5572 ExprResult &RHS, 5573 SourceLocation Loc) { 5574 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 5575 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 5576 5577 if (S.Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy)) { 5578 // Two identical pointers types are always compatible. 5579 return LHSTy; 5580 } 5581 5582 QualType lhptee, rhptee; 5583 5584 // Get the pointee types. 5585 bool IsBlockPointer = false; 5586 if (const BlockPointerType *LHSBTy = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 5587 lhptee = LHSBTy->getPointeeType(); 5588 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5589 IsBlockPointer = true; 5590 } else { 5591 lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5592 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5593 } 5594 5595 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types or to 5596 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is 5597 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the composite 5598 // type. 5599 5600 // Only CVR-qualifiers exist in the standard, and the differently-qualified 5601 // clause doesn't make sense for our extensions. E.g. address space 2 should 5602 // be incompatible with address space 3: they may live on different devices or 5603 // anything. 5604 Qualifiers lhQual = lhptee.getQualifiers(); 5605 Qualifiers rhQual = rhptee.getQualifiers(); 5606 5607 unsigned MergedCVRQual = lhQual.getCVRQualifiers() | rhQual.getCVRQualifiers(); 5608 lhQual.removeCVRQualifiers(); 5609 rhQual.removeCVRQualifiers(); 5610 5611 lhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), lhQual); 5612 rhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), rhQual); 5613 5614 QualType CompositeTy = S.Context.mergeTypes(lhptee, rhptee); 5615 5616 if (CompositeTy.isNull()) { 5617 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers) 5618 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 5619 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5620 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good 5621 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick 5622 // to get a consistent AST. 5623 QualType incompatTy = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy); 5624 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 5625 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 5626 return incompatTy; 5627 } 5628 5629 // The pointer types are compatible. 5630 QualType ResultTy = CompositeTy.withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual); 5631 if (IsBlockPointer) 5632 ResultTy = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(ResultTy); 5633 else 5634 ResultTy = S.Context.getPointerType(ResultTy); 5635 5636 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultTy, CK_BitCast); 5637 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultTy, CK_BitCast); 5638 return ResultTy; 5639 } 5640 5641 /// \brief Returns true if QT is quelified-id and implements 'NSObject' and/or 5642 /// 'NSCopying' protocols (and nothing else); or QT is an NSObject and optionally 5643 /// implements 'NSObject' and/or NSCopying' protocols (and nothing else). 5644 static bool isObjCPtrBlockCompatible(Sema &S, ASTContext &C, QualType QT) { 5645 if (QT->isObjCIdType()) 5646 return true; 5647 5648 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 5649 if (!OPT) 5650 return false; 5651 5652 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) 5653 if (ID->getIdentifier() != &C.Idents.get("NSObject")) 5654 return false; 5655 5656 ObjCProtocolDecl* PNSCopying = 5657 S.LookupProtocol(&C.Idents.get("NSCopying"), SourceLocation()); 5658 ObjCProtocolDecl* PNSObject = 5659 S.LookupProtocol(&C.Idents.get("NSObject"), SourceLocation()); 5660 5661 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) { 5662 if ((PNSCopying && declaresSameEntity(Proto, PNSCopying)) || 5663 (PNSObject && declaresSameEntity(Proto, PNSObject))) 5664 ; 5665 else 5666 return false; 5667 } 5668 return true; 5669 } 5670 5671 /// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both block pointers. 5672 static QualType checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, 5673 ExprResult &LHS, 5674 ExprResult &RHS, 5675 SourceLocation Loc) { 5676 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 5677 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 5678 5679 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) { 5680 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) { 5681 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy); 5682 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5683 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5684 return destType; 5685 } 5686 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 5687 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 5688 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5689 return QualType(); 5690 } 5691 5692 // We have 2 block pointer types. 5693 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 5694 } 5695 5696 /// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both pointers. 5697 static QualType 5698 checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 5699 ExprResult &RHS, 5700 SourceLocation Loc) { 5701 // get the pointer types 5702 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 5703 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 5704 5705 // get the "pointed to" types 5706 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5707 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5708 5709 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6) 5710 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) { 5711 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6) 5712 QualType destPointee 5713 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers()); 5714 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 5715 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 5716 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 5717 // Promote to void*. 5718 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5719 return destType; 5720 } 5721 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) { 5722 QualType destPointee 5723 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers()); 5724 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 5725 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 5726 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 5727 // Promote to void*. 5728 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5729 return destType; 5730 } 5731 5732 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 5733 } 5734 5735 /// \brief Return false if the first expression is not an integer and the second 5736 /// expression is not a pointer, true otherwise. 5737 static bool checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema &S, ExprResult &Int, 5738 Expr* PointerExpr, SourceLocation Loc, 5739 bool IsIntFirstExpr) { 5740 if (!PointerExpr->getType()->isPointerType() || 5741 !Int.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) 5742 return false; 5743 5744 Expr *Expr1 = IsIntFirstExpr ? Int.get() : PointerExpr; 5745 Expr *Expr2 = IsIntFirstExpr ? PointerExpr : Int.get(); 5746 5747 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch) 5748 << Expr1->getType() << Expr2->getType() 5749 << Expr1->getSourceRange() << Expr2->getSourceRange(); 5750 Int = S.ImpCastExprToType(Int.get(), PointerExpr->getType(), 5751 CK_IntegralToPointer); 5752 return true; 5753 } 5754 5755 /// \brief Simple conversion between integer and floating point types. 5756 /// 5757 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the 5758 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar. 5759 /// 5760 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i and s6.11.6 together require that the scalar 5761 /// types are either integer or floating type. Between the two 5762 /// operands, the type with the higher rank is defined as the "result 5763 /// type". The other operand needs to be promoted to the same type. No 5764 /// other type promotion is allowed. We cannot use 5765 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() for this purpose, since it always 5766 /// promotes promotable types. 5767 static QualType OpenCLArithmeticConversions(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 5768 ExprResult &RHS, 5769 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5770 LHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 5771 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 5772 return QualType(); 5773 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 5774 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 5775 return QualType(); 5776 5777 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 5778 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 5779 QualType LHSType = 5780 S.Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 5781 QualType RHSType = 5782 S.Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 5783 5784 if (!LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSType->isRealFloatingType()) { 5785 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float) 5786 << LHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5787 return QualType(); 5788 } 5789 5790 if (!RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) { 5791 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float) 5792 << RHSType << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5793 return QualType(); 5794 } 5795 5796 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 5797 if (LHSType == RHSType) 5798 return LHSType; 5799 5800 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double). 5801 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) 5802 return handleFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 5803 /*IsCompAssign = */ false); 5804 5805 // Finally, we have two differing integer types. 5806 return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 5807 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, /*IsCompAssign = */ false); 5808 } 5809 5810 /// \brief Convert scalar operands to a vector that matches the 5811 /// condition in length. 5812 /// 5813 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the 5814 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar. 5815 /// 5816 /// We first compute the "result type" for the scalar operands 5817 /// according to OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. Both operands are then converted 5818 /// into a vector of that type where the length matches the condition 5819 /// vector type. s6.11.6 requires that the element types of the result 5820 /// and the condition must have the same number of bits. 5821 static QualType 5822 OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 5823 QualType CondTy, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5824 QualType ResTy = OpenCLArithmeticConversions(S, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc); 5825 if (ResTy.isNull()) return QualType(); 5826 5827 const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 5828 assert(CV); 5829 5830 // Determine the vector result type 5831 unsigned NumElements = CV->getNumElements(); 5832 QualType VectorTy = S.Context.getExtVectorType(ResTy, NumElements); 5833 5834 // Ensure that all types have the same number of bits 5835 if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CV->getElementType()) 5836 != S.Context.getTypeSize(ResTy)) { 5837 // Since VectorTy is created internally, it does not pretty print 5838 // with an OpenCL name. Instead, we just print a description. 5839 std::string EleTyName = ResTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString(); 5840 SmallString<64> Str; 5841 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str); 5842 OS << "(vector of " << NumElements << " '" << EleTyName << "' values)"; 5843 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size) 5844 << CondTy << OS.str(); 5845 return QualType(); 5846 } 5847 5848 // Convert operands to the vector result type 5849 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 5850 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 5851 5852 return VectorTy; 5853 } 5854 5855 /// \brief Return false if this is a valid OpenCL condition vector 5856 static bool checkOpenCLConditionVector(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, 5857 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5858 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 says the elements of the vector must be of 5859 // integral type. 5860 const VectorType *CondTy = Cond->getType()->getAs<VectorType>(); 5861 assert(CondTy); 5862 QualType EleTy = CondTy->getElementType(); 5863 if (EleTy->isIntegerType()) return false; 5864 5865 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat) 5866 << Cond->getType() << Cond->getSourceRange(); 5867 return true; 5868 } 5869 5870 /// \brief Return false if the vector condition type and the vector 5871 /// result type are compatible. 5872 /// 5873 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 requires that both vector types have the same 5874 /// number of elements, and their element types have the same number 5875 /// of bits. 5876 static bool checkVectorResult(Sema &S, QualType CondTy, QualType VecResTy, 5877 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5878 const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 5879 const VectorType *RV = VecResTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 5880 assert(CV && RV); 5881 5882 if (CV->getNumElements() != RV->getNumElements()) { 5883 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_size) 5884 << CondTy << VecResTy; 5885 return true; 5886 } 5887 5888 QualType CVE = CV->getElementType(); 5889 QualType RVE = RV->getElementType(); 5890 5891 if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CVE) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RVE)) { 5892 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size) 5893 << CondTy << VecResTy; 5894 return true; 5895 } 5896 5897 return false; 5898 } 5899 5900 /// \brief Return the resulting type for the conditional operator in 5901 /// OpenCL (aka "ternary selection operator", OpenCL v1.1 5902 /// s6.3.i) when the condition is a vector type. 5903 static QualType 5904 OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(Sema &S, ExprResult &Cond, 5905 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 5906 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5907 Cond = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Cond.get()); 5908 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 5909 return QualType(); 5910 QualType CondTy = Cond.get()->getType(); 5911 5912 if (checkOpenCLConditionVector(S, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc)) 5913 return QualType(); 5914 5915 // If either operand is a vector then find the vector type of the 5916 // result as specified in OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. 5917 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 5918 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 5919 QualType VecResTy = S.CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, 5920 /*isCompAssign*/false); 5921 if (VecResTy.isNull()) return QualType(); 5922 // The result type must match the condition type as specified in 5923 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6. 5924 if (checkVectorResult(S, CondTy, VecResTy, QuestionLoc)) 5925 return QualType(); 5926 return VecResTy; 5927 } 5928 5929 // Both operands are scalar. 5930 return OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(S, LHS, RHS, CondTy, QuestionLoc); 5931 } 5932 5933 /// Note that LHS is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension. 5934 /// In that case, LHS = cond. 5935 /// C99 6.5.15 5936 QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS, 5937 ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK, 5938 ExprObjectKind &OK, 5939 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5940 5941 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get()); 5942 if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType(); 5943 LHS = LHSResult; 5944 5945 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get()); 5946 if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType(); 5947 RHS = RHSResult; 5948 5949 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker. 5950 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5951 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, VK, OK, QuestionLoc); 5952 5953 VK = VK_RValue; 5954 OK = OK_Ordinary; 5955 5956 // The OpenCL operator with a vector condition is sufficiently 5957 // different to merit its own checker. 5958 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && Cond.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 5959 return OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(*this, Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc); 5960 5961 // First, check the condition. 5962 Cond = UsualUnaryConversions(Cond.get()); 5963 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 5964 return QualType(); 5965 if (checkCondition(*this, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc)) 5966 return QualType(); 5967 5968 // Now check the two expressions. 5969 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 5970 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 5971 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, /*isCompAssign*/false); 5972 5973 QualType ResTy = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 5974 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 5975 return QualType(); 5976 5977 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 5978 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 5979 5980 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions 5981 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5. 5982 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) { 5983 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(LHS, ResTy)); 5984 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(RHS, ResTy)); 5985 5986 return ResTy; 5987 } 5988 5989 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that 5990 // type. 5991 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3 5992 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) 5993 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl()) 5994 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has 5995 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped. 5996 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType(); 5997 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode. 5998 } 5999 6000 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type." 6001 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism). 6002 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) { 6003 return checkConditionalVoidType(*this, LHS, RHS); 6004 } 6005 6006 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has 6007 // the type of the other operand." 6008 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, RHS, LHSTy)) return LHSTy; 6009 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, LHS, RHSTy)) return RHSTy; 6010 6011 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here. 6012 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS, 6013 QuestionLoc); 6014 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 6015 return QualType(); 6016 if (!compositeType.isNull()) 6017 return compositeType; 6018 6019 6020 // Handle block pointer types. 6021 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) 6022 return checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS, 6023 QuestionLoc); 6024 6025 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6). 6026 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) 6027 return checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS, 6028 QuestionLoc); 6029 6030 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch. Note that 6031 // null pointers have been filtered out by this point. 6032 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, LHS, RHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 6033 /*isIntFirstExpr=*/true)) 6034 return RHSTy; 6035 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, RHS, LHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 6036 /*isIntFirstExpr=*/false)) 6037 return LHSTy; 6038 6039 // Emit a better diagnostic if one of the expressions is a null pointer 6040 // constant and the other is not a pointer type. In this case, the user most 6041 // likely forgot to take the address of the other expression. 6042 if (DiagnoseConditionalForNull(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc)) 6043 return QualType(); 6044 6045 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible. 6046 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 6047 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 6048 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6049 return QualType(); 6050 } 6051 6052 /// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of 6053 /// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions. 6054 QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 6055 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6056 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6057 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6058 6059 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result 6060 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the 6061 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields. 6062 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() && 6063 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) { 6064 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 6065 return LHSTy; 6066 } 6067 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() && 6068 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) { 6069 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 6070 return RHSTy; 6071 } 6072 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id 6073 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() && 6074 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) { 6075 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 6076 return LHSTy; 6077 } 6078 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() && 6079 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) { 6080 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 6081 return RHSTy; 6082 } 6083 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL 6084 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) && 6085 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) { 6086 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_BitCast); 6087 return LHSTy; 6088 } 6089 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) && 6090 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) { 6091 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_BitCast); 6092 return RHSTy; 6093 } 6094 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types. 6095 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 6096 6097 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) { 6098 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible. 6099 return LHSTy; 6100 } 6101 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 6102 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 6103 QualType compositeType = LHSTy; 6104 6105 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be 6106 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite 6107 // type. This allows 6108 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b 6109 // where B is a subclass of A. 6110 // 6111 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id' 6112 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are 6113 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite 6114 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to. 6115 6116 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'. 6117 // It could return the composite type. 6118 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) { 6119 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy; 6120 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) { 6121 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy; 6122 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || 6123 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) && 6124 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) { 6125 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly. 6126 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to 6127 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be 6128 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible. 6129 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType(); 6130 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) { 6131 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType(); 6132 } else if (!(compositeType = 6133 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull()) 6134 ; 6135 else { 6136 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 6137 << LHSTy << RHSTy 6138 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6139 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType(); 6140 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 6141 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 6142 return incompatTy; 6143 } 6144 // The object pointer types are compatible. 6145 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast); 6146 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast); 6147 return compositeType; 6148 } 6149 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *' 6150 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 6151 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 6152 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *', 6153 // so these types are not compatible. 6154 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy 6155 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6156 LHS = RHS = true; 6157 return QualType(); 6158 } 6159 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6160 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6161 QualType destPointee 6162 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers()); 6163 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 6164 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 6165 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 6166 // Promote to void*. 6167 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6168 return destType; 6169 } 6170 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) { 6171 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 6172 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *', 6173 // so these types are not compatible. 6174 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy 6175 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6176 LHS = RHS = true; 6177 return QualType(); 6178 } 6179 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6180 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6181 QualType destPointee 6182 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers()); 6183 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 6184 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 6185 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 6186 // Promote to void*. 6187 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6188 return destType; 6189 } 6190 return QualType(); 6191 } 6192 6193 /// SuggestParentheses - Emit a note with a fixit hint that wraps 6194 /// ParenRange in parentheses. 6195 static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc, 6196 const PartialDiagnostic &Note, 6197 SourceRange ParenRange) { 6198 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd()); 6199 if (ParenRange.getBegin().isFileID() && ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() && 6200 EndLoc.isValid()) { 6201 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) 6202 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(") 6203 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")"); 6204 } else { 6205 // We can't display the parentheses, so just show the bare note. 6206 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) << ParenRange; 6207 } 6208 } 6209 6210 static bool IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 6211 return Opc >= BO_Mul && Opc <= BO_Shr; 6212 } 6213 6214 /// IsArithmeticBinaryExpr - Returns true if E is an arithmetic binary 6215 /// expression, either using a built-in or overloaded operator, 6216 /// and sets *OpCode to the opcode and *RHSExprs to the right-hand side 6217 /// expression. 6218 static bool IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Expr *E, BinaryOperatorKind *Opcode, 6219 Expr **RHSExprs) { 6220 // Don't strip parenthesis: we should not warn if E is in parenthesis. 6221 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 6222 E = E->IgnoreConversionOperator(); 6223 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 6224 6225 // Built-in binary operator. 6226 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 6227 if (IsArithmeticOp(OP->getOpcode())) { 6228 *Opcode = OP->getOpcode(); 6229 *RHSExprs = OP->getRHS(); 6230 return true; 6231 } 6232 } 6233 6234 // Overloaded operator. 6235 if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Call = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) { 6236 if (Call->getNumArgs() != 2) 6237 return false; 6238 6239 // Make sure this is really a binary operator that is safe to pass into 6240 // BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(), e.g. it's not a subscript op. 6241 OverloadedOperatorKind OO = Call->getOperator(); 6242 if (OO < OO_Plus || OO > OO_Arrow || 6243 OO == OO_PlusPlus || OO == OO_MinusMinus) 6244 return false; 6245 6246 BinaryOperatorKind OpKind = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(OO); 6247 if (IsArithmeticOp(OpKind)) { 6248 *Opcode = OpKind; 6249 *RHSExprs = Call->getArg(1); 6250 return true; 6251 } 6252 } 6253 6254 return false; 6255 } 6256 6257 static bool IsLogicOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 6258 return (Opc >= BO_LT && Opc <= BO_NE) || (Opc >= BO_LAnd && Opc <= BO_LOr); 6259 } 6260 6261 /// ExprLooksBoolean - Returns true if E looks boolean, i.e. it has boolean type 6262 /// or is a logical expression such as (x==y) which has int type, but is 6263 /// commonly interpreted as boolean. 6264 static bool ExprLooksBoolean(Expr *E) { 6265 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 6266 6267 if (E->getType()->isBooleanType()) 6268 return true; 6269 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) 6270 return IsLogicOp(OP->getOpcode()); 6271 if (UnaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) 6272 return OP->getOpcode() == UO_LNot; 6273 if (E->getType()->isPointerType()) 6274 return true; 6275 6276 return false; 6277 } 6278 6279 /// DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence - Emit a warning when a conditional operator 6280 /// and binary operator are mixed in a way that suggests the programmer assumed 6281 /// the conditional operator has higher precedence, for example: 6282 /// "int x = a + someBinaryCondition ? 1 : 2". 6283 static void DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema &Self, 6284 SourceLocation OpLoc, 6285 Expr *Condition, 6286 Expr *LHSExpr, 6287 Expr *RHSExpr) { 6288 BinaryOperatorKind CondOpcode; 6289 Expr *CondRHS; 6290 6291 if (!IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Condition, &CondOpcode, &CondRHS)) 6292 return; 6293 if (!ExprLooksBoolean(CondRHS)) 6294 return; 6295 6296 // The condition is an arithmetic binary expression, with a right- 6297 // hand side that looks boolean, so warn. 6298 6299 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_conditional) 6300 << Condition->getSourceRange() 6301 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode); 6302 6303 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 6304 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 6305 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode), 6306 SourceRange(Condition->getLocStart(), Condition->getLocEnd())); 6307 6308 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 6309 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_conditional_first), 6310 SourceRange(CondRHS->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd())); 6311 } 6312 6313 /// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null 6314 /// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension. 6315 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc, 6316 SourceLocation ColonLoc, 6317 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr, 6318 Expr *RHSExpr) { 6319 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6320 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes in the condition because it 6321 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 6322 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 6323 ExprResult CondResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CondExpr); 6324 if (!CondResult.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 6325 CondExpr = CondResult.get(); 6326 } 6327 6328 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS 6329 // was the condition. 6330 OpaqueValueExpr *opaqueValue = nullptr; 6331 Expr *commonExpr = nullptr; 6332 if (!LHSExpr) { 6333 commonExpr = CondExpr; 6334 // Lower out placeholder types first. This is important so that we don't 6335 // try to capture a placeholder. This happens in few cases in C++; such 6336 // as Objective-C++'s dictionary subscripting syntax. 6337 if (commonExpr->hasPlaceholderType()) { 6338 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(commonExpr); 6339 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 6340 commonExpr = result.get(); 6341 } 6342 // We usually want to apply unary conversions *before* saving, except 6343 // in the special case of a C++ l-value conditional. 6344 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 6345 && !commonExpr->isTypeDependent() 6346 && commonExpr->getValueKind() == RHSExpr->getValueKind() 6347 && commonExpr->isGLValue() 6348 && commonExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject() 6349 && RHSExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject() 6350 && Context.hasSameType(commonExpr->getType(), RHSExpr->getType()))) { 6351 ExprResult commonRes = UsualUnaryConversions(commonExpr); 6352 if (commonRes.isInvalid()) 6353 return ExprError(); 6354 commonExpr = commonRes.get(); 6355 } 6356 6357 opaqueValue = new (Context) OpaqueValueExpr(commonExpr->getExprLoc(), 6358 commonExpr->getType(), 6359 commonExpr->getValueKind(), 6360 commonExpr->getObjectKind(), 6361 commonExpr); 6362 LHSExpr = CondExpr = opaqueValue; 6363 } 6364 6365 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 6366 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 6367 ExprResult Cond = CondExpr, LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 6368 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, 6369 VK, OK, QuestionLoc); 6370 if (result.isNull() || Cond.isInvalid() || LHS.isInvalid() || 6371 RHS.isInvalid()) 6372 return ExprError(); 6373 6374 DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(*this, QuestionLoc, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), 6375 RHS.get()); 6376 6377 if (!commonExpr) 6378 return new (Context) 6379 ConditionalOperator(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc, LHS.get(), ColonLoc, 6380 RHS.get(), result, VK, OK); 6381 6382 return new (Context) BinaryConditionalOperator( 6383 commonExpr, opaqueValue, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 6384 ColonLoc, result, VK, OK); 6385 } 6386 6387 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite 6388 // being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this 6389 // routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee. 6390 // This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3]. 6391 // FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment. 6392 static Sema::AssignConvertType 6393 checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) { 6394 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!"); 6395 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!"); 6396 6397 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level) 6398 const Type *lhptee, *rhptee; 6399 Qualifiers lhq, rhq; 6400 std::tie(lhptee, lhq) = 6401 cast<PointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 6402 std::tie(rhptee, rhq) = 6403 cast<PointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 6404 6405 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible; 6406 6407 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints 6408 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the 6409 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right; 6410 6411 // As a special case, 'non-__weak A *' -> 'non-__weak const *' is okay. 6412 if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime() && 6413 lhq.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(rhq)) { 6414 // Ignore lifetime for further calculation. 6415 lhq.removeObjCLifetime(); 6416 rhq.removeObjCLifetime(); 6417 } 6418 6419 if (!lhq.compatiblyIncludes(rhq)) { 6420 // Treat address-space mismatches as fatal. TODO: address subspaces 6421 if (!lhq.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhq)) 6422 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6423 6424 // It's okay to add or remove GC or lifetime qualifiers when converting to 6425 // and from void*. 6426 else if (lhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime() 6427 .compatiblyIncludes( 6428 rhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime()) 6429 && (lhptee->isVoidType() || rhptee->isVoidType())) 6430 ; // keep old 6431 6432 // Treat lifetime mismatches as fatal. 6433 else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) 6434 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6435 6436 // For GCC compatibility, other qualifier mismatches are treated 6437 // as still compatible in C. 6438 else ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6439 } 6440 6441 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or 6442 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified 6443 // version of void... 6444 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) { 6445 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) 6446 return ConvTy; 6447 6448 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer. 6449 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType()); 6450 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer; 6451 } 6452 6453 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) { 6454 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) 6455 return ConvTy; 6456 6457 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer. 6458 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType()); 6459 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer; 6460 } 6461 6462 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or 6463 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ... 6464 QualType ltrans = QualType(lhptee, 0), rtrans = QualType(rhptee, 0); 6465 if (!S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ltrans, rtrans)) { 6466 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign. 6467 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs 6468 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned. 6469 if (lhptee->isCharType()) 6470 ltrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy; 6471 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()) 6472 ltrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(ltrans); 6473 6474 if (rhptee->isCharType()) 6475 rtrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy; 6476 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()) 6477 rtrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rtrans); 6478 6479 if (ltrans == rtrans) { 6480 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility 6481 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign 6482 // warning can be disabled. 6483 if (ConvTy != Sema::Compatible) 6484 return ConvTy; 6485 6486 return Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign; 6487 } 6488 6489 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply 6490 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If 6491 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same 6492 // level of indirection, this must be the issue. 6493 if (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)) { 6494 do { 6495 lhptee = cast<PointerType>(lhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr(); 6496 rhptee = cast<PointerType>(rhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr(); 6497 } while (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)); 6498 6499 if (lhptee == rhptee) 6500 return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers; 6501 } 6502 6503 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers. 6504 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6505 } 6506 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 6507 S.IsNoReturnConversion(ltrans, rtrans, ltrans)) 6508 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6509 return ConvTy; 6510 } 6511 6512 /// checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two 6513 /// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer 6514 /// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer 6515 // types. 6516 static Sema::AssignConvertType 6517 checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 6518 QualType RHSType) { 6519 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!"); 6520 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!"); 6521 6522 QualType lhptee, rhptee; 6523 6524 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level) 6525 lhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType(); 6526 rhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType(); 6527 6528 // In C++, the types have to match exactly. 6529 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 6530 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 6531 6532 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible; 6533 6534 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical. 6535 if (lhptee.getLocalQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalQualifiers()) 6536 ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6537 6538 if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) 6539 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 6540 6541 return ConvTy; 6542 } 6543 6544 /// checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types 6545 /// for assignment compatibility. 6546 static Sema::AssignConvertType 6547 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 6548 QualType RHSType) { 6549 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS was not canonicalized!"); 6550 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS was not canonicalized!"); 6551 6552 if (LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 6553 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers. 6554 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && !RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() && 6555 !RHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) 6556 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6557 return Sema::Compatible; 6558 } 6559 if (RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 6560 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && !LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() && 6561 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) 6562 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6563 return Sema::Compatible; 6564 } 6565 QualType lhptee = LHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6566 QualType rhptee = RHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6567 6568 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee) && 6569 // make an exception for id<P> 6570 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 6571 return Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6572 6573 if (S.Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) 6574 return Sema::Compatible; 6575 if (LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 6576 return Sema::IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId; 6577 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6578 } 6579 6580 Sema::AssignConvertType 6581 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc, 6582 QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) { 6583 // Fake up an opaque expression. We don't actually care about what 6584 // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints 6585 // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't 6586 // usually happen on valid code. 6587 OpaqueValueExpr RHSExpr(Loc, RHSType, VK_RValue); 6588 ExprResult RHSPtr = &RHSExpr; 6589 CastKind K = CK_Invalid; 6590 6591 return CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSPtr, K); 6592 } 6593 6594 /// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently 6595 /// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking 6596 /// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings: 6597 /// 6598 /// int a, *pint; 6599 /// short *pshort; 6600 /// struct foo *pfoo; 6601 /// 6602 /// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type 6603 /// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast 6604 /// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast 6605 /// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type 6606 /// 6607 /// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the 6608 /// C99 spec dictates. 6609 /// 6610 /// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible. 6611 Sema::AssignConvertType 6612 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS, 6613 CastKind &Kind) { 6614 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 6615 QualType OrigLHSType = LHSType; 6616 6617 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing 6618 // them. 6619 LHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(LHSType).getUnqualifiedType(); 6620 RHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(RHSType).getUnqualifiedType(); 6621 6622 // Common case: no conversion required. 6623 if (LHSType == RHSType) { 6624 Kind = CK_NoOp; 6625 return Compatible; 6626 } 6627 6628 // If we have an atomic type, try a non-atomic assignment, then just add an 6629 // atomic qualification step. 6630 if (const AtomicType *AtomicTy = dyn_cast<AtomicType>(LHSType)) { 6631 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 6632 CheckAssignmentConstraints(AtomicTy->getValueType(), RHS, Kind); 6633 if (result != Compatible) 6634 return result; 6635 if (Kind != CK_NoOp) 6636 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), AtomicTy->getValueType(), Kind); 6637 Kind = CK_NonAtomicToAtomic; 6638 return Compatible; 6639 } 6640 6641 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a 6642 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C, 6643 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case, 6644 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the 6645 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting 6646 // LHSType so that the resulting expression does not have reference 6647 // type. 6648 if (const ReferenceType *LHSTypeRef = LHSType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 6649 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSTypeRef->getPointeeType(), RHSType)) { 6650 Kind = CK_LValueBitCast; 6651 return Compatible; 6652 } 6653 return Incompatible; 6654 } 6655 6656 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type 6657 // to the same ExtVector type. 6658 if (LHSType->isExtVectorType()) { 6659 if (RHSType->isExtVectorType()) 6660 return Incompatible; 6661 if (RHSType->isArithmeticType()) { 6662 // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the 6663 // element type. 6664 QualType elType = cast<ExtVectorType>(LHSType)->getElementType(); 6665 if (elType != RHSType) { 6666 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, elType); 6667 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), elType, Kind); 6668 } 6669 Kind = CK_VectorSplat; 6670 return Compatible; 6671 } 6672 } 6673 6674 // Conversions to or from vector type. 6675 if (LHSType->isVectorType() || RHSType->isVectorType()) { 6676 if (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) { 6677 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC 6678 // vector type and vice versa 6679 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) { 6680 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6681 return Compatible; 6682 } 6683 6684 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both 6685 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast; 6686 // no bits are changed but the result type is different. 6687 if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) { 6688 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6689 return IncompatibleVectors; 6690 } 6691 } 6692 return Incompatible; 6693 } 6694 6695 // Arithmetic conversions. 6696 if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType() && 6697 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHSType->isEnumeralType())) { 6698 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, LHSType); 6699 return Compatible; 6700 } 6701 6702 // Conversions to normal pointers. 6703 if (const PointerType *LHSPointer = dyn_cast<PointerType>(LHSType)) { 6704 // U* -> T* 6705 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 6706 unsigned AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 6707 unsigned AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 6708 Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast; 6709 return checkPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 6710 } 6711 6712 // int -> T* 6713 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6714 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null? 6715 return IntToPointer; 6716 } 6717 6718 // C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers, 6719 // with two exceptions: 6720 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) { 6721 // - conversions to void* 6722 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 6723 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6724 return Compatible; 6725 } 6726 6727 // - conversions from 'Class' to the redefinition type 6728 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && 6729 Context.hasSameType(LHSType, 6730 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) { 6731 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6732 return Compatible; 6733 } 6734 6735 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6736 return IncompatiblePointer; 6737 } 6738 6739 // U^ -> void* 6740 if (RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 6741 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 6742 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6743 return Compatible; 6744 } 6745 } 6746 6747 return Incompatible; 6748 } 6749 6750 // Conversions to block pointers. 6751 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)) { 6752 // U^ -> T^ 6753 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 6754 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6755 return checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 6756 } 6757 6758 // int or null -> T^ 6759 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6760 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null 6761 return IntToBlockPointer; 6762 } 6763 6764 // id -> T^ 6765 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 && RHSType->isObjCIdType()) { 6766 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 6767 return Compatible; 6768 } 6769 6770 // void* -> T^ 6771 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>()) 6772 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 6773 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 6774 return Compatible; 6775 } 6776 6777 return Incompatible; 6778 } 6779 6780 // Conversions to Objective-C pointers. 6781 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(LHSType)) { 6782 // A* -> B* 6783 if (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 6784 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6785 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 6786 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 6787 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 6788 result == Compatible && 6789 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(OrigLHSType, RHSType)) 6790 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef; 6791 return result; 6792 } 6793 6794 // int or null -> A* 6795 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6796 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null 6797 return IntToPointer; 6798 } 6799 6800 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers, 6801 // with two exceptions: 6802 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 6803 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6804 6805 // - conversions from 'void*' 6806 if (RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) { 6807 return Compatible; 6808 } 6809 6810 // - conversions to 'Class' from its redefinition type 6811 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && 6812 Context.hasSameType(RHSType, 6813 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) { 6814 return Compatible; 6815 } 6816 6817 return IncompatiblePointer; 6818 } 6819 6820 // Only under strict condition T^ is compatible with an Objective-C pointer. 6821 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 6822 isObjCPtrBlockCompatible(*this, Context, LHSType)) { 6823 maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, RHS); 6824 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6825 return Compatible; 6826 } 6827 6828 return Incompatible; 6829 } 6830 6831 // Conversions from pointers that are not covered by the above. 6832 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 6833 // T* -> _Bool 6834 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) { 6835 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean; 6836 return Compatible; 6837 } 6838 6839 // T* -> int 6840 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6841 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral; 6842 return PointerToInt; 6843 } 6844 6845 return Incompatible; 6846 } 6847 6848 // Conversions from Objective-C pointers that are not covered by the above. 6849 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) { 6850 // T* -> _Bool 6851 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) { 6852 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean; 6853 return Compatible; 6854 } 6855 6856 // T* -> int 6857 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6858 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral; 6859 return PointerToInt; 6860 } 6861 6862 return Incompatible; 6863 } 6864 6865 // struct A -> struct B 6866 if (isa<TagType>(LHSType) && isa<TagType>(RHSType)) { 6867 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) { 6868 Kind = CK_NoOp; 6869 return Compatible; 6870 } 6871 } 6872 6873 return Incompatible; 6874 } 6875 6876 /// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is 6877 /// used to initialize the transparent union. 6878 static void ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema &S, ASTContext &C, 6879 ExprResult &EResult, QualType UnionType, 6880 FieldDecl *Field) { 6881 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member 6882 // of the transparent union. 6883 Expr *E = EResult.get(); 6884 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(), 6885 E, SourceLocation()); 6886 Initializer->setType(UnionType); 6887 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field); 6888 6889 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent 6890 // union type from this initializer list. 6891 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType); 6892 EResult = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType, 6893 VK_RValue, Initializer, false); 6894 } 6895 6896 Sema::AssignConvertType 6897 Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, 6898 ExprResult &RHS) { 6899 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 6900 6901 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential 6902 // transparent_union GCC extension. 6903 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType(); 6904 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 6905 return Incompatible; 6906 6907 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 6908 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 6909 FieldDecl *InitField = nullptr; 6910 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 6911 for (auto *it : UD->fields()) { 6912 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) { 6913 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow: 6914 // 1) void pointer 6915 // 2) null pointer constant 6916 if (RHSType->isPointerType()) 6917 if (RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 6918 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), CK_BitCast); 6919 InitField = it; 6920 break; 6921 } 6922 6923 if (RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 6924 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 6925 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), 6926 CK_NullToPointer); 6927 InitField = it; 6928 break; 6929 } 6930 } 6931 6932 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid; 6933 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), RHS, Kind) 6934 == Compatible) { 6935 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), Kind); 6936 InitField = it; 6937 break; 6938 } 6939 } 6940 6941 if (!InitField) 6942 return Incompatible; 6943 6944 ConstructTransparentUnion(*this, Context, RHS, ArgType, InitField); 6945 return Compatible; 6946 } 6947 6948 Sema::AssignConvertType 6949 Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS, 6950 bool Diagnose, 6951 bool DiagnoseCFAudited) { 6952 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6953 if (!LHSType->isRecordType() && !LHSType->isAtomicType()) { 6954 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the 6955 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the 6956 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand. 6957 ExprResult Res; 6958 if (Diagnose) { 6959 Res = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 6960 AA_Assigning); 6961 } else { 6962 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 6963 TryImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 6964 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 6965 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 6966 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 6967 /*CStyle=*/false, 6968 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 6969 if (ICS.isFailure()) 6970 return Incompatible; 6971 Res = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 6972 ICS, AA_Assigning); 6973 } 6974 if (Res.isInvalid()) 6975 return Incompatible; 6976 Sema::AssignConvertType result = Compatible; 6977 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 6978 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(LHSType, 6979 RHS.get()->getType())) 6980 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef; 6981 RHS = Res; 6982 return result; 6983 } 6984 6985 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C 6986 // structures. 6987 // FIXME: We also fall through for atomics; not sure what should 6988 // happen there, though. 6989 } 6990 6991 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is 6992 // a null pointer constant. 6993 if ((LHSType->isPointerType() || LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 6994 LHSType->isBlockPointerType()) && 6995 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 6996 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 6997 CastKind Kind; 6998 CXXCastPath Path; 6999 CheckPointerConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, Path, false); 7000 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, VK_RValue, &Path); 7001 return Compatible; 7002 } 7003 7004 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper 7005 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all 7006 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary 7007 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof). 7008 // 7009 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5. 7010 if (!LHSType->isReferenceType()) { 7011 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 7012 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 7013 return Incompatible; 7014 } 7015 7016 Expr *PRE = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts(); 7017 if (ObjCProtocolExpr *OPE = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolExpr>(PRE)) { 7018 ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = OPE->getProtocol(); 7019 if (PDecl && !PDecl->hasDefinition()) { 7020 Diag(PRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_atprotocol_protocol) << PDecl->getName(); 7021 Diag(PDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PDecl; 7022 } 7023 } 7024 7025 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid; 7026 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 7027 CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS, Kind); 7028 7029 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the 7030 // type of the assignment expression. 7031 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference, 7032 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C. 7033 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression 7034 // does not have reference type. 7035 if (result != Incompatible && RHS.get()->getType() != LHSType) { 7036 QualType Ty = LHSType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 7037 Expr *E = RHS.get(); 7038 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 7039 CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), Ty, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, 7040 DiagnoseCFAudited); 7041 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 && 7042 (CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(E->getLocStart(), 7043 LHSType, E->getType(), E) || 7044 ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(LHSType, E))) { 7045 RHS = E; 7046 return Compatible; 7047 } 7048 7049 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty, Kind); 7050 } 7051 return result; 7052 } 7053 7054 QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS, 7055 ExprResult &RHS) { 7056 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands) 7057 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 7058 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7059 return QualType(); 7060 } 7061 7062 /// Try to convert a value of non-vector type to a vector type by converting 7063 /// the type to the element type of the vector and then performing a splat. 7064 /// If the language is OpenCL, we only use conversions that promote scalar 7065 /// rank; for C, Obj-C, and C++ we allow any real scalar conversion except 7066 /// for float->int. 7067 /// 7068 /// \param scalar - if non-null, actually perform the conversions 7069 /// \return true if the operation fails (but without diagnosing the failure) 7070 static bool tryVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *scalar, 7071 QualType scalarTy, 7072 QualType vectorEltTy, 7073 QualType vectorTy) { 7074 // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it, 7075 // if necessary. 7076 CastKind scalarCast = CK_Invalid; 7077 7078 if (vectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 7079 if (!scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) 7080 return true; 7081 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 7082 S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0) 7083 return true; 7084 scalarCast = CK_IntegralCast; 7085 } else if (vectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 7086 if (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 7087 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 7088 S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0) 7089 return true; 7090 scalarCast = CK_FloatingCast; 7091 } 7092 else if (scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) 7093 scalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating; 7094 else 7095 return true; 7096 } else { 7097 return true; 7098 } 7099 7100 // Adjust scalar if desired. 7101 if (scalar) { 7102 if (scalarCast != CK_Invalid) 7103 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorEltTy, scalarCast); 7104 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 7105 } 7106 return false; 7107 } 7108 7109 QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7110 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 7111 if (!IsCompAssign) { 7112 LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 7113 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 7114 return QualType(); 7115 } 7116 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 7117 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 7118 return QualType(); 7119 7120 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 7121 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 7122 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 7123 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 7124 7125 // If the vector types are identical, return. 7126 if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType)) 7127 return LHSType; 7128 7129 const VectorType *LHSVecType = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 7130 const VectorType *RHSVecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 7131 assert(LHSVecType || RHSVecType); 7132 7133 // If we have compatible AltiVec and GCC vector types, use the AltiVec type. 7134 if (LHSVecType && RHSVecType && 7135 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) { 7136 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 7137 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 7138 return LHSType; 7139 } 7140 7141 if (!IsCompAssign) 7142 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 7143 return RHSType; 7144 } 7145 7146 // If there's an ext-vector type and a scalar, try to convert the scalar to 7147 // the vector element type and splat. 7148 if (!RHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 7149 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, RHSType, 7150 LHSVecType->getElementType(), LHSType)) 7151 return LHSType; 7152 } 7153 if (!LHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) { 7154 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, (IsCompAssign ? nullptr : &LHS), 7155 LHSType, RHSVecType->getElementType(), 7156 RHSType)) 7157 return RHSType; 7158 } 7159 7160 // If we're allowing lax vector conversions, only the total (data) size 7161 // needs to be the same. 7162 // FIXME: Should we really be allowing this? 7163 // FIXME: We really just pick the LHS type arbitrarily? 7164 if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) { 7165 QualType resultType = LHSType; 7166 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), resultType, CK_BitCast); 7167 return resultType; 7168 } 7169 7170 // Okay, the expression is invalid. 7171 7172 // If there's a non-vector, non-real operand, diagnose that. 7173 if ((!RHSVecType && !RHSType->isRealType()) || 7174 (!LHSVecType && !LHSType->isRealType())) { 7175 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_non_scalar) 7176 << LHSType << RHSType 7177 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7178 return QualType(); 7179 } 7180 7181 // Otherwise, use the generic diagnostic. 7182 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable) 7183 << LHSType << RHSType 7184 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7185 return QualType(); 7186 } 7187 7188 // checkArithmeticNull - Detect when a NULL constant is used improperly in an 7189 // expression. These are mainly cases where the null pointer is used as an 7190 // integer instead of a pointer. 7191 static void checkArithmeticNull(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7192 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompare) { 7193 // The canonical way to check for a GNU null is with isNullPointerConstant, 7194 // but we use a bit of a hack here for speed; this is a relatively 7195 // hot path, and isNullPointerConstant is slow. 7196 bool LHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 7197 bool RHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 7198 7199 QualType NonNullType = LHSNull ? RHS.get()->getType() : LHS.get()->getType(); 7200 7201 // Avoid analyzing cases where the result will either be invalid (and 7202 // diagnosed as such) or entirely valid and not something to warn about. 7203 if ((!LHSNull && !RHSNull) || NonNullType->isBlockPointerType() || 7204 NonNullType->isMemberPointerType() || NonNullType->isFunctionType()) 7205 return; 7206 7207 // Comparison operations would not make sense with a null pointer no matter 7208 // what the other expression is. 7209 if (!IsCompare) { 7210 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_arithmetic_operation) 7211 << (LHSNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 7212 << (RHSNull ? RHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 7213 return; 7214 } 7215 7216 // The rest of the operations only make sense with a null pointer 7217 // if the other expression is a pointer. 7218 if (LHSNull == RHSNull || NonNullType->isAnyPointerType() || 7219 NonNullType->canDecayToPointerType()) 7220 return; 7221 7222 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_comparison_operation) 7223 << LHSNull /* LHS is NULL */ << NonNullType 7224 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7225 } 7226 7227 QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7228 SourceLocation Loc, 7229 bool IsCompAssign, bool IsDiv) { 7230 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 7231 7232 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7233 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 7234 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 7235 7236 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign); 7237 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7238 return QualType(); 7239 7240 7241 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isArithmeticType()) 7242 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7243 7244 // Check for division by zero. 7245 llvm::APSInt RHSValue; 7246 if (IsDiv && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 7247 RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, Context) && RHSValue == 0) 7248 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 7249 PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero) 7250 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 7251 7252 return compType; 7253 } 7254 7255 QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands( 7256 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 7257 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 7258 7259 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7260 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 7261 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() && 7262 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 7263 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 7264 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7265 } 7266 7267 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign); 7268 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7269 return QualType(); 7270 7271 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isIntegerType()) 7272 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7273 7274 // Check for remainder by zero. 7275 llvm::APSInt RHSValue; 7276 if (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 7277 RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, Context) && RHSValue == 0) 7278 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 7279 PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero) 7280 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 7281 7282 return compType; 7283 } 7284 7285 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two void pointers. 7286 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7287 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7288 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7289 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type 7290 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) 7291 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 7292 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 7293 } 7294 7295 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a void pointer. 7296 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7297 Expr *Pointer) { 7298 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7299 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type 7300 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) 7301 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 7302 } 7303 7304 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two function pointers. 7305 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7306 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 7307 assert(LHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7308 assert(RHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7309 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7310 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type 7311 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith) 7312 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHS->getType()->getPointeeType() 7313 // We only show the second type if it differs from the first. 7314 << (unsigned)!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS->getType(), 7315 RHS->getType()) 7316 << RHS->getType()->getPointeeType() 7317 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange(); 7318 } 7319 7320 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a function pointer. 7321 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7322 Expr *Pointer) { 7323 assert(Pointer->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7324 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7325 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type 7326 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith) 7327 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getType()->getPointeeType() 7328 << 0 /* one pointer, so only one type */ 7329 << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 7330 } 7331 7332 /// \brief Emit error if Operand is incomplete pointer type 7333 /// 7334 /// \returns True if pointer has incomplete type 7335 static bool checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7336 Expr *Operand) { 7337 QualType ResType = Operand->getType(); 7338 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 7339 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 7340 7341 assert(ResType->isAnyPointerType() && !ResType->isDependentType()); 7342 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType(); 7343 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy, 7344 diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type, 7345 PointeeTy, Operand->getSourceRange()); 7346 } 7347 7348 /// \brief Check the validity of an arithmetic pointer operand. 7349 /// 7350 /// If the operand has pointer type, this code will check for pointer types 7351 /// which are invalid in arithmetic operations. These will be diagnosed 7352 /// appropriately, including whether or not the use is supported as an 7353 /// extension. 7354 /// 7355 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension). 7356 static bool checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7357 Expr *Operand) { 7358 QualType ResType = Operand->getType(); 7359 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 7360 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 7361 7362 if (!ResType->isAnyPointerType()) return true; 7363 7364 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType(); 7365 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) { 7366 diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, Operand); 7367 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 7368 } 7369 if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) { 7370 diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, Operand); 7371 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 7372 } 7373 7374 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, Operand)) return false; 7375 7376 return true; 7377 } 7378 7379 /// \brief Check the validity of a binary arithmetic operation w.r.t. pointer 7380 /// operands. 7381 /// 7382 /// This routine will diagnose any invalid arithmetic on pointer operands much 7383 /// like \see checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand. However, it has special logic 7384 /// for emitting a single diagnostic even for operations where both LHS and RHS 7385 /// are (potentially problematic) pointers. 7386 /// 7387 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension). 7388 static bool checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7389 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7390 bool isLHSPointer = LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType(); 7391 bool isRHSPointer = RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType(); 7392 if (!isLHSPointer && !isRHSPointer) return true; 7393 7394 QualType LHSPointeeTy, RHSPointeeTy; 7395 if (isLHSPointer) LHSPointeeTy = LHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType(); 7396 if (isRHSPointer) RHSPointeeTy = RHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType(); 7397 7398 // if both are pointers check if operation is valid wrt address spaces 7399 if (isLHSPointer && isRHSPointer) { 7400 const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>(); 7401 const PointerType *rhsPtr = RHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>(); 7402 if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*rhsPtr)) { 7403 S.Diag(Loc, 7404 diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers) 7405 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << 1 /*arithmetic op*/ 7406 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 7407 return false; 7408 } 7409 } 7410 7411 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types. 7412 bool isLHSVoidPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isVoidType(); 7413 bool isRHSVoidPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isVoidType(); 7414 if (isLHSVoidPtr || isRHSVoidPtr) { 7415 if (!isRHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr); 7416 else if (!isLHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, RHSExpr); 7417 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 7418 7419 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 7420 } 7421 7422 bool isLHSFuncPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType(); 7423 bool isRHSFuncPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType(); 7424 if (isLHSFuncPtr || isRHSFuncPtr) { 7425 if (!isRHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr); 7426 else if (!isLHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, 7427 RHSExpr); 7428 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 7429 7430 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 7431 } 7432 7433 if (isLHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, LHSExpr)) 7434 return false; 7435 if (isRHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, RHSExpr)) 7436 return false; 7437 7438 return true; 7439 } 7440 7441 /// diagnoseStringPlusInt - Emit a warning when adding an integer to a string 7442 /// literal. 7443 static void diagnoseStringPlusInt(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 7444 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7445 StringLiteral* StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7446 Expr* IndexExpr = RHSExpr; 7447 if (!StrExpr) { 7448 StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7449 IndexExpr = LHSExpr; 7450 } 7451 7452 bool IsStringPlusInt = StrExpr && 7453 IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 7454 if (!IsStringPlusInt || IndexExpr->isValueDependent()) 7455 return; 7456 7457 llvm::APSInt index; 7458 if (IndexExpr->EvaluateAsInt(index, Self.getASTContext())) { 7459 unsigned StrLenWithNull = StrExpr->getLength() + 1; 7460 if (index.isNonNegative() && 7461 index <= llvm::APSInt(llvm::APInt(index.getBitWidth(), StrLenWithNull), 7462 index.isUnsigned())) 7463 return; 7464 } 7465 7466 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 7467 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_int) 7468 << DiagRange << IndexExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType(); 7469 7470 // Only print a fixit for "str" + int, not for int + "str". 7471 if (IndexExpr == RHSExpr) { 7472 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 7473 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence) 7474 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&") 7475 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[") 7476 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]"); 7477 } else 7478 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence); 7479 } 7480 7481 /// \brief Emit a warning when adding a char literal to a string. 7482 static void diagnoseStringPlusChar(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 7483 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7484 const Expr *StringRefExpr = LHSExpr; 7485 const CharacterLiteral *CharExpr = 7486 dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7487 7488 if (!CharExpr) { 7489 CharExpr = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7490 StringRefExpr = RHSExpr; 7491 } 7492 7493 if (!CharExpr || !StringRefExpr) 7494 return; 7495 7496 const QualType StringType = StringRefExpr->getType(); 7497 7498 // Return if not a PointerType. 7499 if (!StringType->isAnyPointerType()) 7500 return; 7501 7502 // Return if not a CharacterType. 7503 if (!StringType->getPointeeType()->isAnyCharacterType()) 7504 return; 7505 7506 ASTContext &Ctx = Self.getASTContext(); 7507 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 7508 7509 const QualType CharType = CharExpr->getType(); 7510 if (!CharType->isAnyCharacterType() && 7511 CharType->isIntegerType() && 7512 llvm::isUIntN(Ctx.getCharWidth(), CharExpr->getValue())) { 7513 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char) 7514 << DiagRange << Ctx.CharTy; 7515 } else { 7516 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char) 7517 << DiagRange << CharExpr->getType(); 7518 } 7519 7520 // Only print a fixit for str + char, not for char + str. 7521 if (isa<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts())) { 7522 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 7523 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence) 7524 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&") 7525 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[") 7526 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]"); 7527 } else { 7528 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence); 7529 } 7530 } 7531 7532 /// \brief Emit error when two pointers are incompatible. 7533 static void diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7534 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7535 assert(LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7536 assert(RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7537 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible) 7538 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 7539 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 7540 } 7541 7542 QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6 7543 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc, 7544 QualType* CompLHSTy) { 7545 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 7546 7547 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7548 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 7549 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy); 7550 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 7551 return compType; 7552 } 7553 7554 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy); 7555 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7556 return QualType(); 7557 7558 // Diagnose "string literal" '+' int and string '+' "char literal". 7559 if (Opc == BO_Add) { 7560 diagnoseStringPlusInt(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7561 diagnoseStringPlusChar(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7562 } 7563 7564 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic). 7565 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) { 7566 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 7567 return compType; 7568 } 7569 7570 // Type-checking. Ultimately the pointer's going to be in PExp; 7571 // note that we bias towards the LHS being the pointer. 7572 Expr *PExp = LHS.get(), *IExp = RHS.get(); 7573 7574 bool isObjCPointer; 7575 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) { 7576 isObjCPointer = false; 7577 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7578 isObjCPointer = true; 7579 } else { 7580 std::swap(PExp, IExp); 7581 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) { 7582 isObjCPointer = false; 7583 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7584 isObjCPointer = true; 7585 } else { 7586 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7587 } 7588 } 7589 assert(PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7590 7591 if (!IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) 7592 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7593 7594 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, PExp)) 7595 return QualType(); 7596 7597 if (isObjCPointer && checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, PExp)) 7598 return QualType(); 7599 7600 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic 7601 CheckArrayAccess(PExp, IExp); 7602 7603 if (CompLHSTy) { 7604 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get()); 7605 if (LHSTy.isNull()) { 7606 LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 7607 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType()) 7608 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy); 7609 } 7610 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy; 7611 } 7612 7613 return PExp->getType(); 7614 } 7615 7616 // C99 6.5.6 7617 QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7618 SourceLocation Loc, 7619 QualType* CompLHSTy) { 7620 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 7621 7622 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7623 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 7624 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy); 7625 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 7626 return compType; 7627 } 7628 7629 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy); 7630 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7631 return QualType(); 7632 7633 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3. 7634 7635 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic). 7636 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) { 7637 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 7638 return compType; 7639 } 7640 7641 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr. 7642 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) { 7643 QualType lpointee = LHS.get()->getType()->getPointeeType(); 7644 7645 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts. 7646 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 7647 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get())) 7648 return QualType(); 7649 7650 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type. 7651 if (RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) { 7652 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, LHS.get())) 7653 return QualType(); 7654 7655 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic 7656 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), /*ArraySubscriptExpr*/nullptr, 7657 /*AllowOnePastEnd*/true, /*IndexNegated*/true); 7658 7659 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 7660 return LHS.get()->getType(); 7661 } 7662 7663 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions. 7664 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy 7665 = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 7666 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType(); 7667 7668 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7669 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add] 7670 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) { 7671 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7672 } 7673 } else { 7674 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3 7675 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible( 7676 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(), 7677 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) { 7678 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7679 return QualType(); 7680 } 7681 } 7682 7683 if (!checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(*this, Loc, 7684 LHS.get(), RHS.get())) 7685 return QualType(); 7686 7687 // The pointee type may have zero size. As an extension, a structure or 7688 // union may have zero size or an array may have zero length. In this 7689 // case subtraction does not make sense. 7690 if (!rpointee->isVoidType() && !rpointee->isFunctionType()) { 7691 CharUnits ElementSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(rpointee); 7692 if (ElementSize.isZero()) { 7693 Diag(Loc,diag::warn_sub_ptr_zero_size_types) 7694 << rpointee.getUnqualifiedType() 7695 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7696 } 7697 } 7698 7699 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 7700 return Context.getPointerDiffType(); 7701 } 7702 } 7703 7704 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7705 } 7706 7707 static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) { 7708 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>()) 7709 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped(); 7710 return false; 7711 } 7712 7713 static void DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7714 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc, 7715 QualType LHSType) { 7716 // OpenCL 6.3j: shift values are effectively % word size of LHS (more defined), 7717 // so skip remaining warnings as we don't want to modify values within Sema. 7718 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) 7719 return; 7720 7721 llvm::APSInt Right; 7722 // Check right/shifter operand 7723 if (RHS.get()->isValueDependent() || 7724 !RHS.get()->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, S.Context)) 7725 return; 7726 7727 if (Right.isNegative()) { 7728 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 7729 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_negative) 7730 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 7731 return; 7732 } 7733 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(), 7734 S.Context.getTypeSize(LHS.get()->getType())); 7735 if (Right.uge(LeftBits)) { 7736 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 7737 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) 7738 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 7739 return; 7740 } 7741 if (Opc != BO_Shl) 7742 return; 7743 7744 // When left shifting an ICE which is signed, we can check for overflow which 7745 // according to C++ has undefined behavior ([expr.shift] 5.8/2). Unsigned 7746 // integers have defined behavior modulo one more than the maximum value 7747 // representable in the result type, so never warn for those. 7748 llvm::APSInt Left; 7749 if (LHS.get()->isValueDependent() || 7750 !LHS.get()->isIntegerConstantExpr(Left, S.Context) || 7751 LHSType->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation()) 7752 return; 7753 llvm::APInt ResultBits = 7754 static_cast<llvm::APInt&>(Right) + Left.getMinSignedBits(); 7755 if (LeftBits.uge(ResultBits)) 7756 return; 7757 llvm::APSInt Result = Left.extend(ResultBits.getLimitedValue()); 7758 Result = Result.shl(Right); 7759 7760 // Print the bit representation of the signed integer as an unsigned 7761 // hexadecimal number. 7762 SmallString<40> HexResult; 7763 Result.toString(HexResult, 16, /*Signed =*/false, /*Literal =*/true); 7764 7765 // If we are only missing a sign bit, this is less likely to result in actual 7766 // bugs -- if the result is cast back to an unsigned type, it will have the 7767 // expected value. Thus we place this behind a different warning that can be 7768 // turned off separately if needed. 7769 if (LeftBits == ResultBits - 1) { 7770 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_sets_sign_bit) 7771 << HexResult.str() << LHSType 7772 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7773 return; 7774 } 7775 7776 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_gt_typewidth) 7777 << HexResult.str() << Result.getMinSignedBits() << LHSType 7778 << Left.getBitWidth() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 7779 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7780 } 7781 7782 // C99 6.5.7 7783 QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7784 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc, 7785 bool IsCompAssign) { 7786 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 7787 7788 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type. 7789 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7790 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 7791 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 7792 7793 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer 7794 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3 7795 7796 // For the LHS, do usual unary conversions, but then reset them away 7797 // if this is a compound assignment. 7798 ExprResult OldLHS = LHS; 7799 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 7800 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 7801 return QualType(); 7802 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 7803 if (IsCompAssign) LHS = OldLHS; 7804 7805 // The RHS is simpler. 7806 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 7807 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 7808 return QualType(); 7809 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 7810 7811 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type. 7812 if (!LHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation() || 7813 !RHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 7814 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7815 7816 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than 7817 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this. 7818 if (isScopedEnumerationType(LHSType) || 7819 isScopedEnumerationType(RHSType)) { 7820 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7821 } 7822 // Sanity-check shift operands 7823 DiagnoseBadShiftValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc, LHSType); 7824 7825 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand." 7826 return LHSType; 7827 } 7828 7829 static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) { 7830 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) { 7831 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC)) 7832 return true; 7833 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)) 7834 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization(); 7835 } 7836 return false; 7837 } 7838 7839 /// If two different enums are compared, raise a warning. 7840 static void checkEnumComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *LHS, 7841 Expr *RHS) { 7842 QualType LHSStrippedType = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(); 7843 QualType RHSStrippedType = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(); 7844 7845 const EnumType *LHSEnumType = LHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>(); 7846 if (!LHSEnumType) 7847 return; 7848 const EnumType *RHSEnumType = RHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>(); 7849 if (!RHSEnumType) 7850 return; 7851 7852 // Ignore anonymous enums. 7853 if (!LHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier()) 7854 return; 7855 if (!RHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier()) 7856 return; 7857 7858 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType)) 7859 return; 7860 7861 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comparison_of_mixed_enum_types) 7862 << LHSStrippedType << RHSStrippedType 7863 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange(); 7864 } 7865 7866 /// \brief Diagnose bad pointer comparisons. 7867 static void diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7868 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7869 bool IsError) { 7870 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers 7871 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers) 7872 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 7873 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7874 } 7875 7876 /// \brief Returns false if the pointers are converted to a composite type, 7877 /// true otherwise. 7878 static bool convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7879 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS) { 7880 // C++ [expr.rel]p2: 7881 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification 7882 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on 7883 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring 7884 // them to their composite pointer type. [...] 7885 // 7886 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality 7887 // comparisons of pointers. 7888 7889 // C++ [expr.eq]p2: 7890 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to 7891 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions 7892 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring 7893 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant, 7894 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the 7895 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type 7896 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4) 7897 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand 7898 // types. 7899 7900 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 7901 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 7902 assert((LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) || 7903 (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType())); 7904 7905 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false; 7906 bool *BoolPtr = S.isSFINAEContext() ? nullptr : &NonStandardCompositeType; 7907 QualType T = S.FindCompositePointerType(Loc, LHS, RHS, BoolPtr); 7908 if (T.isNull()) { 7909 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(S, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/true); 7910 return true; 7911 } 7912 7913 if (NonStandardCompositeType) 7914 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard) 7915 << LHSType << RHSType << T << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 7916 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7917 7918 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast); 7919 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast); 7920 return false; 7921 } 7922 7923 static void diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7924 ExprResult &LHS, 7925 ExprResult &RHS, 7926 bool IsError) { 7927 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void 7928 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void) 7929 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 7930 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7931 } 7932 7933 static bool isObjCObjectLiteral(ExprResult &E) { 7934 switch (E.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getStmtClass()) { 7935 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass: 7936 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass: 7937 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass: 7938 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: 7939 return true; 7940 default: 7941 // Note that ObjCBoolLiteral is NOT an object literal! 7942 return false; 7943 } 7944 } 7945 7946 static bool hasIsEqualMethod(Sema &S, const Expr *LHS, const Expr *RHS) { 7947 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Type = 7948 LHS->getType()->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7949 7950 // If this is not actually an Objective-C object, bail out. 7951 if (!Type) 7952 return false; 7953 7954 // Get the LHS object's interface type. 7955 QualType InterfaceType = Type->getPointeeType(); 7956 if (const ObjCObjectType *iQFaceTy = 7957 InterfaceType->getAsObjCQualifiedInterfaceType()) 7958 InterfaceType = iQFaceTy->getBaseType(); 7959 7960 // If the RHS isn't an Objective-C object, bail out. 7961 if (!RHS->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 7962 return false; 7963 7964 // Try to find the -isEqual: method. 7965 Selector IsEqualSel = S.NSAPIObj->getIsEqualSelector(); 7966 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = S.LookupMethodInObjectType(IsEqualSel, 7967 InterfaceType, 7968 /*instance=*/true); 7969 if (!Method) { 7970 if (Type->isObjCIdType()) { 7971 // For 'id', just check the global pool. 7972 Method = S.LookupInstanceMethodInGlobalPool(IsEqualSel, SourceRange(), 7973 /*receiverId=*/true, 7974 /*warn=*/false); 7975 } else { 7976 // Check protocols. 7977 Method = S.LookupMethodInQualifiedType(IsEqualSel, Type, 7978 /*instance=*/true); 7979 } 7980 } 7981 7982 if (!Method) 7983 return false; 7984 7985 QualType T = Method->parameters()[0]->getType(); 7986 if (!T->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 7987 return false; 7988 7989 QualType R = Method->getReturnType(); 7990 if (!R->isScalarType()) 7991 return false; 7992 7993 return true; 7994 } 7995 7996 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind Sema::CheckLiteralKind(Expr *FromE) { 7997 FromE = FromE->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 7998 switch (FromE->getStmtClass()) { 7999 default: 8000 break; 8001 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass: 8002 // "string literal" 8003 return LK_String; 8004 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass: 8005 // "array literal" 8006 return LK_Array; 8007 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass: 8008 // "dictionary literal" 8009 return LK_Dictionary; 8010 case Stmt::BlockExprClass: 8011 return LK_Block; 8012 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: { 8013 Expr *Inner = cast<ObjCBoxedExpr>(FromE)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 8014 switch (Inner->getStmtClass()) { 8015 case Stmt::IntegerLiteralClass: 8016 case Stmt::FloatingLiteralClass: 8017 case Stmt::CharacterLiteralClass: 8018 case Stmt::ObjCBoolLiteralExprClass: 8019 case Stmt::CXXBoolLiteralExprClass: 8020 // "numeric literal" 8021 return LK_Numeric; 8022 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: { 8023 CastKind CK = cast<CastExpr>(Inner)->getCastKind(); 8024 // Boolean literals can be represented by implicit casts. 8025 if (CK == CK_IntegralToBoolean || CK == CK_IntegralCast) 8026 return LK_Numeric; 8027 break; 8028 } 8029 default: 8030 break; 8031 } 8032 return LK_Boxed; 8033 } 8034 } 8035 return LK_None; 8036 } 8037 8038 static void diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8039 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8040 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc){ 8041 Expr *Literal; 8042 Expr *Other; 8043 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS)) { 8044 Literal = LHS.get(); 8045 Other = RHS.get(); 8046 } else { 8047 Literal = RHS.get(); 8048 Other = LHS.get(); 8049 } 8050 8051 // Don't warn on comparisons against nil. 8052 Other = Other->IgnoreParenCasts(); 8053 if (Other->isNullPointerConstant(S.getASTContext(), 8054 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) 8055 return; 8056 8057 // This should be kept in sync with warn_objc_literal_comparison. 8058 // LK_String should always be after the other literals, since it has its own 8059 // warning flag. 8060 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind LiteralKind = S.CheckLiteralKind(Literal); 8061 assert(LiteralKind != Sema::LK_Block); 8062 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_None) { 8063 llvm_unreachable("Unknown Objective-C object literal kind"); 8064 } 8065 8066 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_String) 8067 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_string_literal_comparison) 8068 << Literal->getSourceRange(); 8069 else 8070 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_literal_comparison) 8071 << LiteralKind << Literal->getSourceRange(); 8072 8073 if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) && 8074 hasIsEqualMethod(S, LHS.get(), RHS.get())) { 8075 SourceLocation Start = LHS.get()->getLocStart(); 8076 SourceLocation End = S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd()); 8077 CharSourceRange OpRange = 8078 CharSourceRange::getCharRange(Loc, S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(Loc)); 8079 8080 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_objc_literal_comparison_isequal) 8081 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Start, Opc == BO_EQ ? "[" : "![") 8082 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpRange, " isEqual:") 8083 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(End, "]"); 8084 } 8085 } 8086 8087 static void diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofComparison(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 8088 ExprResult &RHS, 8089 SourceLocation Loc, 8090 unsigned OpaqueOpc) { 8091 // This checking requires bools. 8092 if (!S.getLangOpts().Bool) return; 8093 8094 // Check that left hand side is !something. 8095 UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 8096 if (!UO || UO->getOpcode() != UO_LNot) return; 8097 8098 // Only check if the right hand side is non-bool arithmetic type. 8099 if (RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType()) return; 8100 8101 // Make sure that the something in !something is not bool. 8102 Expr *SubExpr = UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImpCasts(); 8103 if (SubExpr->getType()->isBooleanType()) return; 8104 8105 // Emit warning. 8106 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_not_on_lhs_of_comparison) 8107 << Loc; 8108 8109 // First note suggest !(x < y) 8110 SourceLocation FirstOpen = SubExpr->getLocStart(); 8111 SourceLocation FirstClose = RHS.get()->getLocEnd(); 8112 FirstClose = S.getPreprocessor().getLocForEndOfToken(FirstClose); 8113 if (FirstClose.isInvalid()) 8114 FirstOpen = SourceLocation(); 8115 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_fix) 8116 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstOpen, "(") 8117 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstClose, ")"); 8118 8119 // Second note suggests (!x) < y 8120 SourceLocation SecondOpen = LHS.get()->getLocStart(); 8121 SourceLocation SecondClose = LHS.get()->getLocEnd(); 8122 SecondClose = S.getPreprocessor().getLocForEndOfToken(SecondClose); 8123 if (SecondClose.isInvalid()) 8124 SecondOpen = SourceLocation(); 8125 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_silence_with_parens) 8126 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondOpen, "(") 8127 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondClose, ")"); 8128 } 8129 8130 // Get the decl for a simple expression: a reference to a variable, 8131 // an implicit C++ field reference, or an implicit ObjC ivar reference. 8132 static ValueDecl *getCompareDecl(Expr *E) { 8133 if (DeclRefExpr* DR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 8134 return DR->getDecl(); 8135 if (ObjCIvarRefExpr* Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) { 8136 if (Ivar->isFreeIvar()) 8137 return Ivar->getDecl(); 8138 } 8139 if (MemberExpr* Mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 8140 if (Mem->isImplicitAccess()) 8141 return Mem->getMemberDecl(); 8142 } 8143 return nullptr; 8144 } 8145 8146 // C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel] 8147 QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8148 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned OpaqueOpc, 8149 bool IsRelational) { 8150 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/true); 8151 8152 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc; 8153 8154 // Handle vector comparisons separately. 8155 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 8156 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 8157 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsRelational); 8158 8159 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 8160 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 8161 8162 Expr *LHSStripped = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8163 Expr *RHSStripped = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8164 8165 checkEnumComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 8166 diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofComparison(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, OpaqueOpc); 8167 8168 if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() && 8169 !(LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && IsRelational) && 8170 !LHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID() && 8171 !RHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID() && 8172 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) { 8173 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form 8174 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and 8175 // often indicate logic errors in the program. 8176 // 8177 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro 8178 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self 8179 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch 8180 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to 8181 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same 8182 // result. 8183 ValueDecl *DL = getCompareDecl(LHSStripped); 8184 ValueDecl *DR = getCompareDecl(RHSStripped); 8185 if (DL && DR && DL == DR && !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DL)) { 8186 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 8187 << 0 // self- 8188 << (Opc == BO_EQ 8189 || Opc == BO_LE 8190 || Opc == BO_GE)); 8191 } else if (DL && DR && LHSType->isArrayType() && RHSType->isArrayType() && 8192 !DL->getType()->isReferenceType() && 8193 !DR->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 8194 // what is it always going to eval to? 8195 char always_evals_to; 8196 switch(Opc) { 8197 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2 8198 always_evals_to = 0; // false 8199 break; 8200 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2 8201 always_evals_to = 1; // true 8202 break; 8203 default: 8204 // best we can say is 'a constant' 8205 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2 8206 break; 8207 } 8208 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 8209 << 1 // array 8210 << always_evals_to); 8211 } 8212 8213 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped)) 8214 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts(); 8215 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped)) 8216 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts(); 8217 8218 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other 8219 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp. 8220 Expr *literalString = nullptr; 8221 Expr *literalStringStripped = nullptr; 8222 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) && 8223 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 8224 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 8225 literalString = LHS.get(); 8226 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped; 8227 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) || 8228 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) && 8229 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 8230 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 8231 literalString = RHS.get(); 8232 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped; 8233 } 8234 8235 if (literalString) { 8236 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 8237 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare) 8238 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped) 8239 << literalString->getSourceRange()); 8240 } 8241 } 8242 8243 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4 8244 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 8245 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 8246 return QualType(); 8247 8248 LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 8249 RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 8250 8251 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C. 8252 QualType ResultTy = Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 8253 8254 if (IsRelational) { 8255 if (LHSType->isRealType() && RHSType->isRealType()) 8256 return ResultTy; 8257 } else { 8258 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==. 8259 if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 8260 CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 8261 8262 if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType()) 8263 return ResultTy; 8264 } 8265 8266 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind LHSNullKind = 8267 LHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 8268 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind RHSNullKind = 8269 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 8270 bool LHSIsNull = LHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull; 8271 bool RHSIsNull = RHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull; 8272 8273 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) { 8274 bool IsEquality = Opc == BO_EQ; 8275 if (RHSIsNull) 8276 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(LHS.get(), RHSNullKind, IsEquality, 8277 RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 8278 else 8279 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(RHS.get(), LHSNullKind, IsEquality, 8280 LHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 8281 } 8282 8283 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except 8284 // when handling null pointer constants. 8285 if (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2 8286 QualType LCanPointeeTy = 8287 LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType(); 8288 QualType RCanPointeeTy = 8289 RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType(); 8290 8291 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8292 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy) 8293 return ResultTy; 8294 if (!IsRelational && 8295 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) { 8296 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer 8297 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison. 8298 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain 8299 // conformance with the C++ standard. 8300 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 8301 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 8302 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison( 8303 *this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/ (bool)isSFINAEContext()); 8304 8305 if (isSFINAEContext()) 8306 return QualType(); 8307 8308 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8309 return ResultTy; 8310 } 8311 } 8312 8313 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS)) 8314 return QualType(); 8315 else 8316 return ResultTy; 8317 } 8318 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2 8319 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(), 8320 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) { 8321 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers 8322 if (IsRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) { 8323 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers) 8324 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8325 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8326 } 8327 } else if (!IsRelational && 8328 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) { 8329 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer 8330 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 8331 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 8332 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 8333 /*isError*/false); 8334 } else { 8335 // Invalid 8336 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/false); 8337 } 8338 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy) { 8339 const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 8340 if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())) { 8341 Diag(Loc, 8342 diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers) 8343 << LHSType << RHSType << 0 /* comparison */ 8344 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8345 } 8346 unsigned AddrSpaceL = LCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace(); 8347 unsigned AddrSpaceR = RCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace(); 8348 CastKind Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion 8349 : CK_BitCast; 8350 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 8351 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, Kind); 8352 else 8353 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind); 8354 } 8355 return ResultTy; 8356 } 8357 8358 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8359 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself. 8360 if (LHSType->isNullPtrType() && RHSType->isNullPtrType()) 8361 return ResultTy; 8362 8363 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality 8364 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants. 8365 if (RHSIsNull && 8366 ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() || LHSType->isNullPtrType()) || 8367 (!IsRelational && 8368 (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || LHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) { 8369 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 8370 LHSType->isMemberPointerType() 8371 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer 8372 : CK_NullToPointer); 8373 return ResultTy; 8374 } 8375 if (LHSIsNull && 8376 ((RHSType->isAnyPointerType() || RHSType->isNullPtrType()) || 8377 (!IsRelational && 8378 (RHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) { 8379 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 8380 RHSType->isMemberPointerType() 8381 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer 8382 : CK_NullToPointer); 8383 return ResultTy; 8384 } 8385 8386 // Comparison of member pointers. 8387 if (!IsRelational && 8388 LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType()) { 8389 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS)) 8390 return QualType(); 8391 else 8392 return ResultTy; 8393 } 8394 8395 // Handle scoped enumeration types specifically, since they don't promote 8396 // to integers. 8397 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isEnumeralType() && 8398 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS.get()->getType(), 8399 RHS.get()->getType())) 8400 return ResultTy; 8401 } 8402 8403 // Handle block pointer types. 8404 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 8405 RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 8406 QualType lpointee = LHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 8407 QualType rpointee = RHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 8408 8409 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull && 8410 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) { 8411 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks) 8412 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8413 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8414 } 8415 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8416 return ResultTy; 8417 } 8418 8419 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants. 8420 if (!IsRelational 8421 && ((LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) 8422 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()))) { 8423 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 8424 if (!((RHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->castAs<PointerType>() 8425 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) 8426 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && LHSType->castAs<PointerType>() 8427 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()))) 8428 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks) 8429 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8430 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8431 } 8432 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 8433 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 8434 RHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast 8435 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 8436 else 8437 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 8438 LHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast 8439 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 8440 return ResultTy; 8441 } 8442 8443 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 8444 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 8445 const PointerType *LPT = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 8446 const PointerType *RPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 8447 if (LPT || RPT) { 8448 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ? LPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false; 8449 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ? RPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false; 8450 8451 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid && 8452 !Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) { 8453 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 8454 /*isError*/false); 8455 } 8456 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 8457 Expr *E = LHS.get(); 8458 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 8459 CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), RHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion); 8460 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, RHSType, 8461 RPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 8462 } 8463 else { 8464 Expr *E = RHS.get(); 8465 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 8466 CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), LHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, false, 8467 Opc); 8468 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, LHSType, 8469 LPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 8470 } 8471 return ResultTy; 8472 } 8473 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 8474 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 8475 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) 8476 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 8477 /*isError*/false); 8478 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS) || isObjCObjectLiteral(RHS)) 8479 diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, Opc); 8480 8481 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 8482 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 8483 else 8484 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8485 return ResultTy; 8486 } 8487 } 8488 if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) || 8489 (LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isAnyPointerType())) { 8490 unsigned DiagID = 0; 8491 bool isError = false; 8492 if (LangOpts.DebuggerSupport) { 8493 // Under a debugger, allow the comparison of pointers to integers, 8494 // since users tend to want to compare addresses. 8495 } else if ((LHSIsNull && LHSType->isIntegerType()) || 8496 (RHSIsNull && RHSType->isIntegerType())) { 8497 if (IsRelational && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 8498 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero; 8499 } else if (IsRelational && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 8500 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 8501 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8502 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 8503 isError = true; 8504 } else 8505 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 8506 8507 if (DiagID) { 8508 Diag(Loc, DiagID) 8509 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8510 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8511 if (isError) 8512 return QualType(); 8513 } 8514 8515 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) 8516 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 8517 LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer); 8518 else 8519 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 8520 RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer); 8521 return ResultTy; 8522 } 8523 8524 // Handle block pointers. 8525 if (!IsRelational && RHSIsNull 8526 && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8527 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 8528 return ResultTy; 8529 } 8530 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull 8531 && LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 8532 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 8533 return ResultTy; 8534 } 8535 8536 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8537 } 8538 8539 8540 // Return a signed type that is of identical size and number of elements. 8541 // For floating point vectors, return an integer type of identical size 8542 // and number of elements. 8543 QualType Sema::GetSignedVectorType(QualType V) { 8544 const VectorType *VTy = V->getAs<VectorType>(); 8545 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType()); 8546 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy)) 8547 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8548 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy)) 8549 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8550 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy)) 8551 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8552 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy)) 8553 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8554 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) && 8555 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare"); 8556 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8557 } 8558 8559 /// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that 8560 /// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result, 8561 /// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer 8562 /// types. 8563 QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8564 SourceLocation Loc, 8565 bool IsRelational) { 8566 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width, 8567 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type. 8568 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompAssign*/false); 8569 if (vType.isNull()) 8570 return vType; 8571 8572 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 8573 8574 // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e. 8575 // bool for C++, int for C 8576 if (vType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) 8577 return Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 8578 8579 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form 8580 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and 8581 // often indicate logic errors in the program. 8582 if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() && 8583 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) { 8584 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL 8585 = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) 8586 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR 8587 = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) 8588 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl()) 8589 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 8590 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 8591 << 0 // self- 8592 << 2 // "a constant" 8593 ); 8594 } 8595 8596 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==. 8597 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) { 8598 assert (RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation()); 8599 CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 8600 } 8601 8602 // Return a signed type for the vector. 8603 return GetSignedVectorType(LHSType); 8604 } 8605 8606 QualType Sema::CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8607 SourceLocation Loc) { 8608 // Ensure that either both operands are of the same vector type, or 8609 // one operand is of a vector type and the other is of its element type. 8610 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, false); 8611 if (vType.isNull()) 8612 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8613 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120 && 8614 vType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 8615 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8616 8617 return GetSignedVectorType(LHS.get()->getType()); 8618 } 8619 8620 inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands( 8621 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 8622 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 8623 8624 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 8625 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 8626 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() && 8627 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 8628 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 8629 8630 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8631 } 8632 8633 ExprResult LHSResult = LHS, RHSResult = RHS; 8634 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHSResult, RHSResult, 8635 IsCompAssign); 8636 if (LHSResult.isInvalid() || RHSResult.isInvalid()) 8637 return QualType(); 8638 LHS = LHSResult.get(); 8639 RHS = RHSResult.get(); 8640 8641 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 8642 return compType; 8643 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8644 } 8645 8646 inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14] 8647 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) { 8648 8649 // Check vector operands differently. 8650 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 8651 return CheckVectorLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc); 8652 8653 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a 8654 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS 8655 // is a constant. 8656 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && 8657 !LHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() && 8658 RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 8659 // Don't warn in macros or template instantiations. 8660 !Loc.isMacroID() && ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) { 8661 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something 8662 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that 8663 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn. 8664 // Parens on the RHS are ignored. 8665 llvm::APSInt Result; 8666 if (RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) 8667 if ((getLangOpts().Bool && !RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() && 8668 !RHS.get()->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) || 8669 (Result != 0 && Result != 1)) { 8670 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise) 8671 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8672 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||"); 8673 // Suggest replacing the logical operator with the bitwise version 8674 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_change_operator) 8675 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|") 8676 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange( 8677 Loc, Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(Loc, 0, getSourceManager(), 8678 getLangOpts())), 8679 Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|"); 8680 if (Opc == BO_LAnd) 8681 // Suggest replacing "Foo() && kNonZero" with "Foo()" 8682 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_remove_constant) 8683 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 8684 SourceRange( 8685 Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(LHS.get()->getLocEnd(), 8686 0, getSourceManager(), 8687 getLangOpts()), 8688 RHS.get()->getLocEnd())); 8689 } 8690 } 8691 8692 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8693 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.g: The logical operators and (&&), or (||) do 8694 // not operate on the built-in scalar and vector float types. 8695 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 8696 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 8697 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType() || 8698 RHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType()) 8699 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8700 } 8701 8702 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 8703 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 8704 return QualType(); 8705 8706 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 8707 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8708 return QualType(); 8709 8710 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType() || 8711 !RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType()) 8712 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8713 8714 return Context.IntTy; 8715 } 8716 8717 // The following is safe because we only use this method for 8718 // non-overloadable operands. 8719 8720 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1 8721 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1 8722 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool. 8723 ExprResult LHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(LHS.get()); 8724 if (LHSRes.isInvalid()) 8725 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8726 LHS = LHSRes; 8727 8728 ExprResult RHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(RHS.get()); 8729 if (RHSRes.isInvalid()) 8730 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8731 RHS = RHSRes; 8732 8733 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2 8734 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2 8735 // The result is a bool. 8736 return Context.BoolTy; 8737 } 8738 8739 static bool IsReadonlyMessage(Expr *E, Sema &S) { 8740 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E); 8741 if (!ME) return false; 8742 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) return false; 8743 ObjCMessageExpr *Base = 8744 dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 8745 if (!Base) return false; 8746 return Base->getMethodDecl() != nullptr; 8747 } 8748 8749 /// Is the given expression (which must be 'const') a reference to a 8750 /// variable which was originally non-const, but which has become 8751 /// 'const' due to being captured within a block? 8752 enum NonConstCaptureKind { NCCK_None, NCCK_Block, NCCK_Lambda }; 8753 static NonConstCaptureKind isReferenceToNonConstCapture(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 8754 assert(E->isLValue() && E->getType().isConstQualified()); 8755 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 8756 8757 // Must be a reference to a declaration from an enclosing scope. 8758 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 8759 if (!DRE) return NCCK_None; 8760 if (!DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) return NCCK_None; 8761 8762 // The declaration must be a variable which is not declared 'const'. 8763 VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 8764 if (!var) return NCCK_None; 8765 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) return NCCK_None; 8766 assert(var->hasLocalStorage() && "capture added 'const' to non-local?"); 8767 8768 // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda. 8769 DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext, *Prev = nullptr; 8770 while (DC != var->getDeclContext()) { 8771 Prev = DC; 8772 DC = DC->getParent(); 8773 } 8774 // Unless we have an init-capture, we've gone one step too far. 8775 if (!var->isInitCapture()) 8776 DC = Prev; 8777 return (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) ? NCCK_Block : NCCK_Lambda); 8778 } 8779 8780 /// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not, 8781 /// emit an error and return true. If so, return false. 8782 static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) { 8783 assert(!E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject)); 8784 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc; 8785 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context, 8786 &Loc); 8787 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary && IsReadonlyMessage(E, S)) 8788 IsLV = Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression; 8789 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid) 8790 return false; 8791 8792 unsigned DiagID = 0; 8793 bool NeedType = false; 8794 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2 8795 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: 8796 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; 8797 8798 // Use a specialized diagnostic when we're assigning to an object 8799 // from an enclosing function or block. 8800 if (NonConstCaptureKind NCCK = isReferenceToNonConstCapture(S, E)) { 8801 if (NCCK == NCCK_Block) 8802 DiagID = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue; 8803 else 8804 DiagID = diag::err_lambda_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue; 8805 break; 8806 } 8807 8808 // In ARC, use some specialized diagnostics for occasions where we 8809 // infer 'const'. These are always pseudo-strong variables. 8810 if (S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 8811 DeclRefExpr *declRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()); 8812 if (declRef && isa<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl())) { 8813 VarDecl *var = cast<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl()); 8814 8815 // Use the normal diagnostic if it's pseudo-__strong but the 8816 // user actually wrote 'const'. 8817 if (var->isARCPseudoStrong() && 8818 (!var->getTypeSourceInfo() || 8819 !var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType().isConstQualified())) { 8820 // There are two pseudo-strong cases: 8821 // - self 8822 ObjCMethodDecl *method = S.getCurMethodDecl(); 8823 if (method && var == method->getSelfDecl()) 8824 DiagID = method->isClassMethod() 8825 ? diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self_class_method 8826 : diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self; 8827 8828 // - fast enumeration variables 8829 else 8830 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arr_assign_enumeration; 8831 8832 SourceRange Assign; 8833 if (Loc != OrigLoc) 8834 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc); 8835 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 8836 // We need to preserve the AST regardless, so migration tool 8837 // can do its job. 8838 return false; 8839 } 8840 } 8841 } 8842 8843 break; 8844 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType: 8845 case Expr::MLV_ArrayTemporary: 8846 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue; 8847 NeedType = true; 8848 break; 8849 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType: 8850 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue; 8851 NeedType = true; 8852 break; 8853 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast: 8854 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported; 8855 break; 8856 case Expr::MLV_Valid: 8857 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid"); 8858 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression: 8859 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction: 8860 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary: 8861 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue; 8862 break; 8863 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType: 8864 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType: 8865 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(), 8866 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue, E); 8867 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents: 8868 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue; 8869 break; 8870 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty: 8871 llvm_unreachable("readonly properties should be processed differently"); 8872 case Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression: 8873 DiagID = diag::error_readonly_message_assignment; 8874 break; 8875 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting: 8876 DiagID = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting; 8877 break; 8878 } 8879 8880 SourceRange Assign; 8881 if (Loc != OrigLoc) 8882 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc); 8883 if (NeedType) 8884 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 8885 else 8886 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 8887 return true; 8888 } 8889 8890 static void CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 8891 SourceLocation Loc, 8892 Sema &Sema) { 8893 // C / C++ fields 8894 MemberExpr *ML = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(LHSExpr); 8895 MemberExpr *MR = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(RHSExpr); 8896 if (ML && MR && ML->getMemberDecl() == MR->getMemberDecl()) { 8897 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(ML->getBase()) && isa<CXXThisExpr>(MR->getBase())) 8898 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 0; 8899 } 8900 8901 // Objective-C instance variables 8902 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OL = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHSExpr); 8903 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OR = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(RHSExpr); 8904 if (OL && OR && OL->getDecl() == OR->getDecl()) { 8905 DeclRefExpr *RL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OL->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 8906 DeclRefExpr *RR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OR->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 8907 if (RL && RR && RL->getDecl() == RR->getDecl()) 8908 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 1; 8909 } 8910 } 8911 8912 // C99 6.5.16.1 8913 QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS, 8914 SourceLocation Loc, 8915 QualType CompoundType) { 8916 assert(!LHSExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject)); 8917 8918 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not. 8919 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHSExpr, Loc, *this)) 8920 return QualType(); 8921 8922 QualType LHSType = LHSExpr->getType(); 8923 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS.get()->getType() : 8924 CompoundType; 8925 AssignConvertType ConvTy; 8926 if (CompoundType.isNull()) { 8927 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS.get(); 8928 8929 CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHSExpr, RHSCheck, Loc, *this); 8930 8931 QualType LHSTy(LHSType); 8932 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS); 8933 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8934 return QualType(); 8935 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types. 8936 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer && 8937 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) && 8938 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) || 8939 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) && 8940 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()))) 8941 ConvTy = Compatible; 8942 8943 if (ConvTy == Compatible && 8944 LHSType->isObjCObjectType()) 8945 Diag(Loc, diag::err_objc_object_assignment) 8946 << LHSType; 8947 8948 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are 8949 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4" 8950 // instead of "x += 4". 8951 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck)) 8952 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr(); 8953 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) { 8954 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus || 8955 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) && 8956 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() && 8957 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent. 8958 Loc.getLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() && 8959 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the 8960 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1". 8961 Loc.getLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() && 8962 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) { 8963 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign) 8964 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-") 8965 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc()); 8966 } 8967 } 8968 8969 if (ConvTy == Compatible) { 8970 if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong) { 8971 // Warn about retain cycles where a block captures the LHS, but 8972 // not if the LHS is a simple variable into which the block is 8973 // being stored...unless that variable can be captured by reference! 8974 const Expr *InnerLHS = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenCasts(); 8975 const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InnerLHS); 8976 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl()->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 8977 checkRetainCycles(LHSExpr, RHS.get()); 8978 8979 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable. 8980 // Although this code can still have problems: 8981 // id x = self.weakProp; 8982 // id y = self.weakProp; 8983 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate 8984 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if 8985 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive. 8986 if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, 8987 RHS.get()->getLocStart())) 8988 getCurFunction()->markSafeWeakUse(RHS.get()); 8989 8990 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 8991 checkUnsafeExprAssigns(Loc, LHSExpr, RHS.get()); 8992 } 8993 } 8994 } else { 8995 // Compound assignment "x += y" 8996 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(Loc, LHSType, RHSType); 8997 } 8998 8999 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType, 9000 RHS.get(), AA_Assigning)) 9001 return QualType(); 9002 9003 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, LHSExpr); 9004 9005 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the 9006 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case 9007 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand. 9008 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand 9009 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above). 9010 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left 9011 // operand. 9012 return (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 9013 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType()); 9014 } 9015 9016 // C99 6.5.17 9017 static QualType CheckCommaOperands(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9018 SourceLocation Loc) { 9019 LHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get()); 9020 RHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get()); 9021 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9022 return QualType(); 9023 9024 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its 9025 // operands, but not unary promotions. 9026 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1). 9027 9028 // So we treat the LHS as a ignored value, and in C++ we allow the 9029 // containing site to determine what should be done with the RHS. 9030 LHS = S.IgnoredValueConversions(LHS.get()); 9031 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 9032 return QualType(); 9033 9034 S.DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS.get()); 9035 9036 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9037 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 9038 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 9039 return QualType(); 9040 if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isVoidType()) 9041 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS.get()->getType(), 9042 diag::err_incomplete_type); 9043 } 9044 9045 return RHS.get()->getType(); 9046 } 9047 9048 /// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine 9049 /// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions. 9050 static QualType CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, 9051 ExprValueKind &VK, 9052 ExprObjectKind &OK, 9053 SourceLocation OpLoc, 9054 bool IsInc, bool IsPrefix) { 9055 if (Op->isTypeDependent()) 9056 return S.Context.DependentTy; 9057 9058 QualType ResType = Op->getType(); 9059 // Atomic types can be used for increment / decrement where the non-atomic 9060 // versions can, so ignore the _Atomic() specifier for the purpose of 9061 // checking. 9062 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 9063 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 9064 9065 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression"); 9066 9067 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) { 9068 // Decrement of bool is not allowed. 9069 if (!IsInc) { 9070 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange(); 9071 return QualType(); 9072 } 9073 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated. 9074 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange(); 9075 } else if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isEnumeralType()) { 9076 // Error on enum increments and decrements in C++ mode 9077 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_increment_decrement_enum) << IsInc << ResType; 9078 return QualType(); 9079 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) { 9080 // OK! 9081 } else if (ResType->isPointerType()) { 9082 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2 9083 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(S, OpLoc, Op)) 9084 return QualType(); 9085 } else if (ResType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9086 // On modern runtimes, ObjC pointer arithmetic is forbidden. 9087 // Otherwise, we just need a complete type. 9088 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, OpLoc, Op) || 9089 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(S, OpLoc, Op)) 9090 return QualType(); 9091 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) { 9092 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension. 9093 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex) 9094 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange(); 9095 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) { 9096 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op); 9097 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 9098 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OK, OpLoc, 9099 IsInc, IsPrefix); 9100 } else if (S.getLangOpts().AltiVec && ResType->isVectorType()) { 9101 // OK! ( C/C++ Language Extensions for CBEA(Version 2.6) 10.3 ) 9102 } else if(S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && ResType->isVectorType() && 9103 ResType->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) { 9104 // OpenCL V1.2 6.3 says dec/inc ops operate on integer vector types. 9105 } else { 9106 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement) 9107 << ResType << int(IsInc) << Op->getSourceRange(); 9108 return QualType(); 9109 } 9110 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type. 9111 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue. 9112 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, S)) 9113 return QualType(); 9114 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise 9115 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the 9116 // operand. 9117 if (IsPrefix && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9118 VK = VK_LValue; 9119 OK = Op->getObjectKind(); 9120 return ResType; 9121 } else { 9122 VK = VK_RValue; 9123 return ResType.getUnqualifiedType(); 9124 } 9125 } 9126 9127 9128 /// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand(). 9129 /// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions 9130 /// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to 9131 /// handle cases when the expression references a function designator 9132 /// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples: 9133 /// - &(x) => x 9134 /// - &*****f => f for f a function designator. 9135 /// - &s.xx => s 9136 /// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array 9137 /// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array 9138 /// - &"123"[2] -> 0 9139 /// - & __real__ x -> x 9140 static ValueDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) { 9141 switch (E->getStmtClass()) { 9142 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass: 9143 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl(); 9144 case Stmt::MemberExprClass: 9145 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from 9146 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is 9147 // irrelevant. 9148 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow()) 9149 return nullptr; 9150 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base 9151 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase()); 9152 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: { 9153 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit 9154 // promotion of register arrays earlier. 9155 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase(); 9156 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) { 9157 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType()) 9158 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr()); 9159 } 9160 return nullptr; 9161 } 9162 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: { 9163 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E); 9164 9165 switch(UO->getOpcode()) { 9166 case UO_Real: 9167 case UO_Imag: 9168 case UO_Extension: 9169 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr()); 9170 default: 9171 return nullptr; 9172 } 9173 } 9174 case Stmt::ParenExprClass: 9175 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr()); 9176 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: 9177 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about 9178 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter. 9179 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr()); 9180 default: 9181 return nullptr; 9182 } 9183 } 9184 9185 namespace { 9186 enum { 9187 AO_Bit_Field = 0, 9188 AO_Vector_Element = 1, 9189 AO_Property_Expansion = 2, 9190 AO_Register_Variable = 3, 9191 AO_No_Error = 4 9192 }; 9193 } 9194 /// \brief Diagnose invalid operand for address of operations. 9195 /// 9196 /// \param Type The type of operand which cannot have its address taken. 9197 static void diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9198 Expr *E, unsigned Type) { 9199 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of) << Type << E->getSourceRange(); 9200 } 9201 9202 /// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function 9203 /// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the 9204 /// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field. 9205 /// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the & 9206 /// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue. 9207 /// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case 9208 /// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type. 9209 QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult &OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 9210 if (const BuiltinType *PTy = OrigOp.get()->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()){ 9211 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 9212 Expr *E = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens(); 9213 if (!isa<OverloadExpr>(E)) { 9214 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf); 9215 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof_addrof_function) 9216 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 9217 return QualType(); 9218 } 9219 9220 OverloadExpr *Ovl = cast<OverloadExpr>(E); 9221 if (isa<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Ovl)) 9222 if (!ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Ovl)) { 9223 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 9224 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 9225 return QualType(); 9226 } 9227 9228 return Context.OverloadTy; 9229 } 9230 9231 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny) 9232 return Context.UnknownAnyTy; 9233 9234 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember) { 9235 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 9236 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 9237 return QualType(); 9238 } 9239 9240 OrigOp = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp.get()); 9241 if (OrigOp.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 9242 } 9243 9244 if (OrigOp.get()->isTypeDependent()) 9245 return Context.DependentTy; 9246 9247 assert(!OrigOp.get()->getType()->isPlaceholderType()); 9248 9249 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks 9250 Expr *op = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens(); 9251 9252 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed. 9253 if (LangOpts.OpenCL && op->getType()->isFunctionType()) { 9254 Diag(op->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_function_address); 9255 return QualType(); 9256 } 9257 9258 if (getLangOpts().C99) { 9259 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules. 9260 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) { 9261 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref) 9262 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result 9263 // (assuming the deref expression is valid). 9264 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType(); 9265 } 9266 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript 9267 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway. 9268 } 9269 ValueDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op); 9270 Expr::LValueClassification lval = op->ClassifyLValue(Context); 9271 unsigned AddressOfError = AO_No_Error; 9272 9273 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary || lval == Expr::LV_ArrayTemporary) { 9274 bool sfinae = (bool)isSFINAEContext(); 9275 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_temporary 9276 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_temporary) 9277 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange(); 9278 if (sfinae) 9279 return QualType(); 9280 // Materialize the temporary as an lvalue so that we can take its address. 9281 OrigOp = op = new (Context) 9282 MaterializeTemporaryExpr(op->getType(), OrigOp.get(), true); 9283 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) { 9284 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType()); 9285 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) { 9286 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer. 9287 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo. 9288 9289 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up. 9290 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) { 9291 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 9292 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 9293 return QualType(); 9294 } 9295 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op); 9296 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 9297 9298 // The id-expression was parenthesized. 9299 if (OrigOp.get() != DRE) { 9300 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function) 9301 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 9302 9303 // The method was named without a qualifier. 9304 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) { 9305 if (MD->getParent()->getName().empty()) 9306 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function) 9307 << op->getSourceRange(); 9308 else { 9309 SmallString<32> Str; 9310 StringRef Qual = (MD->getParent()->getName() + "::").toStringRef(Str); 9311 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function) 9312 << op->getSourceRange() 9313 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(op->getSourceRange().getBegin(), Qual); 9314 } 9315 } 9316 9317 // Taking the address of a dtor is illegal per C++ [class.dtor]p2. 9318 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) 9319 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_addrof_dtor) << op->getSourceRange(); 9320 9321 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType( 9322 op->getType(), Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr()); 9323 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 9324 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy, 0); 9325 return MPTy; 9326 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) { 9327 // C99 6.5.3.2p1 9328 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator 9329 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) { 9330 // Use a special diagnostic for loads from property references. 9331 if (isa<PseudoObjectExpr>(op)) { 9332 AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion; 9333 } else { 9334 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof) 9335 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange(); 9336 return QualType(); 9337 } 9338 } 9339 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1 9340 // The operand cannot be a bit-field 9341 AddressOfError = AO_Bit_Field; 9342 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_VectorComponent) { 9343 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector 9344 AddressOfError = AO_Vector_Element; 9345 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1 9346 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared 9347 // with the register storage-class specifier. 9348 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) { 9349 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register 9350 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3) 9351 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register && 9352 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9353 AddressOfError = AO_Register_Variable; 9354 } 9355 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) { 9356 return Context.OverloadTy; 9357 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(dcl) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(dcl)) { 9358 // Okay: we can take the address of a field. 9359 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit 9360 // scope qualifier for the class. 9361 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) { 9362 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext(); 9363 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) { 9364 if (dcl->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 9365 Diag(OpLoc, 9366 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type) 9367 << dcl->getDeclName() << dcl->getType(); 9368 return QualType(); 9369 } 9370 9371 while (cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) 9372 Ctx = Ctx->getParent(); 9373 9374 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType( 9375 op->getType(), 9376 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr()); 9377 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 9378 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy, 0); 9379 return MPTy; 9380 } 9381 } 9382 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl) && !isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(dcl)) 9383 llvm_unreachable("Unknown/unexpected decl type"); 9384 } 9385 9386 if (AddressOfError != AO_No_Error) { 9387 diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(*this, OpLoc, op, AddressOfError); 9388 return QualType(); 9389 } 9390 9391 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) { 9392 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we 9393 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid. 9394 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;". 9395 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange(); 9396 } 9397 9398 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type". 9399 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType()) 9400 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType()); 9401 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType()); 9402 } 9403 9404 static void RecordModifiableNonNullParam(Sema &S, const Expr *Exp) { 9405 const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Exp); 9406 if (!DRE) 9407 return; 9408 const Decl *D = DRE->getDecl(); 9409 if (!D) 9410 return; 9411 const ParmVarDecl *Param = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D); 9412 if (!Param) 9413 return; 9414 if (const FunctionDecl* FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Param->getDeclContext())) 9415 if (!FD->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>() && !Param->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>()) 9416 return; 9417 if (FunctionScopeInfo *FD = S.getCurFunction()) 9418 if (!FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.count(Param)) 9419 FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.insert(Param); 9420 } 9421 9422 /// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*'). 9423 static QualType CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, ExprValueKind &VK, 9424 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 9425 if (Op->isTypeDependent()) 9426 return S.Context.DependentTy; 9427 9428 ExprResult ConvResult = S.UsualUnaryConversions(Op); 9429 if (ConvResult.isInvalid()) 9430 return QualType(); 9431 Op = ConvResult.get(); 9432 QualType OpTy = Op->getType(); 9433 QualType Result; 9434 9435 if (isa<CXXReinterpretCastExpr>(Op)) { 9436 QualType OpOrigType = Op->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType(); 9437 S.CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(OpOrigType, OpTy, /*IsDereference*/true, 9438 Op->getSourceRange()); 9439 } 9440 9441 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 9442 Result = PT->getPointeeType(); 9443 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = 9444 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 9445 Result = OPT->getPointeeType(); 9446 else { 9447 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op); 9448 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 9449 if (PR.get() != Op) 9450 return CheckIndirectionOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OpLoc); 9451 } 9452 9453 if (Result.isNull()) { 9454 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer) 9455 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange(); 9456 return QualType(); 9457 } 9458 9459 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if Result 9460 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about 9461 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a 9462 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes. In C++, indirection is not valid 9463 // for pointers to 'void' but is fine for any other pointer type: 9464 // 9465 // C++ [expr.unary.op]p1: 9466 // [...] the expression to which [the unary * operator] is applied shall 9467 // be a pointer to an object type, or a pointer to a function type 9468 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result->isVoidType()) 9469 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_indirection_through_void_pointer) 9470 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange(); 9471 9472 // Dereferences are usually l-values... 9473 VK = VK_LValue; 9474 9475 // ...except that certain expressions are never l-values in C. 9476 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result.isCForbiddenLValueType()) 9477 VK = VK_RValue; 9478 9479 return Result; 9480 } 9481 9482 BinaryOperatorKind Sema::ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind) { 9483 BinaryOperatorKind Opc; 9484 switch (Kind) { 9485 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!"); 9486 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break; 9487 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break; 9488 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break; 9489 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break; 9490 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break; 9491 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break; 9492 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break; 9493 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break; 9494 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break; 9495 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break; 9496 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break; 9497 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break; 9498 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break; 9499 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break; 9500 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break; 9501 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break; 9502 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break; 9503 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break; 9504 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break; 9505 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break; 9506 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break; 9507 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break; 9508 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break; 9509 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break; 9510 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break; 9511 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break; 9512 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break; 9513 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break; 9514 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break; 9515 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break; 9516 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break; 9517 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break; 9518 } 9519 return Opc; 9520 } 9521 9522 static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode( 9523 tok::TokenKind Kind) { 9524 UnaryOperatorKind Opc; 9525 switch (Kind) { 9526 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!"); 9527 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break; 9528 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break; 9529 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break; 9530 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break; 9531 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break; 9532 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break; 9533 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break; 9534 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break; 9535 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break; 9536 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break; 9537 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break; 9538 } 9539 return Opc; 9540 } 9541 9542 /// DiagnoseSelfAssignment - Emits a warning if a value is assigned to itself. 9543 /// This warning is only emitted for builtin assignment operations. It is also 9544 /// suppressed in the event of macro expansions. 9545 static void DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema &S, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 9546 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 9547 if (!S.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) 9548 return; 9549 if (OpLoc.isInvalid() || OpLoc.isMacroID()) 9550 return; 9551 LHSExpr = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 9552 RHSExpr = RHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 9553 const DeclRefExpr *LHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr); 9554 const DeclRefExpr *RHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSExpr); 9555 if (!LHSDeclRef || !RHSDeclRef || 9556 LHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID() || 9557 RHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID()) 9558 return; 9559 const ValueDecl *LHSDecl = 9560 cast<ValueDecl>(LHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 9561 const ValueDecl *RHSDecl = 9562 cast<ValueDecl>(RHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 9563 if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl) 9564 return; 9565 if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 9566 return; 9567 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 9568 if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified()) 9569 return; 9570 9571 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_self_assignment) 9572 << LHSDeclRef->getType() 9573 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 9574 } 9575 9576 /// Check if a bitwise-& is performed on an Objective-C pointer. This 9577 /// is usually indicative of introspection within the Objective-C pointer. 9578 static void checkObjCPointerIntrospection(Sema &S, ExprResult &L, ExprResult &R, 9579 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 9580 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1) 9581 return; 9582 9583 const Expr *ObjCPointerExpr = nullptr, *OtherExpr = nullptr; 9584 const Expr *LHS = L.get(); 9585 const Expr *RHS = R.get(); 9586 9587 if (LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9588 ObjCPointerExpr = LHS; 9589 OtherExpr = RHS; 9590 } 9591 else if (RHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9592 ObjCPointerExpr = RHS; 9593 OtherExpr = LHS; 9594 } 9595 9596 // This warning is deliberately made very specific to reduce false 9597 // positives with logic that uses '&' for hashing. This logic mainly 9598 // looks for code trying to introspect into tagged pointers, which 9599 // code should generally never do. 9600 if (ObjCPointerExpr && isa<IntegerLiteral>(OtherExpr->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 9601 unsigned Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking; 9602 // Determine if we are introspecting the result of performSelectorXXX. 9603 const Expr *Ex = ObjCPointerExpr->IgnoreParenCasts(); 9604 // Special case messages to -performSelector and friends, which 9605 // can return non-pointer values boxed in a pointer value. 9606 // Some clients may wish to silence warnings in this subcase. 9607 if (const ObjCMessageExpr *ME = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Ex)) { 9608 Selector S = ME->getSelector(); 9609 StringRef SelArg0 = S.getNameForSlot(0); 9610 if (SelArg0.startswith("performSelector")) 9611 Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking_performSelector; 9612 } 9613 9614 S.Diag(OpLoc, Diag) 9615 << ObjCPointerExpr->getSourceRange(); 9616 } 9617 } 9618 9619 static NamedDecl *getDeclFromExpr(Expr *E) { 9620 if (!E) 9621 return nullptr; 9622 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 9623 return DRE->getDecl(); 9624 if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) 9625 return ME->getMemberDecl(); 9626 if (auto *IRE = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) 9627 return IRE->getDecl(); 9628 return nullptr; 9629 } 9630 9631 /// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with 9632 /// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports 9633 /// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators. 9634 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 9635 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9636 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9637 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isa<InitListExpr>(RHSExpr)) { 9638 // The syntax only allows initializer lists on the RHS of assignment, 9639 // so we don't need to worry about accepting invalid code for 9640 // non-assignment operators. 9641 // C++11 5.17p9: 9642 // The meaning of x = {v} [...] is that of x = T(v) [...]. The meaning 9643 // of x = {} is x = T(). 9644 InitializationKind Kind = 9645 InitializationKind::CreateDirectList(RHSExpr->getLocStart()); 9646 InitializedEntity Entity = 9647 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(LHSExpr->getType()); 9648 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr); 9649 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr); 9650 if (Init.isInvalid()) 9651 return Init; 9652 RHSExpr = Init.get(); 9653 } 9654 9655 ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 9656 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator. 9657 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators 9658 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation 9659 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result 9660 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 9661 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 9662 9663 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9664 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it 9665 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 9666 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 9667 LHS = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(LHSExpr); 9668 RHS = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(RHSExpr, [Opc, LHS](Expr *E) { 9669 if (Opc != BO_Assign) 9670 return ExprResult(E); 9671 // Avoid correcting the RHS to the same Expr as the LHS. 9672 Decl *D = getDeclFromExpr(E); 9673 return (D && D == getDeclFromExpr(LHS.get())) ? ExprError() : E; 9674 }); 9675 if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable()) 9676 return ExprError(); 9677 } 9678 9679 switch (Opc) { 9680 case BO_Assign: 9681 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, QualType()); 9682 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 9683 LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) { 9684 VK = LHS.get()->getValueKind(); 9685 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 9686 } 9687 if (!ResultTy.isNull()) { 9688 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc); 9689 DiagnoseSelfMove(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc); 9690 } 9691 RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, LHS.get()); 9692 break; 9693 case BO_PtrMemD: 9694 case BO_PtrMemI: 9695 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(LHS, RHS, VK, OpLoc, 9696 Opc == BO_PtrMemI); 9697 break; 9698 case BO_Mul: 9699 case BO_Div: 9700 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false, 9701 Opc == BO_Div); 9702 break; 9703 case BO_Rem: 9704 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 9705 break; 9706 case BO_Add: 9707 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 9708 break; 9709 case BO_Sub: 9710 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 9711 break; 9712 case BO_Shl: 9713 case BO_Shr: 9714 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 9715 break; 9716 case BO_LE: 9717 case BO_LT: 9718 case BO_GE: 9719 case BO_GT: 9720 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true); 9721 break; 9722 case BO_EQ: 9723 case BO_NE: 9724 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, false); 9725 break; 9726 case BO_And: 9727 checkObjCPointerIntrospection(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 9728 case BO_Xor: 9729 case BO_Or: 9730 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 9731 break; 9732 case BO_LAnd: 9733 case BO_LOr: 9734 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 9735 break; 9736 case BO_MulAssign: 9737 case BO_DivAssign: 9738 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true, 9739 Opc == BO_DivAssign); 9740 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 9741 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 9742 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 9743 break; 9744 case BO_RemAssign: 9745 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true); 9746 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 9747 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 9748 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 9749 break; 9750 case BO_AddAssign: 9751 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, &CompLHSTy); 9752 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 9753 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 9754 break; 9755 case BO_SubAssign: 9756 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy); 9757 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 9758 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 9759 break; 9760 case BO_ShlAssign: 9761 case BO_ShrAssign: 9762 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true); 9763 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 9764 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 9765 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 9766 break; 9767 case BO_AndAssign: 9768 case BO_OrAssign: // fallthrough 9769 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc); 9770 case BO_XorAssign: 9771 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true); 9772 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 9773 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 9774 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 9775 break; 9776 case BO_Comma: 9777 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 9778 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !RHS.isInvalid()) { 9779 VK = RHS.get()->getValueKind(); 9780 OK = RHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 9781 } 9782 break; 9783 } 9784 if (ResultTy.isNull() || LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9785 return ExprError(); 9786 9787 // Check for array bounds violations for both sides of the BinaryOperator 9788 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get()); 9789 CheckArrayAccess(RHS.get()); 9790 9791 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 9792 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope, 9793 &Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"), 9794 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName); 9795 if (ObjectSetClass && isa<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get())) { 9796 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd()); 9797 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) << 9798 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS.get()->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") << 9799 FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OpLoc), ",") << 9800 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")"); 9801 } 9802 else 9803 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign); 9804 } 9805 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE = 9806 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) 9807 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, OpLoc, RHS.get()); 9808 9809 if (CompResultTy.isNull()) 9810 return new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, 9811 OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract); 9812 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != 9813 OK_ObjCProperty) { 9814 VK = VK_LValue; 9815 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 9816 } 9817 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator( 9818 LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, CompLHSTy, CompResultTy, 9819 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract); 9820 } 9821 9822 /// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison 9823 /// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that 9824 /// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of 9825 /// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1". 9826 static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9827 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr, 9828 Expr *RHSExpr) { 9829 BinaryOperator *LHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr); 9830 BinaryOperator *RHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr); 9831 9832 // Check that one of the sides is a comparison operator. 9833 bool isLeftComp = LHSBO && LHSBO->isComparisonOp(); 9834 bool isRightComp = RHSBO && RHSBO->isComparisonOp(); 9835 if (!isLeftComp && !isRightComp) 9836 return; 9837 9838 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops. 9839 // Don't diagnose this. 9840 bool isLeftBitwise = LHSBO && LHSBO->isBitwiseOp(); 9841 bool isRightBitwise = RHSBO && RHSBO->isBitwiseOp(); 9842 if ((isLeftComp || isLeftBitwise) && (isRightComp || isRightBitwise)) 9843 return; 9844 9845 SourceRange DiagRange = isLeftComp ? SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), 9846 OpLoc) 9847 : SourceRange(OpLoc, RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 9848 StringRef OpStr = isLeftComp ? LHSBO->getOpcodeStr() : RHSBO->getOpcodeStr(); 9849 SourceRange ParensRange = isLeftComp ? 9850 SourceRange(LHSBO->getRHS()->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()) 9851 : SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSBO->getLHS()->getLocEnd()); 9852 9853 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel) 9854 << DiagRange << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << OpStr; 9855 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 9856 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << OpStr, 9857 (isLeftComp ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr)->getSourceRange()); 9858 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 9859 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first) 9860 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 9861 ParensRange); 9862 } 9863 9864 /// \brief It accepts a '&' expr that is inside a '|' one. 9865 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&' expression 9866 /// in parentheses. 9867 static void 9868 EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9869 BinaryOperator *Bop) { 9870 assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And); 9871 Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_bitwise_and_in_bitwise_or) 9872 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc; 9873 SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 9874 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 9875 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(), 9876 Bop->getSourceRange()); 9877 } 9878 9879 /// \brief It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one. 9880 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression 9881 /// in parentheses. 9882 static void 9883 EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9884 BinaryOperator *Bop) { 9885 assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd); 9886 Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or) 9887 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc; 9888 SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 9889 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 9890 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(), 9891 Bop->getSourceRange()); 9892 } 9893 9894 /// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant 9895 /// 'true'. 9896 static bool EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 9897 bool Res; 9898 return !E->isValueDependent() && 9899 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && Res; 9900 } 9901 9902 /// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant 9903 /// 'false'. 9904 static bool EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 9905 bool Res; 9906 return !E->isValueDependent() && 9907 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && !Res; 9908 } 9909 9910 /// \brief Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr. 9911 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9912 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9913 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr)) { 9914 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) { 9915 // If it's "a && b || 0" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 9916 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, RHSExpr)) 9917 return; 9918 // If it's "1 && a || b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 9919 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getLHS())) 9920 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 9921 } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) { 9922 if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) { 9923 // If it's "a || b && 1 || c" we didn't warn earlier for 9924 // "a || b && 1", but warn now. 9925 if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd && EvaluatesAsTrue(S, RBop->getRHS())) 9926 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop); 9927 } 9928 } 9929 } 9930 } 9931 9932 /// \brief Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr. 9933 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9934 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9935 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr)) { 9936 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) { 9937 // If it's "0 || a && b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 9938 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, LHSExpr)) 9939 return; 9940 // If it's "a || b && 1" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 9941 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getRHS())) 9942 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 9943 } 9944 } 9945 } 9946 9947 /// \brief Look for '&' in the left or right hand of a '|' expr. 9948 static void DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9949 Expr *OrArg) { 9950 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(OrArg)) { 9951 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And) 9952 return EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 9953 } 9954 } 9955 9956 static void DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9957 Expr *SubExpr, StringRef Shift) { 9958 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) { 9959 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Add || Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Sub) { 9960 StringRef Op = Bop->getOpcodeStr(); 9961 S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_addition_in_bitshift) 9962 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc << Shift << Op; 9963 SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 9964 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << Op, 9965 Bop->getSourceRange()); 9966 } 9967 } 9968 } 9969 9970 static void DiagnoseShiftCompare(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9971 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9972 CXXOperatorCallExpr *OCE = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(LHSExpr); 9973 if (!OCE) 9974 return; 9975 9976 FunctionDecl *FD = OCE->getDirectCallee(); 9977 if (!FD || !FD->isOverloadedOperator()) 9978 return; 9979 9980 OverloadedOperatorKind Kind = FD->getOverloadedOperator(); 9981 if (Kind != OO_LessLess && Kind != OO_GreaterGreater) 9982 return; 9983 9984 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_overloaded_shift_in_comparison) 9985 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange() 9986 << (Kind == OO_LessLess); 9987 SuggestParentheses(S, OCE->getOperatorLoc(), 9988 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 9989 << (Kind == OO_LessLess ? "<<" : ">>"), 9990 OCE->getSourceRange()); 9991 SuggestParentheses(S, OpLoc, 9992 S.PDiag(diag::note_evaluate_comparison_first), 9993 SourceRange(OCE->getArg(1)->getLocStart(), 9994 RHSExpr->getLocEnd())); 9995 } 9996 9997 /// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky 9998 /// precedence. 9999 static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 10000 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr, 10001 Expr *RHSExpr){ 10002 // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3". 10003 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc)) 10004 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10005 10006 // Diagnose "arg1 & arg2 | arg3" 10007 if (Opc == BO_Or && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) { 10008 DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr); 10009 DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr); 10010 } 10011 10012 // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does. 10013 // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe. 10014 if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) { 10015 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10016 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10017 } 10018 10019 if ((Opc == BO_Shl && LHSExpr->getType()->isIntegralType(Self.getASTContext())) 10020 || Opc == BO_Shr) { 10021 StringRef Shift = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc); 10022 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, Shift); 10023 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr, Shift); 10024 } 10025 10026 // Warn on overloaded shift operators and comparisons, such as: 10027 // cout << 5 == 4; 10028 if (BinaryOperator::isComparisonOp(Opc)) 10029 DiagnoseShiftCompare(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10030 } 10031 10032 // Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator. 10033 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc, 10034 tok::TokenKind Kind, 10035 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 10036 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind); 10037 assert(LHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression"); 10038 assert(RHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression"); 10039 10040 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0" 10041 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10042 10043 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10044 } 10045 10046 /// Build an overloaded binary operator expression in the given scope. 10047 static ExprResult BuildOverloadedBinOp(Sema &S, Scope *Sc, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10048 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 10049 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 10050 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this 10051 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local 10052 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of 10053 // the arguments. 10054 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions; 10055 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp 10056 = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 10057 if (Sc && OverOp != OO_None && OverOp != OO_Equal) 10058 S.LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, Sc, LHS->getType(), 10059 RHS->getType(), Functions); 10060 10061 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent) 10062 // binary operation. 10063 return S.CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, LHS, RHS); 10064 } 10065 10066 ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10067 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 10068 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 10069 // We want to end up calling one of checkPseudoObjectAssignment 10070 // (if the LHS is a pseudo-object), BuildOverloadedBinOp (if 10071 // both expressions are overloadable or either is type-dependent), 10072 // or CreateBuiltinBinOp (in any other case). We also want to get 10073 // any placeholder types out of the way. 10074 10075 // Handle pseudo-objects in the LHS. 10076 if (const BuiltinType *pty = LHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 10077 // Assignments with a pseudo-object l-value need special analysis. 10078 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject && 10079 BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) 10080 return checkPseudoObjectAssignment(S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10081 10082 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable. 10083 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 10084 // We can't actually test that if we still have a placeholder, 10085 // though. Fortunately, none of the exceptions we see in that 10086 // code below are valid when the LHS is an overload set. Note 10087 // that an overload set can be dependently-typed, but it never 10088 // instantiates to having an overloadable type. 10089 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr); 10090 if (resolvedRHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10091 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get(); 10092 10093 if (RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || 10094 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 10095 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10096 } 10097 10098 ExprResult LHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHSExpr); 10099 if (LHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10100 LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 10101 } 10102 10103 // Handle pseudo-objects in the RHS. 10104 if (const BuiltinType *pty = RHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 10105 // An overload in the RHS can potentially be resolved by the type 10106 // being assigned to. 10107 if (Opc == BO_Assign && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 10108 if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent()) 10109 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10110 10111 if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 10112 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10113 10114 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10115 } 10116 10117 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable. 10118 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload && 10119 LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 10120 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10121 10122 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr); 10123 if (!resolvedRHS.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 10124 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get(); 10125 } 10126 10127 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10128 // If either expression is type-dependent, always build an 10129 // overloaded op. 10130 if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent()) 10131 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10132 10133 // Otherwise, build an overloaded op if either expression has an 10134 // overloadable type. 10135 if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType() || 10136 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 10137 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10138 } 10139 10140 // Build a built-in binary operation. 10141 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 10142 } 10143 10144 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 10145 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, 10146 Expr *InputExpr) { 10147 ExprResult Input = InputExpr; 10148 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 10149 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 10150 QualType resultType; 10151 switch (Opc) { 10152 case UO_PreInc: 10153 case UO_PreDec: 10154 case UO_PostInc: 10155 case UO_PostDec: 10156 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OK, 10157 OpLoc, 10158 Opc == UO_PreInc || 10159 Opc == UO_PostInc, 10160 Opc == UO_PreInc || 10161 Opc == UO_PreDec); 10162 break; 10163 case UO_AddrOf: 10164 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc); 10165 RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, InputExpr); 10166 break; 10167 case UO_Deref: { 10168 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 10169 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10170 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc); 10171 break; 10172 } 10173 case UO_Plus: 10174 case UO_Minus: 10175 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get()); 10176 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10177 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 10178 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 10179 break; 10180 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1 10181 resultType->isVectorType()) 10182 break; 10183 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6 10184 Opc == UO_Plus && 10185 resultType->isPointerType()) 10186 break; 10187 10188 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 10189 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 10190 10191 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement 10192 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get()); 10193 if (Input.isInvalid()) 10194 return ExprError(); 10195 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 10196 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 10197 break; 10198 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension. 10199 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType()) 10200 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation. 10201 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex) 10202 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange(); 10203 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 10204 break; 10205 else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) { 10206 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 10207 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.f: The bitwise operator not (~) does not operate 10208 // on vector float types. 10209 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 10210 if (!T->isIntegerType()) 10211 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 10212 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 10213 } 10214 break; 10215 } else { 10216 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 10217 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 10218 } 10219 break; 10220 10221 case UO_LNot: // logical negation 10222 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5). 10223 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 10224 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10225 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 10226 10227 // Though we still have to promote half FP to float... 10228 if (resultType->isHalfType() && !Context.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) { 10229 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 10230 resultType = Context.FloatTy; 10231 } 10232 10233 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 10234 break; 10235 if (resultType->isScalarType() && !isScopedEnumerationType(resultType)) { 10236 // C99 6.5.3.3p1: ok, fallthrough; 10237 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10238 // C++03 [expr.unary.op]p8, C++0x [expr.unary.op]p9: 10239 // operand contextually converted to bool. 10240 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.BoolTy, 10241 ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind(resultType)); 10242 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 10243 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 10244 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not 10245 // operate on scalar float types. 10246 if (!resultType->isIntegerType()) 10247 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 10248 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 10249 } 10250 } else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) { 10251 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 10252 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 10253 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not 10254 // operate on vector float types. 10255 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 10256 if (!T->isIntegerType()) 10257 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 10258 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 10259 } 10260 // Vector logical not returns the signed variant of the operand type. 10261 resultType = GetSignedVectorType(resultType); 10262 break; 10263 } else { 10264 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 10265 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 10266 } 10267 10268 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5. 10269 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8 10270 resultType = Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 10271 break; 10272 case UO_Real: 10273 case UO_Imag: 10274 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real); 10275 // _Real maps ordinary l-values into ordinary l-values. _Imag maps ordinary 10276 // complex l-values to ordinary l-values and all other values to r-values. 10277 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10278 if (Opc == UO_Real || Input.get()->getType()->isAnyComplexType()) { 10279 if (Input.get()->getValueKind() != VK_RValue && 10280 Input.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary) 10281 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind(); 10282 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10283 // In C, a volatile scalar is read by __imag. In C++, it is not. 10284 Input = DefaultLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 10285 } 10286 break; 10287 case UO_Extension: 10288 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 10289 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind(); 10290 OK = Input.get()->getObjectKind(); 10291 break; 10292 } 10293 if (resultType.isNull() || Input.isInvalid()) 10294 return ExprError(); 10295 10296 // Check for array bounds violations in the operand of the UnaryOperator, 10297 // except for the '*' and '&' operators that have to be handled specially 10298 // by CheckArrayAccess (as there are special cases like &array[arraysize] 10299 // that are explicitly defined as valid by the standard). 10300 if (Opc != UO_AddrOf && Opc != UO_Deref) 10301 CheckArrayAccess(Input.get()); 10302 10303 return new (Context) 10304 UnaryOperator(Input.get(), Opc, resultType, VK, OK, OpLoc); 10305 } 10306 10307 /// \brief Determine whether the given expression is a qualified member 10308 /// access expression, of a form that could be turned into a pointer to member 10309 /// with the address-of operator. 10310 static bool isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr *E) { 10311 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 10312 if (!DRE->getQualifier()) 10313 return false; 10314 10315 ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl(); 10316 if (!VD->isCXXClassMember()) 10317 return false; 10318 10319 if (isa<FieldDecl>(VD) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 10320 return true; 10321 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)) 10322 return Method->isInstance(); 10323 10324 return false; 10325 } 10326 10327 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 10328 if (!ULE->getQualifier()) 10329 return false; 10330 10331 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator D = ULE->decls_begin(), 10332 DEnd = ULE->decls_end(); 10333 D != DEnd; ++D) { 10334 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(*D)) { 10335 if (Method->isInstance()) 10336 return true; 10337 } else { 10338 // Overload set does not contain methods. 10339 break; 10340 } 10341 } 10342 10343 return false; 10344 } 10345 10346 return false; 10347 } 10348 10349 ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10350 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *Input) { 10351 // First things first: handle placeholders so that the 10352 // overloaded-operator check considers the right type. 10353 if (const BuiltinType *pty = Input->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 10354 // Increment and decrement of pseudo-object references. 10355 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject && 10356 UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc)) 10357 return checkPseudoObjectIncDec(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input); 10358 10359 // extension is always a builtin operator. 10360 if (Opc == UO_Extension) 10361 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 10362 10363 // & gets special logic for several kinds of placeholder. 10364 // The builtin code knows what to do. 10365 if (Opc == UO_AddrOf && 10366 (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload || 10367 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny || 10368 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember)) 10369 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 10370 10371 // Anything else needs to be handled now. 10372 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input); 10373 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10374 Input = Result.get(); 10375 } 10376 10377 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() && 10378 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None && 10379 !(Opc == UO_AddrOf && isQualifiedMemberAccess(Input))) { 10380 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this 10381 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local 10382 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of 10383 // the arguments. 10384 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions; 10385 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 10386 if (S && OverOp != OO_None) 10387 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(), 10388 Functions); 10389 10390 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input); 10391 } 10392 10393 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 10394 } 10395 10396 // Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator. 10397 ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10398 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) { 10399 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input); 10400 } 10401 10402 /// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo". 10403 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc, 10404 LabelDecl *TheDecl) { 10405 TheDecl->markUsed(Context); 10406 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'. 10407 return new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, TheDecl, 10408 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)); 10409 } 10410 10411 /// Given the last statement in a statement-expression, check whether 10412 /// the result is a producing expression (like a call to an 10413 /// ns_returns_retained function) and, if so, rebuild it to hoist the 10414 /// release out of the full-expression. Otherwise, return null. 10415 /// Cannot fail. 10416 static Expr *maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(Stmt *Statement) { 10417 // Should always be wrapped with one of these. 10418 ExprWithCleanups *cleanups = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Statement); 10419 if (!cleanups) return nullptr; 10420 10421 ImplicitCastExpr *cast = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(cleanups->getSubExpr()); 10422 if (!cast || cast->getCastKind() != CK_ARCConsumeObject) 10423 return nullptr; 10424 10425 // Splice out the cast. This shouldn't modify any interesting 10426 // features of the statement. 10427 Expr *producer = cast->getSubExpr(); 10428 assert(producer->getType() == cast->getType()); 10429 assert(producer->getValueKind() == cast->getValueKind()); 10430 cleanups->setSubExpr(producer); 10431 return cleanups; 10432 } 10433 10434 void Sema::ActOnStartStmtExpr() { 10435 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 10436 } 10437 10438 void Sema::ActOnStmtExprError() { 10439 // Note that function is also called by TreeTransform when leaving a 10440 // StmtExpr scope without rebuilding anything. 10441 10442 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 10443 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 10444 } 10445 10446 ExprResult 10447 Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt, 10448 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})" 10449 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!"); 10450 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt); 10451 10452 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction()) 10453 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 10454 assert(!ExprNeedsCleanups && "cleanups within StmtExpr not correctly bound!"); 10455 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 10456 10457 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for 10458 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently. 10459 // More semantic analysis is needed. 10460 10461 // If there are sub-stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one 10462 // as the type of the stmtexpr. 10463 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy; 10464 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false; 10465 if (!Compound->body_empty()) { 10466 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back(); 10467 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = nullptr; 10468 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body. 10469 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) { 10470 LastLabelStmt = Label; 10471 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt(); 10472 } 10473 10474 if (Expr *LastE = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) { 10475 // Do function/array conversion on the last expression, but not 10476 // lvalue-to-rvalue. However, initialize an unqualified type. 10477 ExprResult LastExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(LastE); 10478 if (LastExpr.isInvalid()) 10479 return ExprError(); 10480 Ty = LastExpr.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 10481 10482 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr.get()->isTypeDependent()) { 10483 // In ARC, if the final expression ends in a consume, splice 10484 // the consume out and bind it later. In the alternate case 10485 // (when dealing with a retainable type), the result 10486 // initialization will create a produce. In both cases the 10487 // result will be +1, and we'll need to balance that out with 10488 // a bind. 10489 if (Expr *rebuiltLastStmt 10490 = maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(LastExpr.get())) { 10491 LastExpr = rebuiltLastStmt; 10492 } else { 10493 LastExpr = PerformCopyInitialization( 10494 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc, 10495 Ty, 10496 false), 10497 SourceLocation(), 10498 LastExpr); 10499 } 10500 10501 if (LastExpr.isInvalid()) 10502 return ExprError(); 10503 if (LastExpr.get() != nullptr) { 10504 if (!LastLabelStmt) 10505 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr.get()); 10506 else 10507 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr.get()); 10508 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true; 10509 } 10510 } 10511 } 10512 } 10513 10514 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement 10515 // expressions are not lvalues. 10516 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc); 10517 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp) 10518 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr); 10519 return ResStmtExpr; 10520 } 10521 10522 ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 10523 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 10524 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr, 10525 unsigned NumComponents, 10526 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 10527 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType(); 10528 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType(); 10529 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange(); 10530 10531 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first 10532 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents 10533 // a struct/union/class. 10534 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType()) 10535 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) 10536 << ArgTy << TypeRange); 10537 10538 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable 10539 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed. 10540 if (!Dependent 10541 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy, 10542 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type, TypeRange)) 10543 return ExprError(); 10544 10545 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a 10546 // GCC extension, diagnose them. 10547 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in 10548 // a system header! 10549 if (NumComponents != 1) 10550 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator) 10551 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd); 10552 10553 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false; 10554 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy; 10555 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode; 10556 SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps; 10557 SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs; 10558 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) { 10559 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i]; 10560 if (OC.isBrackets) { 10561 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements? 10562 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) { 10563 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType); 10564 if(!AT) 10565 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type) 10566 << CurrentType); 10567 CurrentType = AT->getElementType(); 10568 } else 10569 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy; 10570 10571 ExprResult IdxRval = DefaultLvalueConversion(static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E)); 10572 if (IdxRval.isInvalid()) 10573 return ExprError(); 10574 Expr *Idx = IdxRval.get(); 10575 10576 // The expression must be an integral expression. 10577 // FIXME: An integral constant expression? 10578 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() && 10579 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType()) 10580 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(), 10581 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer) 10582 << Idx->getSourceRange()); 10583 10584 // Record this array index. 10585 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd)); 10586 Exprs.push_back(Idx); 10587 continue; 10588 } 10589 10590 // Offset of a field. 10591 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) { 10592 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent 10593 // type. Just record the identifier of the field. 10594 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd)); 10595 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy; 10596 continue; 10597 } 10598 10599 // We need to have a complete type to look into. 10600 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType, 10601 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)) 10602 return ExprError(); 10603 10604 // Look for the designated field. 10605 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>(); 10606 if (!RC) 10607 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) 10608 << CurrentType); 10609 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl(); 10610 10611 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5: 10612 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this 10613 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union 10614 // (clause 9). 10615 // C++11 [support.types]p4: 10616 // If type is not a standard-layout class (Clause 9), the results are 10617 // undefined. 10618 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 10619 bool IsSafe = LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? CRD->isStandardLayout() : CRD->isPOD(); 10620 unsigned DiagID = 10621 LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? diag::ext_offsetof_non_standardlayout_type 10622 : diag::ext_offsetof_non_pod_type; 10623 10624 if (!IsSafe && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD && 10625 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc, nullptr, 10626 PDiag(DiagID) 10627 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd) 10628 << CurrentType)) 10629 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true; 10630 } 10631 10632 // Look for the field. 10633 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName); 10634 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD); 10635 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>(); 10636 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectMemberDecl = nullptr; 10637 if (!MemberDecl) { 10638 if ((IndirectMemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>())) 10639 MemberDecl = IndirectMemberDecl->getAnonField(); 10640 } 10641 10642 if (!MemberDecl) 10643 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member) 10644 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, 10645 OC.LocEnd)); 10646 10647 // C99 7.17p3: 10648 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.) 10649 // 10650 // We diagnose this as an error. 10651 if (MemberDecl->isBitField()) { 10652 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield) 10653 << MemberDecl->getDeclName() 10654 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 10655 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl); 10656 return ExprError(); 10657 } 10658 10659 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent(); 10660 if (IndirectMemberDecl) 10661 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(IndirectMemberDecl->getDeclContext()); 10662 10663 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for 10664 // the base class indirections. 10665 CXXBasePaths Paths; 10666 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) { 10667 if (Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 10668 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_field_of_virtual_base) 10669 << MemberDecl->getDeclName() 10670 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 10671 return ExprError(); 10672 } 10673 10674 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front(); 10675 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end(); 10676 B != BEnd; ++B) 10677 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base)); 10678 } 10679 10680 if (IndirectMemberDecl) { 10681 for (auto *FI : IndirectMemberDecl->chain()) { 10682 assert(isa<FieldDecl>(FI)); 10683 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, 10684 cast<FieldDecl>(FI), OC.LocEnd)); 10685 } 10686 } else 10687 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd)); 10688 10689 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType(); 10690 } 10691 10692 return OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc, TInfo, 10693 Comps, Exprs, RParenLoc); 10694 } 10695 10696 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S, 10697 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 10698 SourceLocation TypeLoc, 10699 ParsedType ParsedArgTy, 10700 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr, 10701 unsigned NumComponents, 10702 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 10703 10704 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo; 10705 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedArgTy, &ArgTInfo); 10706 if (ArgTy.isNull()) 10707 return ExprError(); 10708 10709 if (!ArgTInfo) 10710 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc); 10711 10712 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents, 10713 RParenLoc); 10714 } 10715 10716 10717 ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 10718 Expr *CondExpr, 10719 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 10720 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 10721 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)"); 10722 10723 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 10724 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 10725 QualType resType; 10726 bool ValueDependent = false; 10727 bool CondIsTrue = false; 10728 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) { 10729 resType = Context.DependentTy; 10730 ValueDependent = true; 10731 } else { 10732 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression. 10733 llvm::APSInt condEval(32); 10734 ExprResult CondICE 10735 = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(CondExpr, &condEval, 10736 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant, false); 10737 if (CondICE.isInvalid()) 10738 return ExprError(); 10739 CondExpr = CondICE.get(); 10740 CondIsTrue = condEval.getZExtValue(); 10741 10742 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr. 10743 Expr *ActiveExpr = CondIsTrue ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr; 10744 10745 resType = ActiveExpr->getType(); 10746 ValueDependent = ActiveExpr->isValueDependent(); 10747 VK = ActiveExpr->getValueKind(); 10748 OK = ActiveExpr->getObjectKind(); 10749 } 10750 10751 return new (Context) 10752 ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr, resType, VK, OK, RPLoc, 10753 CondIsTrue, resType->isDependentType(), ValueDependent); 10754 } 10755 10756 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 10757 // Clang Extensions. 10758 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 10759 10760 /// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started. 10761 void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) { 10762 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc); 10763 10764 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) { 10765 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 10766 if (MangleNumberingContext *MCtx = 10767 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Block->getDeclContext(), 10768 ManglingContextDecl)) { 10769 unsigned ManglingNumber = MCtx->getManglingNumber(Block); 10770 Block->setBlockMangling(ManglingNumber, ManglingContextDecl); 10771 } 10772 } 10773 10774 PushBlockScope(CurScope, Block); 10775 CurContext->addDecl(Block); 10776 if (CurScope) 10777 PushDeclContext(CurScope, Block); 10778 else 10779 CurContext = Block; 10780 10781 getCurBlock()->HasImplicitReturnType = true; 10782 10783 // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the block from any 10784 // cleanups from the enclosing full-expression. 10785 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(PotentiallyEvaluated); 10786 } 10787 10788 void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Declarator &ParamInfo, 10789 Scope *CurScope) { 10790 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier() == nullptr && 10791 "block-id should have no identifier!"); 10792 assert(ParamInfo.getContext() == Declarator::BlockLiteralContext); 10793 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock(); 10794 10795 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope); 10796 QualType T = Sig->getType(); 10797 10798 // FIXME: We should allow unexpanded parameter packs here, but that would, 10799 // in turn, make the block expression contain unexpanded parameter packs. 10800 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(CaretLoc, Sig, UPPC_Block)) { 10801 // Drop the parameters. 10802 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 10803 EPI.HasTrailingReturn = false; 10804 EPI.TypeQuals |= DeclSpec::TQ_const; 10805 T = Context.getFunctionType(Context.DependentTy, None, EPI); 10806 Sig = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 10807 } 10808 10809 // GetTypeForDeclarator always produces a function type for a block 10810 // literal signature. Furthermore, it is always a FunctionProtoType 10811 // unless the function was written with a typedef. 10812 assert(T->isFunctionType() && 10813 "GetTypeForDeclarator made a non-function block signature"); 10814 10815 // Look for an explicit signature in that function type. 10816 FunctionProtoTypeLoc ExplicitSignature; 10817 10818 TypeLoc tmp = Sig->getTypeLoc().IgnoreParens(); 10819 if ((ExplicitSignature = tmp.getAs<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>())) { 10820 10821 // Check whether that explicit signature was synthesized by 10822 // GetTypeForDeclarator. If so, don't save that as part of the 10823 // written signature. 10824 if (ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeBegin() == 10825 ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeEnd()) { 10826 // This would be much cheaper if we stored TypeLocs instead of 10827 // TypeSourceInfos. 10828 TypeLoc Result = ExplicitSignature.getReturnLoc(); 10829 unsigned Size = Result.getFullDataSize(); 10830 Sig = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result.getType(), Size); 10831 Sig->getTypeLoc().initializeFullCopy(Result, Size); 10832 10833 ExplicitSignature = FunctionProtoTypeLoc(); 10834 } 10835 } 10836 10837 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig); 10838 CurBlock->FunctionType = T; 10839 10840 const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>(); 10841 QualType RetTy = Fn->getReturnType(); 10842 bool isVariadic = 10843 (isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) && cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic()); 10844 10845 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic); 10846 10847 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block 10848 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like: 10849 // ^ * { ... } 10850 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction".... 10851 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy) { 10852 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy; 10853 CurBlock->TheDecl->setBlockMissingReturnType(false); 10854 CurBlock->HasImplicitReturnType = false; 10855 } 10856 10857 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them. 10858 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params; 10859 if (ExplicitSignature) { 10860 for (unsigned I = 0, E = ExplicitSignature.getNumParams(); I != E; ++I) { 10861 ParmVarDecl *Param = ExplicitSignature.getParam(I); 10862 if (Param->getIdentifier() == nullptr && 10863 !Param->isImplicit() && 10864 !Param->isInvalidDecl() && 10865 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 10866 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted); 10867 Params.push_back(Param); 10868 } 10869 10870 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like 10871 // ^ fntype { ... } 10872 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 10873 for (const auto &I : Fn->param_types()) { 10874 ParmVarDecl *Param = BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef( 10875 CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo.getLocStart(), I); 10876 Params.push_back(Param); 10877 } 10878 } 10879 10880 // Set the parameters on the block decl. 10881 if (!Params.empty()) { 10882 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params); 10883 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(), 10884 CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(), 10885 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false); 10886 } 10887 10888 // Finally we can process decl attributes. 10889 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo); 10890 10891 // Put the parameter variables in scope. 10892 for (auto AI : CurBlock->TheDecl->params()) { 10893 AI->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl); 10894 10895 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 10896 if (AI->getIdentifier()) { 10897 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, AI); 10898 10899 PushOnScopeChains(AI, CurBlock->TheScope); 10900 } 10901 } 10902 } 10903 10904 /// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback 10905 /// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl. 10906 void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) { 10907 // Leave the expression-evaluation context. 10908 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 10909 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 10910 10911 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks. 10912 PopDeclContext(); 10913 PopFunctionScopeInfo(); 10914 } 10915 10916 /// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement 10917 /// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...} 10918 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc, 10919 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) { 10920 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error. 10921 if (!LangOpts.Blocks) 10922 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable); 10923 10924 // Leave the expression-evaluation context. 10925 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction()) 10926 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 10927 assert(!ExprNeedsCleanups && "cleanups within block not correctly bound!"); 10928 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 10929 10930 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back()); 10931 10932 if (BSI->HasImplicitReturnType) 10933 deduceClosureReturnType(*BSI); 10934 10935 PopDeclContext(); 10936 10937 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy; 10938 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull()) 10939 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType; 10940 10941 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->hasAttr<NoReturnAttr>(); 10942 QualType BlockTy; 10943 10944 // Set the captured variables on the block. 10945 // FIXME: Share capture structure between BlockDecl and CapturingScopeInfo! 10946 SmallVector<BlockDecl::Capture, 4> Captures; 10947 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Captures.size(); i != e; i++) { 10948 CapturingScopeInfo::Capture &Cap = BSI->Captures[i]; 10949 if (Cap.isThisCapture()) 10950 continue; 10951 BlockDecl::Capture NewCap(Cap.getVariable(), Cap.isBlockCapture(), 10952 Cap.isNested(), Cap.getInitExpr()); 10953 Captures.push_back(NewCap); 10954 } 10955 BSI->TheDecl->setCaptures(Context, Captures.begin(), Captures.end(), 10956 BSI->CXXThisCaptureIndex != 0); 10957 10958 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that. 10959 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) { 10960 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 10961 10962 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo(); 10963 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true); 10964 10965 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types. 10966 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) { 10967 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 10968 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext; 10969 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI); 10970 10971 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type, 10972 // preserve its sugar structure. 10973 } else if (FTy->getReturnType() == RetTy && 10974 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) { 10975 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType; 10976 10977 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type. 10978 } else { 10979 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy); 10980 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 10981 EPI.TypeQuals = 0; // FIXME: silently? 10982 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext; 10983 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI); 10984 } 10985 10986 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing. 10987 } else { 10988 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 10989 EPI.ExtInfo = FunctionType::ExtInfo().withNoReturn(NoReturn); 10990 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI); 10991 } 10992 10993 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(), 10994 BSI->TheDecl->param_end()); 10995 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy); 10996 10997 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block. 10998 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && 10999 !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled()) 11000 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)); 11001 11002 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)); 11003 11004 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check again 11005 // if we can do this, though, because blocks keep return statements around 11006 // to deduce an implicit return type. 11007 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RetTy->isRecordType() && 11008 !BSI->TheDecl->isDependentContext()) 11009 computeNRVO(Body, BSI); 11010 11011 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy); 11012 AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy(); 11013 PopFunctionScopeInfo(&WP, Result->getBlockDecl(), Result); 11014 11015 // If the block isn't obviously global, i.e. it captures anything at 11016 // all, then we need to do a few things in the surrounding context: 11017 if (Result->getBlockDecl()->hasCaptures()) { 11018 // First, this expression has a new cleanup object. 11019 ExprCleanupObjects.push_back(Result->getBlockDecl()); 11020 ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 11021 11022 // It also gets a branch-protected scope if any of the captured 11023 // variables needs destruction. 11024 for (const auto &CI : Result->getBlockDecl()->captures()) { 11025 const VarDecl *var = CI.getVariable(); 11026 if (var->getType().isDestructedType() != QualType::DK_none) { 11027 getCurFunction()->setHasBranchProtectedScope(); 11028 break; 11029 } 11030 } 11031 } 11032 11033 return Result; 11034 } 11035 11036 ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 11037 Expr *E, ParsedType Ty, 11038 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 11039 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 11040 GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo); 11041 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc); 11042 } 11043 11044 ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 11045 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 11046 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 11047 Expr *OrigExpr = E; 11048 11049 // Get the va_list type 11050 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType(); 11051 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) { 11052 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64, 11053 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to 11054 // a pointer for va_arg. 11055 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType); 11056 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately. 11057 ExprResult Result = UsualUnaryConversions(E); 11058 if (Result.isInvalid()) 11059 return ExprError(); 11060 E = Result.get(); 11061 } else if (VaListType->isRecordType() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11062 // If va_list is a record type and we are compiling in C++ mode, 11063 // check the argument using reference binding. 11064 InitializedEntity Entity 11065 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 11066 Context.getLValueReferenceType(VaListType), false); 11067 ExprResult Init = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), E); 11068 if (Init.isInvalid()) 11069 return ExprError(); 11070 E = Init.getAs<Expr>(); 11071 } else { 11072 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because 11073 // it is modified by va_arg. 11074 if (!E->isTypeDependent() && 11075 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this)) 11076 return ExprError(); 11077 } 11078 11079 if (!E->isTypeDependent() && 11080 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) { 11081 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(), 11082 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list) 11083 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange()); 11084 } 11085 11086 if (!TInfo->getType()->isDependentType()) { 11087 if (RequireCompleteType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TInfo->getType(), 11088 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_incomplete, 11089 TInfo->getTypeLoc())) 11090 return ExprError(); 11091 11092 if (RequireNonAbstractType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 11093 TInfo->getType(), 11094 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_abstract, 11095 TInfo->getTypeLoc())) 11096 return ExprError(); 11097 11098 if (!TInfo->getType().isPODType(Context)) { 11099 Diag(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 11100 TInfo->getType()->isObjCLifetimeType() 11101 ? diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_ownership_qualified 11102 : diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_not_pod) 11103 << TInfo->getType() 11104 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 11105 } 11106 11107 // Check for va_arg where arguments of the given type will be promoted 11108 // (i.e. this va_arg is guaranteed to have undefined behavior). 11109 QualType PromoteType; 11110 if (TInfo->getType()->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 11111 PromoteType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(TInfo->getType()); 11112 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(PromoteType, TInfo->getType())) 11113 PromoteType = QualType(); 11114 } 11115 if (TInfo->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float)) 11116 PromoteType = Context.DoubleTy; 11117 if (!PromoteType.isNull()) 11118 DiagRuntimeBehavior(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), E, 11119 PDiag(diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_never_compatible) 11120 << TInfo->getType() 11121 << PromoteType 11122 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()); 11123 } 11124 11125 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context); 11126 return new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T); 11127 } 11128 11129 ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) { 11130 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of 11131 // pointers on the target. 11132 QualType Ty; 11133 unsigned pw = Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0); 11134 if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth()) 11135 Ty = Context.IntTy; 11136 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth()) 11137 Ty = Context.LongTy; 11138 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth()) 11139 Ty = Context.LongLongTy; 11140 else { 11141 llvm_unreachable("I don't know size of pointer!"); 11142 } 11143 11144 return new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc); 11145 } 11146 11147 bool 11148 Sema::ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(QualType DstType, Expr *&Exp) { 11149 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) 11150 return false; 11151 11152 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 11153 if (!PT) 11154 return false; 11155 11156 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) { 11157 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface. 11158 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl(); 11159 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString")) 11160 return false; 11161 } 11162 11163 // Ignore any parens, implicit casts (should only be 11164 // array-to-pointer decays), and not-so-opaque values. The last is 11165 // important for making this trigger for property assignments. 11166 Expr *SrcExpr = Exp->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11167 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OV = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(SrcExpr)) 11168 if (OV->getSourceExpr()) 11169 SrcExpr = OV->getSourceExpr()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11170 11171 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr); 11172 if (!SL || !SL->isAscii()) 11173 return false; 11174 Diag(SL->getLocStart(), diag::err_missing_atsign_prefix) 11175 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@"); 11176 Exp = BuildObjCStringLiteral(SL->getLocStart(), SL).get(); 11177 return true; 11178 } 11179 11180 bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy, 11181 SourceLocation Loc, 11182 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType, 11183 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action, 11184 bool *Complained) { 11185 if (Complained) 11186 *Complained = false; 11187 11188 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions). 11189 bool CheckInferredResultType = false; 11190 bool isInvalid = false; 11191 unsigned DiagKind = 0; 11192 FixItHint Hint; 11193 ConversionFixItGenerator ConvHints; 11194 bool MayHaveConvFixit = false; 11195 bool MayHaveFunctionDiff = false; 11196 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr; 11197 const ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = nullptr; 11198 11199 switch (ConvTy) { 11200 case Compatible: 11201 DiagnoseAssignmentEnum(DstType, SrcType, SrcExpr); 11202 return false; 11203 11204 case PointerToInt: 11205 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int; 11206 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 11207 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 11208 break; 11209 case IntToPointer: 11210 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer; 11211 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 11212 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 11213 break; 11214 case IncompatiblePointer: 11215 DiagKind = 11216 (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited ? 11217 diag::err_arc_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer : 11218 diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer); 11219 CheckInferredResultType = DstType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 11220 SrcType->isObjCObjectPointerType(); 11221 if (Hint.isNull() && !CheckInferredResultType) { 11222 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 11223 } 11224 else if (CheckInferredResultType) { 11225 SrcType = SrcType.getUnqualifiedType(); 11226 DstType = DstType.getUnqualifiedType(); 11227 } 11228 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 11229 break; 11230 case IncompatiblePointerSign: 11231 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign; 11232 break; 11233 case FunctionVoidPointer: 11234 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func; 11235 break; 11236 case IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: { 11237 // Perform array-to-pointer decay if necessary. 11238 if (SrcType->isArrayType()) SrcType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(SrcType); 11239 11240 Qualifiers lhq = SrcType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers(); 11241 Qualifiers rhq = DstType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers(); 11242 if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) { 11243 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_address_space; 11244 break; 11245 11246 11247 } else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) { 11248 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_ownership; 11249 break; 11250 } 11251 11252 llvm_unreachable("unknown error case for discarding qualifiers!"); 11253 // fallthrough 11254 } 11255 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: 11256 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the 11257 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char* 11258 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME: 11259 // Ideally, this check would be performed in 11260 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a 11261 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an 11262 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part 11263 // of a larger effort to fix checkPointerTypesForAssignment for 11264 // C++ semantics. 11265 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 11266 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType)) 11267 return false; 11268 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers; 11269 break; 11270 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers: 11271 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch; 11272 break; 11273 case IntToBlockPointer: 11274 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer; 11275 break; 11276 case IncompatibleBlockPointer: 11277 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer; 11278 break; 11279 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId: { 11280 if (SrcType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 11281 const ObjCObjectPointerType *srcOPT = 11282 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 11283 for (auto *srcProto : srcOPT->quals()) { 11284 PDecl = srcProto; 11285 break; 11286 } 11287 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = 11288 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType()) 11289 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl(); 11290 } 11291 else if (DstType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 11292 const ObjCObjectPointerType *dstOPT = 11293 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 11294 for (auto *dstProto : dstOPT->quals()) { 11295 PDecl = dstProto; 11296 break; 11297 } 11298 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = 11299 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType()) 11300 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl(); 11301 } 11302 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id; 11303 break; 11304 } 11305 case IncompatibleVectors: 11306 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors; 11307 break; 11308 case IncompatibleObjCWeakRef: 11309 DiagKind = diag::err_arc_weak_unavailable_assign; 11310 break; 11311 case Incompatible: 11312 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible; 11313 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 11314 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 11315 isInvalid = true; 11316 MayHaveFunctionDiff = true; 11317 break; 11318 } 11319 11320 QualType FirstType, SecondType; 11321 switch (Action) { 11322 case AA_Assigning: 11323 case AA_Initializing: 11324 // The destination type comes first. 11325 FirstType = DstType; 11326 SecondType = SrcType; 11327 break; 11328 11329 case AA_Returning: 11330 case AA_Passing: 11331 case AA_Passing_CFAudited: 11332 case AA_Converting: 11333 case AA_Sending: 11334 case AA_Casting: 11335 // The source type comes first. 11336 FirstType = SrcType; 11337 SecondType = DstType; 11338 break; 11339 } 11340 11341 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = PDiag(DiagKind); 11342 if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited) 11343 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << AA_Passing << SrcExpr->getSourceRange(); 11344 else 11345 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << Action << SrcExpr->getSourceRange(); 11346 11347 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 11348 assert(ConvHints.isNull() || Hint.isNull()); 11349 if (!ConvHints.isNull()) { 11350 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = ConvHints.Hints.begin(), 11351 HE = ConvHints.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI) 11352 FDiag << *HI; 11353 } else { 11354 FDiag << Hint; 11355 } 11356 if (MayHaveConvFixit) { FDiag << (unsigned) (ConvHints.Kind); } 11357 11358 if (MayHaveFunctionDiff) 11359 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(FDiag, SecondType, FirstType); 11360 11361 Diag(Loc, FDiag); 11362 if (DiagKind == diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id && 11363 PDecl && IFace && !IFace->hasDefinition()) 11364 Diag(IFace->getLocation(), diag::not_incomplete_class_and_qualified_id) 11365 << IFace->getName() << PDecl->getName(); 11366 11367 if (SecondType == Context.OverloadTy) 11368 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr).Expression, 11369 FirstType); 11370 11371 if (CheckInferredResultType) 11372 EmitRelatedResultTypeNote(SrcExpr); 11373 11374 if (Action == AA_Returning && ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer) 11375 EmitRelatedResultTypeNoteForReturn(DstType); 11376 11377 if (Complained) 11378 *Complained = true; 11379 return isInvalid; 11380 } 11381 11382 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, 11383 llvm::APSInt *Result) { 11384 class SimpleICEDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser { 11385 public: 11386 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override { 11387 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_expr_not_ice) << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus << SR; 11388 } 11389 } Diagnoser; 11390 11391 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser); 11392 } 11393 11394 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, 11395 llvm::APSInt *Result, 11396 unsigned DiagID, 11397 bool AllowFold) { 11398 class IDDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser { 11399 unsigned DiagID; 11400 11401 public: 11402 IDDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID) 11403 : VerifyICEDiagnoser(DiagID == 0), DiagID(DiagID) { } 11404 11405 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override { 11406 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << SR; 11407 } 11408 } Diagnoser(DiagID); 11409 11410 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser, AllowFold); 11411 } 11412 11413 void Sema::VerifyICEDiagnoser::diagnoseFold(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 11414 SourceRange SR) { 11415 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_expr_not_ice) << SR << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus; 11416 } 11417 11418 ExprResult 11419 Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result, 11420 VerifyICEDiagnoser &Diagnoser, 11421 bool AllowFold) { 11422 SourceLocation DiagLoc = E->getLocStart(); 11423 11424 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 11425 // C++11 [expr.const]p5: 11426 // If an expression of literal class type is used in a context where an 11427 // integral constant expression is required, then that class type shall 11428 // have a single non-explicit conversion function to an integral or 11429 // unscoped enumeration type 11430 ExprResult Converted; 11431 class CXX11ConvertDiagnoser : public ICEConvertDiagnoser { 11432 public: 11433 CXX11ConvertDiagnoser(bool Silent) 11434 : ICEConvertDiagnoser(/*AllowScopedEnumerations*/false, 11435 Silent, true) {} 11436 11437 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotInt(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 11438 QualType T) override { 11439 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_not_integral) << T; 11440 } 11441 11442 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseIncomplete( 11443 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 11444 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_incomplete_type) << T; 11445 } 11446 11447 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseExplicitConv( 11448 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override { 11449 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_explicit_conversion) << T << ConvTy; 11450 } 11451 11452 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteExplicitConv( 11453 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override { 11454 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here) 11455 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 11456 } 11457 11458 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseAmbiguous( 11459 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 11460 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_ambiguous_conversion) << T; 11461 } 11462 11463 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteAmbiguous( 11464 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override { 11465 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here) 11466 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 11467 } 11468 11469 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseConversion( 11470 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override { 11471 llvm_unreachable("conversion functions are permitted"); 11472 } 11473 } ConvertDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress); 11474 11475 Converted = PerformContextualImplicitConversion(DiagLoc, E, 11476 ConvertDiagnoser); 11477 if (Converted.isInvalid()) 11478 return Converted; 11479 E = Converted.get(); 11480 if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 11481 return ExprError(); 11482 } else if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 11483 // An ICE must be of integral or unscoped enumeration type. 11484 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) 11485 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 11486 return ExprError(); 11487 } 11488 11489 // Circumvent ICE checking in C++11 to avoid evaluating the expression twice 11490 // in the non-ICE case. 11491 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) { 11492 if (Result) 11493 *Result = E->EvaluateKnownConstInt(Context); 11494 return E; 11495 } 11496 11497 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult; 11498 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 11499 EvalResult.Diag = &Notes; 11500 11501 // Try to evaluate the expression, and produce diagnostics explaining why it's 11502 // not a constant expression as a side-effect. 11503 bool Folded = E->EvaluateAsRValue(EvalResult, Context) && 11504 EvalResult.Val.isInt() && !EvalResult.HasSideEffects; 11505 11506 // In C++11, we can rely on diagnostics being produced for any expression 11507 // which is not a constant expression. If no diagnostics were produced, then 11508 // this is a constant expression. 11509 if (Folded && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Notes.empty()) { 11510 if (Result) 11511 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt(); 11512 return E; 11513 } 11514 11515 // If our only note is the usual "invalid subexpression" note, just point 11516 // the caret at its location rather than producing an essentially 11517 // redundant note. 11518 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 11519 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 11520 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first; 11521 Notes.clear(); 11522 } 11523 11524 if (!Folded || !AllowFold) { 11525 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) { 11526 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 11527 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I) 11528 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 11529 } 11530 11531 return ExprError(); 11532 } 11533 11534 Diagnoser.diagnoseFold(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 11535 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I) 11536 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 11537 11538 if (Result) 11539 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt(); 11540 return E; 11541 } 11542 11543 namespace { 11544 // Handle the case where we conclude a expression which we speculatively 11545 // considered to be unevaluated is actually evaluated. 11546 class TransformToPE : public TreeTransform<TransformToPE> { 11547 typedef TreeTransform<TransformToPE> BaseTransform; 11548 11549 public: 11550 TransformToPE(Sema &SemaRef) : BaseTransform(SemaRef) { } 11551 11552 // Make sure we redo semantic analysis 11553 bool AlwaysRebuild() { return true; } 11554 11555 // Make sure we handle LabelStmts correctly. 11556 // FIXME: This does the right thing, but maybe we need a more general 11557 // fix to TreeTransform? 11558 StmtResult TransformLabelStmt(LabelStmt *S) { 11559 S->getDecl()->setStmt(nullptr); 11560 return BaseTransform::TransformLabelStmt(S); 11561 } 11562 11563 // We need to special-case DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls which 11564 // are not part of a member pointer formation; normal TreeTransforming 11565 // doesn't catch this case because of the way we represent them in the AST. 11566 // FIXME: This is a bit ugly; is it really the best way to handle this 11567 // case? 11568 // 11569 // Error on DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls. 11570 ExprResult TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 11571 if (isa<FieldDecl>(E->getDecl()) && 11572 !SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext()) 11573 return SemaRef.Diag(E->getLocation(), 11574 diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use) 11575 << E->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange(); 11576 11577 return BaseTransform::TransformDeclRefExpr(E); 11578 } 11579 11580 // Exception: filter out member pointer formation 11581 ExprResult TransformUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) { 11582 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && E->getType()->isMemberPointerType()) 11583 return E; 11584 11585 return BaseTransform::TransformUnaryOperator(E); 11586 } 11587 11588 ExprResult TransformLambdaExpr(LambdaExpr *E) { 11589 // Lambdas never need to be transformed. 11590 return E; 11591 } 11592 }; 11593 } 11594 11595 ExprResult Sema::TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr *E) { 11596 assert(isUnevaluatedContext() && 11597 "Should only transform unevaluated expressions"); 11598 ExprEvalContexts.back().Context = 11599 ExprEvalContexts[ExprEvalContexts.size()-2].Context; 11600 if (isUnevaluatedContext()) 11601 return E; 11602 return TransformToPE(*this).TransformExpr(E); 11603 } 11604 11605 void 11606 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, 11607 Decl *LambdaContextDecl, 11608 bool IsDecltype) { 11609 ExprEvalContexts.emplace_back(NewContext, ExprCleanupObjects.size(), 11610 ExprNeedsCleanups, LambdaContextDecl, 11611 IsDecltype); 11612 ExprNeedsCleanups = false; 11613 if (!MaybeODRUseExprs.empty()) 11614 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, ExprEvalContexts.back().SavedMaybeODRUseExprs); 11615 } 11616 11617 void 11618 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, 11619 ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t, 11620 bool IsDecltype) { 11621 Decl *ClosureContextDecl = ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl; 11622 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(NewContext, ClosureContextDecl, IsDecltype); 11623 } 11624 11625 void Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() { 11626 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord& Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back(); 11627 unsigned NumTypos = Rec.NumTypos; 11628 11629 if (!Rec.Lambdas.empty()) { 11630 if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.Context == ConstantEvaluated) { 11631 unsigned D; 11632 if (Rec.isUnevaluated()) { 11633 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p2: 11634 // A lambda-expression shall not appear in an unevaluated operand 11635 // (Clause 5). 11636 D = diag::err_lambda_unevaluated_operand; 11637 } else { 11638 // C++1y [expr.const]p2: 11639 // A conditional-expression e is a core constant expression unless the 11640 // evaluation of e, following the rules of the abstract machine, would 11641 // evaluate [...] a lambda-expression. 11642 D = diag::err_lambda_in_constant_expression; 11643 } 11644 for (const auto *L : Rec.Lambdas) 11645 Diag(L->getLocStart(), D); 11646 } else { 11647 // Mark the capture expressions odr-used. This was deferred 11648 // during lambda expression creation. 11649 for (auto *Lambda : Rec.Lambdas) { 11650 for (auto *C : Lambda->capture_inits()) 11651 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(C); 11652 } 11653 } 11654 } 11655 11656 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any 11657 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of 11658 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they 11659 // will never be constructed. 11660 if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.Context == ConstantEvaluated) { 11661 ExprCleanupObjects.erase(ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + Rec.NumCleanupObjects, 11662 ExprCleanupObjects.end()); 11663 ExprNeedsCleanups = Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups; 11664 CleanupVarDeclMarking(); 11665 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs); 11666 // Otherwise, merge the contexts together. 11667 } else { 11668 ExprNeedsCleanups |= Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups; 11669 MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.begin(), 11670 Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.end()); 11671 } 11672 11673 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack. 11674 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back(); 11675 11676 if (!ExprEvalContexts.empty()) 11677 ExprEvalContexts.back().NumTypos += NumTypos; 11678 else 11679 assert(NumTypos == 0 && "There are outstanding typos after popping the " 11680 "last ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord"); 11681 } 11682 11683 void Sema::DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext() { 11684 ExprCleanupObjects.erase( 11685 ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects, 11686 ExprCleanupObjects.end()); 11687 ExprNeedsCleanups = false; 11688 MaybeODRUseExprs.clear(); 11689 } 11690 11691 ExprResult Sema::HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr *E) { 11692 if (!E->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) 11693 return E; 11694 return TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E); 11695 } 11696 11697 static bool IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(Sema &SemaRef) { 11698 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for 11699 // an instantiation. 11700 if (SemaRef.CurContext->isDependentContext()) 11701 return false; 11702 11703 switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 11704 case Sema::Unevaluated: 11705 case Sema::UnevaluatedAbstract: 11706 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing. 11707 // (Depending on how you read the standard, we actually do need to do 11708 // something here for null pointer constants, but the standard's 11709 // definition of a null pointer constant is completely crazy.) 11710 return false; 11711 11712 case Sema::ConstantEvaluated: 11713 case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluated: 11714 // We are in a potentially evaluated expression (or a constant-expression 11715 // in C++03); we need to do implicit template instantiation, implicitly 11716 // define class members, and mark most declarations as used. 11717 return true; 11718 11719 case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 11720 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the 11721 // containing expression is used. 11722 return false; 11723 } 11724 llvm_unreachable("Invalid context"); 11725 } 11726 11727 /// \brief Mark a function referenced, and check whether it is odr-used 11728 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3) 11729 void Sema::MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *Func, 11730 bool OdrUse) { 11731 assert(Func && "No function?"); 11732 11733 Func->setReferenced(); 11734 11735 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p3: 11736 // A function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression is 11737 // odr-used if it is the unique lookup result or the selected member of a 11738 // set of overloaded functions [...]. 11739 // 11740 // We (incorrectly) mark overload resolution as an unevaluated context, so we 11741 // can just check that here. Skip the rest of this function if we've already 11742 // marked the function as used. 11743 if (Func->isUsed(/*CheckUsedAttr=*/false) || 11744 !IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(*this)) { 11745 // C++11 [temp.inst]p3: 11746 // Unless a function template specialization has been explicitly 11747 // instantiated or explicitly specialized, the function template 11748 // specialization is implicitly instantiated when the specialization is 11749 // referenced in a context that requires a function definition to exist. 11750 // 11751 // We consider constexpr function templates to be referenced in a context 11752 // that requires a definition to exist whenever they are referenced. 11753 // 11754 // FIXME: This instantiates constexpr functions too frequently. If this is 11755 // really an unevaluated context (and we're not just in the definition of a 11756 // function template or overload resolution or other cases which we 11757 // incorrectly consider to be unevaluated contexts), and we're not in a 11758 // subexpression which we actually need to evaluate (for instance, a 11759 // template argument, array bound or an expression in a braced-init-list), 11760 // we are not permitted to instantiate this constexpr function definition. 11761 // 11762 // FIXME: This also implicitly defines special members too frequently. They 11763 // are only supposed to be implicitly defined if they are odr-used, but they 11764 // are not odr-used from constant expressions in unevaluated contexts. 11765 // However, they cannot be referenced if they are deleted, and they are 11766 // deleted whenever the implicit definition of the special member would 11767 // fail. 11768 if (!Func->isConstexpr() || Func->getBody()) 11769 return; 11770 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func); 11771 if (!Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable() && (!MD || MD->isUserProvided())) 11772 return; 11773 } 11774 11775 // Note that this declaration has been used. 11776 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 11777 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Constructor->getFirstDecl()); 11778 if (Constructor->isDefaulted() && !Constructor->isDeleted()) { 11779 if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) { 11780 if (Constructor->isTrivial() && !Constructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 11781 return; 11782 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 11783 } else if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) { 11784 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 11785 } else if (Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) { 11786 DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 11787 } 11788 } else if (Constructor->getInheritedConstructor()) { 11789 DefineInheritingConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 11790 } 11791 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 11792 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func)) { 11793 Destructor = cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Destructor->getFirstDecl()); 11794 if (Destructor->isDefaulted() && !Destructor->isDeleted()) 11795 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor); 11796 if (Destructor->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext) 11797 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent()); 11798 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func)) { 11799 if (MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() && 11800 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) { 11801 MethodDecl = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl()); 11802 if (MethodDecl->isDefaulted() && !MethodDecl->isDeleted()) { 11803 if (MethodDecl->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 11804 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl); 11805 else 11806 DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl); 11807 } 11808 } else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl) && 11809 MethodDecl->getParent()->isLambda()) { 11810 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 11811 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl()); 11812 if (Conversion->isLambdaToBlockPointerConversion()) 11813 DefineImplicitLambdaToBlockPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion); 11814 else 11815 DefineImplicitLambdaToFunctionPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion); 11816 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext) 11817 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent()); 11818 } 11819 11820 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function. 11821 // FIXME: Is this really right? 11822 if (CurContext == Func) return; 11823 11824 // Resolve the exception specification for any function which is 11825 // used: CodeGen will need it. 11826 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11827 if (FPT && isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) 11828 ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 11829 11830 if (!OdrUse) return; 11831 11832 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of 11833 // class templates. 11834 if (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) { 11835 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false; 11836 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Loc; 11837 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo 11838 = Func->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) { 11839 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) 11840 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc); 11841 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind() 11842 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) { 11843 AlreadyInstantiated = true; 11844 PointOfInstantiation = SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation(); 11845 } 11846 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo 11847 = Func->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) { 11848 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) 11849 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc); 11850 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind() 11851 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) { 11852 AlreadyInstantiated = true; 11853 PointOfInstantiation = MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation(); 11854 } 11855 } 11856 11857 if (!AlreadyInstantiated || Func->isConstexpr()) { 11858 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()) && 11859 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass() && 11860 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.size()) 11861 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back( 11862 std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation)); 11863 else if (Func->isConstexpr()) 11864 // Do not defer instantiations of constexpr functions, to avoid the 11865 // expression evaluator needing to call back into Sema if it sees a 11866 // call to such a function. 11867 InstantiateFunctionDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Func); 11868 else { 11869 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Func, 11870 PointOfInstantiation)); 11871 // Notify the consumer that a function was implicitly instantiated. 11872 Consumer.HandleCXXImplicitFunctionInstantiation(Func); 11873 } 11874 } 11875 } else { 11876 // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable. 11877 for (auto i : Func->redecls()) { 11878 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) 11879 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, i); 11880 } 11881 } 11882 11883 // Keep track of used but undefined functions. 11884 if (!Func->isDefined()) { 11885 if (mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(Func)) 11886 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 11887 else if (Func->getMostRecentDecl()->isInlined() && 11888 (LangOpts.CPlusPlus || !LangOpts.GNUInline) && 11889 !Func->getMostRecentDecl()->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) 11890 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 11891 } 11892 11893 // Normally the most current decl is marked used while processing the use and 11894 // any subsequent decls are marked used by decl merging. This fails with 11895 // template instantiation since marking can happen at the end of the file 11896 // and, because of the two phase lookup, this function is called with at 11897 // decl in the middle of a decl chain. We loop to maintain the invariant 11898 // that once a decl is used, all decls after it are also used. 11899 for (FunctionDecl *F = Func->getMostRecentDecl();; F = F->getPreviousDecl()) { 11900 F->markUsed(Context); 11901 if (F == Func) 11902 break; 11903 } 11904 } 11905 11906 static void 11907 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc, 11908 VarDecl *var, DeclContext *DC) { 11909 DeclContext *VarDC = var->getDeclContext(); 11910 11911 // If the parameter still belongs to the translation unit, then 11912 // we're actually just using one parameter in the declaration of 11913 // the next. 11914 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(var) && 11915 isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(VarDC)) 11916 return; 11917 11918 // For C code, don't diagnose about capture if we're not actually in code 11919 // right now; it's impossible to write a non-constant expression outside of 11920 // function context, so we'll get other (more useful) diagnostics later. 11921 // 11922 // For C++, things get a bit more nasty... it would be nice to suppress this 11923 // diagnostic for certain cases like using a local variable in an array bound 11924 // for a member of a local class, but the correct predicate is not obvious. 11925 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !S.CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 11926 return; 11927 11928 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VarDC) && 11929 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VarDC->getParent())->isLambda()) { 11930 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_lambda) 11931 << var->getIdentifier(); 11932 } else if (FunctionDecl *fn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VarDC)) { 11933 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function) 11934 << var->getIdentifier() << fn->getDeclName(); 11935 } else if (isa<BlockDecl>(VarDC)) { 11936 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_block) 11937 << var->getIdentifier(); 11938 } else { 11939 // FIXME: Is there any other context where a local variable can be 11940 // declared? 11941 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_context) 11942 << var->getIdentifier(); 11943 } 11944 11945 S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 11946 << var->getIdentifier(); 11947 11948 // FIXME: Add additional diagnostic info about class etc. which prevents 11949 // capture. 11950 } 11951 11952 11953 static bool isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var, 11954 bool &SubCapturesAreNested, 11955 QualType &CaptureType, 11956 QualType &DeclRefType) { 11957 // Check whether we've already captured it. 11958 if (CSI->CaptureMap.count(Var)) { 11959 // If we found a capture, any subcaptures are nested. 11960 SubCapturesAreNested = true; 11961 11962 // Retrieve the capture type for this variable. 11963 CaptureType = CSI->getCapture(Var).getCaptureType(); 11964 11965 // Compute the type of an expression that refers to this variable. 11966 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 11967 11968 const CapturingScopeInfo::Capture &Cap = CSI->getCapture(Var); 11969 if (Cap.isCopyCapture() && 11970 !(isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI) && cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Mutable)) 11971 DeclRefType.addConst(); 11972 return true; 11973 } 11974 return false; 11975 } 11976 11977 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can 11978 // capture; other scopes don't work. 11979 static DeclContext *getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DeclContext *DC, VarDecl *Var, 11980 SourceLocation Loc, 11981 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) { 11982 if (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) || isa<CapturedDecl>(DC) || isLambdaCallOperator(DC)) 11983 return getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC); 11984 else if (Var->hasLocalStorage()) { 11985 if (Diagnose) 11986 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(S, Loc, Var, DC); 11987 } 11988 return nullptr; 11989 } 11990 11991 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture 11992 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.) 11993 // so check for eligibility. 11994 static bool isVariableCapturable(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var, 11995 SourceLocation Loc, 11996 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) { 11997 11998 bool IsBlock = isa<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI); 11999 bool IsLambda = isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 12000 12001 // Lambdas are not allowed to capture unnamed variables 12002 // (e.g. anonymous unions). 12003 // FIXME: The C++11 rule don't actually state this explicitly, but I'm 12004 // assuming that's the intent. 12005 if (IsLambda && !Var->getDeclName()) { 12006 if (Diagnose) { 12007 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_anonymous_var); 12008 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 12009 } 12010 return false; 12011 } 12012 12013 // Prohibit variably-modified types in blocks; they're difficult to deal with. 12014 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && IsBlock) { 12015 if (Diagnose) { 12016 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type); 12017 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12018 << Var->getDeclName(); 12019 } 12020 return false; 12021 } 12022 // Prohibit structs with flexible array members too. 12023 // We cannot capture what is in the tail end of the struct. 12024 if (const RecordType *VTTy = Var->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 12025 if (VTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 12026 if (Diagnose) { 12027 if (IsBlock) 12028 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_flexarray_type); 12029 else 12030 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_flexarray_type) 12031 << Var->getDeclName(); 12032 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12033 << Var->getDeclName(); 12034 } 12035 return false; 12036 } 12037 } 12038 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>(); 12039 // Lambdas and captured statements are not allowed to capture __block 12040 // variables; they don't support the expected semantics. 12041 if (HasBlocksAttr && (IsLambda || isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))) { 12042 if (Diagnose) { 12043 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_capture_block_variable) 12044 << Var->getDeclName() << !IsLambda; 12045 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12046 << Var->getDeclName(); 12047 } 12048 return false; 12049 } 12050 12051 return true; 12052 } 12053 12054 // Returns true if the capture by block was successful. 12055 static bool captureInBlock(BlockScopeInfo *BSI, VarDecl *Var, 12056 SourceLocation Loc, 12057 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 12058 QualType &CaptureType, 12059 QualType &DeclRefType, 12060 const bool Nested, 12061 Sema &S) { 12062 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr; 12063 bool ByRef = false; 12064 12065 // Blocks are not allowed to capture arrays. 12066 if (CaptureType->isArrayType()) { 12067 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12068 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type); 12069 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12070 << Var->getDeclName(); 12071 } 12072 return false; 12073 } 12074 12075 // Forbid the block-capture of autoreleasing variables. 12076 if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 12077 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12078 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) 12079 << /*block*/ 0; 12080 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12081 << Var->getDeclName(); 12082 } 12083 return false; 12084 } 12085 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>(); 12086 if (HasBlocksAttr || CaptureType->isReferenceType()) { 12087 // Block capture by reference does not change the capture or 12088 // declaration reference types. 12089 ByRef = true; 12090 } else { 12091 // Block capture by copy introduces 'const'. 12092 CaptureType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType().withConst(); 12093 DeclRefType = CaptureType; 12094 12095 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuildAndDiagnose) { 12096 if (const RecordType *Record = DeclRefType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 12097 // The capture logic needs the destructor, so make sure we mark it. 12098 // Usually this is unnecessary because most local variables have 12099 // their destructors marked at declaration time, but parameters are 12100 // an exception because it's technically only the call site that 12101 // actually requires the destructor. 12102 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(Var)) 12103 S.FinalizeVarWithDestructor(Var, Record); 12104 12105 // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the copy 12106 // full-expression. 12107 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext scope(S, S.PotentiallyEvaluated); 12108 12109 // According to the blocks spec, the capture of a variable from 12110 // the stack requires a const copy constructor. This is not true 12111 // of the copy/move done to move a __block variable to the heap. 12112 Expr *DeclRef = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, Nested, 12113 DeclRefType.withConst(), 12114 VK_LValue, Loc); 12115 12116 ExprResult Result 12117 = S.PerformCopyInitialization( 12118 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(Var->getLocation(), 12119 CaptureType, false), 12120 Loc, DeclRef); 12121 12122 // Build a full-expression copy expression if initialization 12123 // succeeded and used a non-trivial constructor. Recover from 12124 // errors by pretending that the copy isn't necessary. 12125 if (!Result.isInvalid() && 12126 !cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Result.get())->getConstructor() 12127 ->isTrivial()) { 12128 Result = S.MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Result); 12129 CopyExpr = Result.get(); 12130 } 12131 } 12132 } 12133 } 12134 12135 // Actually capture the variable. 12136 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 12137 BSI->addCapture(Var, HasBlocksAttr, ByRef, Nested, Loc, 12138 SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr); 12139 12140 return true; 12141 12142 } 12143 12144 12145 /// \brief Capture the given variable in the captured region. 12146 static bool captureInCapturedRegion(CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI, 12147 VarDecl *Var, 12148 SourceLocation Loc, 12149 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 12150 QualType &CaptureType, 12151 QualType &DeclRefType, 12152 const bool RefersToCapturedVariable, 12153 Sema &S) { 12154 12155 // By default, capture variables by reference. 12156 bool ByRef = true; 12157 // Using an LValue reference type is consistent with Lambdas (see below). 12158 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 12159 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr; 12160 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12161 // The current implementation assumes that all variables are captured 12162 // by references. Since there is no capture by copy, no expression 12163 // evaluation will be needed. 12164 RecordDecl *RD = RSI->TheRecordDecl; 12165 12166 FieldDecl *Field 12167 = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, RD, Loc, Loc, nullptr, CaptureType, 12168 S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CaptureType, Loc), 12169 nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit); 12170 Field->setImplicit(true); 12171 Field->setAccess(AS_private); 12172 RD->addDecl(Field); 12173 12174 CopyExpr = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, RefersToCapturedVariable, 12175 DeclRefType, VK_LValue, Loc); 12176 Var->setReferenced(true); 12177 Var->markUsed(S.Context); 12178 } 12179 12180 // Actually capture the variable. 12181 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 12182 RSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable, Loc, 12183 SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr); 12184 12185 12186 return true; 12187 } 12188 12189 /// \brief Create a field within the lambda class for the variable 12190 /// being captured. Handle Array captures. 12191 static ExprResult addAsFieldToClosureType(Sema &S, 12192 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 12193 VarDecl *Var, QualType FieldType, 12194 QualType DeclRefType, 12195 SourceLocation Loc, 12196 bool RefersToCapturedVariable) { 12197 CXXRecordDecl *Lambda = LSI->Lambda; 12198 12199 // Build the non-static data member. 12200 FieldDecl *Field 12201 = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, Lambda, Loc, Loc, nullptr, FieldType, 12202 S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FieldType, Loc), 12203 nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit); 12204 Field->setImplicit(true); 12205 Field->setAccess(AS_private); 12206 Lambda->addDecl(Field); 12207 12208 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p21: 12209 // When the lambda-expression is evaluated, the entities that 12210 // are captured by copy are used to direct-initialize each 12211 // corresponding non-static data member of the resulting closure 12212 // object. (For array members, the array elements are 12213 // direct-initialized in increasing subscript order.) These 12214 // initializations are performed in the (unspecified) order in 12215 // which the non-static data members are declared. 12216 12217 // Introduce a new evaluation context for the initialization, so 12218 // that temporaries introduced as part of the capture are retained 12219 // to be re-"exported" from the lambda expression itself. 12220 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext scope(S, Sema::PotentiallyEvaluated); 12221 12222 // C++ [expr.prim.labda]p12: 12223 // An entity captured by a lambda-expression is odr-used (3.2) in 12224 // the scope containing the lambda-expression. 12225 Expr *Ref = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, RefersToCapturedVariable, 12226 DeclRefType, VK_LValue, Loc); 12227 Var->setReferenced(true); 12228 Var->markUsed(S.Context); 12229 12230 // When the field has array type, create index variables for each 12231 // dimension of the array. We use these index variables to subscript 12232 // the source array, and other clients (e.g., CodeGen) will perform 12233 // the necessary iteration with these index variables. 12234 SmallVector<VarDecl *, 4> IndexVariables; 12235 QualType BaseType = FieldType; 12236 QualType SizeType = S.Context.getSizeType(); 12237 LSI->ArrayIndexStarts.push_back(LSI->ArrayIndexVars.size()); 12238 while (const ConstantArrayType *Array 12239 = S.Context.getAsConstantArrayType(BaseType)) { 12240 // Create the iteration variable for this array index. 12241 IdentifierInfo *IterationVarName = nullptr; 12242 { 12243 SmallString<8> Str; 12244 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str); 12245 OS << "__i" << IndexVariables.size(); 12246 IterationVarName = &S.Context.Idents.get(OS.str()); 12247 } 12248 VarDecl *IterationVar 12249 = VarDecl::Create(S.Context, S.CurContext, Loc, Loc, 12250 IterationVarName, SizeType, 12251 S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(SizeType, Loc), 12252 SC_None); 12253 IndexVariables.push_back(IterationVar); 12254 LSI->ArrayIndexVars.push_back(IterationVar); 12255 12256 // Create a reference to the iteration variable. 12257 ExprResult IterationVarRef 12258 = S.BuildDeclRefExpr(IterationVar, SizeType, VK_LValue, Loc); 12259 assert(!IterationVarRef.isInvalid() && 12260 "Reference to invented variable cannot fail!"); 12261 IterationVarRef = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(IterationVarRef.get()); 12262 assert(!IterationVarRef.isInvalid() && 12263 "Conversion of invented variable cannot fail!"); 12264 12265 // Subscript the array with this iteration variable. 12266 ExprResult Subscript = S.CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr( 12267 Ref, Loc, IterationVarRef.get(), Loc); 12268 if (Subscript.isInvalid()) { 12269 S.CleanupVarDeclMarking(); 12270 S.DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 12271 return ExprError(); 12272 } 12273 12274 Ref = Subscript.get(); 12275 BaseType = Array->getElementType(); 12276 } 12277 12278 // Construct the entity that we will be initializing. For an array, this 12279 // will be first element in the array, which may require several levels 12280 // of array-subscript entities. 12281 SmallVector<InitializedEntity, 4> Entities; 12282 Entities.reserve(1 + IndexVariables.size()); 12283 Entities.push_back( 12284 InitializedEntity::InitializeLambdaCapture(Var->getIdentifier(), 12285 Field->getType(), Loc)); 12286 for (unsigned I = 0, N = IndexVariables.size(); I != N; ++I) 12287 Entities.push_back(InitializedEntity::InitializeElement(S.Context, 12288 0, 12289 Entities.back())); 12290 12291 InitializationKind InitKind 12292 = InitializationKind::CreateDirect(Loc, Loc, Loc); 12293 InitializationSequence Init(S, Entities.back(), InitKind, Ref); 12294 ExprResult Result(true); 12295 if (!Init.Diagnose(S, Entities.back(), InitKind, Ref)) 12296 Result = Init.Perform(S, Entities.back(), InitKind, Ref); 12297 12298 // If this initialization requires any cleanups (e.g., due to a 12299 // default argument to a copy constructor), note that for the 12300 // lambda. 12301 if (S.ExprNeedsCleanups) 12302 LSI->ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 12303 12304 // Exit the expression evaluation context used for the capture. 12305 S.CleanupVarDeclMarking(); 12306 S.DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 12307 return Result; 12308 } 12309 12310 12311 12312 /// \brief Capture the given variable in the lambda. 12313 static bool captureInLambda(LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 12314 VarDecl *Var, 12315 SourceLocation Loc, 12316 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 12317 QualType &CaptureType, 12318 QualType &DeclRefType, 12319 const bool RefersToCapturedVariable, 12320 const Sema::TryCaptureKind Kind, 12321 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, 12322 const bool IsTopScope, 12323 Sema &S) { 12324 12325 // Determine whether we are capturing by reference or by value. 12326 bool ByRef = false; 12327 if (IsTopScope && Kind != Sema::TryCapture_Implicit) { 12328 ByRef = (Kind == Sema::TryCapture_ExplicitByRef); 12329 } else { 12330 ByRef = (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == LambdaScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref); 12331 } 12332 12333 // Compute the type of the field that will capture this variable. 12334 if (ByRef) { 12335 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p15: 12336 // An entity is captured by reference if it is implicitly or 12337 // explicitly captured but not captured by copy. It is 12338 // unspecified whether additional unnamed non-static data 12339 // members are declared in the closure type for entities 12340 // captured by reference. 12341 // 12342 // FIXME: It is not clear whether we want to build an lvalue reference 12343 // to the DeclRefType or to CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(). GCC appears 12344 // to do the former, while EDG does the latter. Core issue 1249 will 12345 // clarify, but for now we follow GCC because it's a more permissive and 12346 // easily defensible position. 12347 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 12348 } else { 12349 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p14: 12350 // For each entity captured by copy, an unnamed non-static 12351 // data member is declared in the closure type. The 12352 // declaration order of these members is unspecified. The type 12353 // of such a data member is the type of the corresponding 12354 // captured entity if the entity is not a reference to an 12355 // object, or the referenced type otherwise. [Note: If the 12356 // captured entity is a reference to a function, the 12357 // corresponding data member is also a reference to a 12358 // function. - end note ] 12359 if (const ReferenceType *RefType = CaptureType->getAs<ReferenceType>()){ 12360 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 12361 CaptureType = RefType->getPointeeType(); 12362 } 12363 12364 // Forbid the lambda copy-capture of autoreleasing variables. 12365 if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 12366 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12367 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) << /*lambda*/ 1; 12368 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12369 << Var->getDeclName(); 12370 } 12371 return false; 12372 } 12373 12374 // Make sure that by-copy captures are of a complete and non-abstract type. 12375 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12376 if (!CaptureType->isDependentType() && 12377 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, CaptureType, 12378 diag::err_capture_of_incomplete_type, 12379 Var->getDeclName())) 12380 return false; 12381 12382 if (S.RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, CaptureType, 12383 diag::err_capture_of_abstract_type)) 12384 return false; 12385 } 12386 } 12387 12388 // Capture this variable in the lambda. 12389 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr; 12390 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12391 ExprResult Result = addAsFieldToClosureType(S, LSI, Var, 12392 CaptureType, DeclRefType, Loc, 12393 RefersToCapturedVariable); 12394 if (!Result.isInvalid()) 12395 CopyExpr = Result.get(); 12396 } 12397 12398 // Compute the type of a reference to this captured variable. 12399 if (ByRef) 12400 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 12401 else { 12402 // C++ [expr.prim.lambda]p5: 12403 // The closure type for a lambda-expression has a public inline 12404 // function call operator [...]. This function call operator is 12405 // declared const (9.3.1) if and only if the lambda-expression’s 12406 // parameter-declaration-clause is not followed by mutable. 12407 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 12408 if (!LSI->Mutable && !CaptureType->isReferenceType()) 12409 DeclRefType.addConst(); 12410 } 12411 12412 // Add the capture. 12413 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 12414 LSI->addCapture(Var, /*IsBlock=*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable, 12415 Loc, EllipsisLoc, CaptureType, CopyExpr); 12416 12417 return true; 12418 } 12419 12420 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation ExprLoc, 12421 TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, 12422 bool BuildAndDiagnose, 12423 QualType &CaptureType, 12424 QualType &DeclRefType, 12425 const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) { 12426 bool Nested = Var->isInitCapture(); 12427 12428 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 12429 const unsigned MaxFunctionScopesIndex = FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt 12430 ? *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt : FunctionScopes.size() - 1; 12431 // We need to sync up the Declaration Context with the 12432 // FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt 12433 if (FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) { 12434 unsigned FSIndex = FunctionScopes.size() - 1; 12435 while (FSIndex != MaxFunctionScopesIndex) { 12436 DC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC); 12437 --FSIndex; 12438 } 12439 } 12440 12441 12442 // If the variable is declared in the current context (and is not an 12443 // init-capture), there is no need to capture it. 12444 if (!Nested && Var->getDeclContext() == DC) return true; 12445 12446 // Capture global variables if it is required to use private copy of this 12447 // variable. 12448 bool IsGlobal = !Var->hasLocalStorage(); 12449 if (IsGlobal && !(LangOpts.OpenMP && IsOpenMPCapturedVar(Var))) 12450 return true; 12451 12452 // Walk up the stack to determine whether we can capture the variable, 12453 // performing the "simple" checks that don't depend on type. We stop when 12454 // we've either hit the declared scope of the variable or find an existing 12455 // capture of that variable. We start from the innermost capturing-entity 12456 // (the DC) and ensure that all intervening capturing-entities 12457 // (blocks/lambdas etc.) between the innermost capturer and the variable`s 12458 // declcontext can either capture the variable or have already captured 12459 // the variable. 12460 CaptureType = Var->getType(); 12461 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 12462 bool Explicit = (Kind != TryCapture_Implicit); 12463 unsigned FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex; 12464 do { 12465 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can 12466 // capture; other scopes don't work. 12467 DeclContext *ParentDC = getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DC, Var, 12468 ExprLoc, 12469 BuildAndDiagnose, 12470 *this); 12471 // We need to check for the parent *first* because, if we *have* 12472 // private-captured a global variable, we need to recursively capture it in 12473 // intermediate blocks, lambdas, etc. 12474 if (!ParentDC) { 12475 if (IsGlobal) { 12476 FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex - 1; 12477 break; 12478 } 12479 return true; 12480 } 12481 12482 FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex]; 12483 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FSI); 12484 12485 12486 // Check whether we've already captured it. 12487 if (isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CSI, Var, Nested, CaptureType, 12488 DeclRefType)) 12489 break; 12490 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator body, 12491 // we do not want to capture new variables. What was captured 12492 // during either a lambdas transformation or initial parsing 12493 // should be used. 12494 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(DC)) { 12495 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12496 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 12497 if (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None) { 12498 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName(); 12499 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12500 << Var->getDeclName(); 12501 Diag(LSI->Lambda->getLocStart(), diag::note_lambda_decl); 12502 } else 12503 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, ExprLoc, Var, DC); 12504 } 12505 return true; 12506 } 12507 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture 12508 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.) 12509 // so check for eligibility. 12510 if (!isVariableCapturable(CSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, *this)) 12511 return true; 12512 12513 // Try to capture variable-length arrays types. 12514 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 12515 // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA 12516 // expressions. 12517 QualType QTy = Var->getType(); 12518 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast_or_null<ParmVarDecl>(Var)) 12519 QTy = PVD->getOriginalType(); 12520 do { 12521 const Type *Ty = QTy.getTypePtr(); 12522 switch (Ty->getTypeClass()) { 12523 #define TYPE(Class, Base) 12524 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) 12525 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) 12526 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 12527 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) 12528 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 12529 QTy = QualType(); 12530 break; 12531 // These types are never variably-modified. 12532 case Type::Builtin: 12533 case Type::Complex: 12534 case Type::Vector: 12535 case Type::ExtVector: 12536 case Type::Record: 12537 case Type::Enum: 12538 case Type::Elaborated: 12539 case Type::TemplateSpecialization: 12540 case Type::ObjCObject: 12541 case Type::ObjCInterface: 12542 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: 12543 llvm_unreachable("type class is never variably-modified!"); 12544 case Type::Adjusted: 12545 QTy = cast<AdjustedType>(Ty)->getOriginalType(); 12546 break; 12547 case Type::Decayed: 12548 QTy = cast<DecayedType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12549 break; 12550 case Type::Pointer: 12551 QTy = cast<PointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12552 break; 12553 case Type::BlockPointer: 12554 QTy = cast<BlockPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12555 break; 12556 case Type::LValueReference: 12557 case Type::RValueReference: 12558 QTy = cast<ReferenceType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12559 break; 12560 case Type::MemberPointer: 12561 QTy = cast<MemberPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12562 break; 12563 case Type::ConstantArray: 12564 case Type::IncompleteArray: 12565 // Losing element qualification here is fine. 12566 QTy = cast<ArrayType>(Ty)->getElementType(); 12567 break; 12568 case Type::VariableArray: { 12569 // Losing element qualification here is fine. 12570 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(Ty); 12571 12572 // Unknown size indication requires no size computation. 12573 // Otherwise, evaluate and record it. 12574 if (auto Size = VAT->getSizeExpr()) { 12575 if (!CSI->isVLATypeCaptured(VAT)) { 12576 RecordDecl *CapRecord = nullptr; 12577 if (auto LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 12578 CapRecord = LSI->Lambda; 12579 } else if (auto CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 12580 CapRecord = CRSI->TheRecordDecl; 12581 } 12582 if (CapRecord) { 12583 auto ExprLoc = Size->getExprLoc(); 12584 auto SizeType = Context.getSizeType(); 12585 // Build the non-static data member. 12586 auto Field = FieldDecl::Create( 12587 Context, CapRecord, ExprLoc, ExprLoc, 12588 /*Id*/ nullptr, SizeType, /*TInfo*/ nullptr, 12589 /*BW*/ nullptr, /*Mutable*/ false, 12590 /*InitStyle*/ ICIS_NoInit); 12591 Field->setImplicit(true); 12592 Field->setAccess(AS_private); 12593 Field->setCapturedVLAType(VAT); 12594 CapRecord->addDecl(Field); 12595 12596 CSI->addVLATypeCapture(ExprLoc, SizeType); 12597 } 12598 } 12599 } 12600 QTy = VAT->getElementType(); 12601 break; 12602 } 12603 case Type::FunctionProto: 12604 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 12605 QTy = cast<FunctionType>(Ty)->getReturnType(); 12606 break; 12607 case Type::Paren: 12608 case Type::TypeOf: 12609 case Type::UnaryTransform: 12610 case Type::Attributed: 12611 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm: 12612 case Type::PackExpansion: 12613 // Keep walking after single level desugaring. 12614 QTy = QTy.getSingleStepDesugaredType(getASTContext()); 12615 break; 12616 case Type::Typedef: 12617 QTy = cast<TypedefType>(Ty)->desugar(); 12618 break; 12619 case Type::Decltype: 12620 QTy = cast<DecltypeType>(Ty)->desugar(); 12621 break; 12622 case Type::Auto: 12623 QTy = cast<AutoType>(Ty)->getDeducedType(); 12624 break; 12625 case Type::TypeOfExpr: 12626 QTy = cast<TypeOfExprType>(Ty)->getUnderlyingExpr()->getType(); 12627 break; 12628 case Type::Atomic: 12629 QTy = cast<AtomicType>(Ty)->getValueType(); 12630 break; 12631 } 12632 } while (!QTy.isNull() && QTy->isVariablyModifiedType()); 12633 } 12634 12635 if (CSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None && !Explicit) { 12636 // No capture-default, and this is not an explicit capture 12637 // so cannot capture this variable. 12638 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12639 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName(); 12640 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12641 << Var->getDeclName(); 12642 Diag(cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda->getLocStart(), 12643 diag::note_lambda_decl); 12644 // FIXME: If we error out because an outer lambda can not implicitly 12645 // capture a variable that an inner lambda explicitly captures, we 12646 // should have the inner lambda do the explicit capture - because 12647 // it makes for cleaner diagnostics later. This would purely be done 12648 // so that the diagnostic does not misleadingly claim that a variable 12649 // can not be captured by a lambda implicitly even though it is captured 12650 // explicitly. Suggestion: 12651 // - create const bool VariableCaptureWasInitiallyExplicit = Explicit 12652 // at the function head 12653 // - cache the StartingDeclContext - this must be a lambda 12654 // - captureInLambda in the innermost lambda the variable. 12655 } 12656 return true; 12657 } 12658 12659 FunctionScopesIndex--; 12660 DC = ParentDC; 12661 Explicit = false; 12662 } while (!Var->getDeclContext()->Equals(DC)); 12663 12664 // Walk back down the scope stack, (e.g. from outer lambda to inner lambda) 12665 // computing the type of the capture at each step, checking type-specific 12666 // requirements, and adding captures if requested. 12667 // If the variable had already been captured previously, we start capturing 12668 // at the lambda nested within that one. 12669 for (unsigned I = ++FunctionScopesIndex, N = MaxFunctionScopesIndex + 1; I != N; 12670 ++I) { 12671 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes[I]); 12672 12673 if (BlockScopeInfo *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 12674 if (!captureInBlock(BSI, Var, ExprLoc, 12675 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 12676 DeclRefType, Nested, *this)) 12677 return true; 12678 Nested = true; 12679 } else if (CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 12680 if (!captureInCapturedRegion(RSI, Var, ExprLoc, 12681 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 12682 DeclRefType, Nested, *this)) 12683 return true; 12684 Nested = true; 12685 } else { 12686 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 12687 if (!captureInLambda(LSI, Var, ExprLoc, 12688 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 12689 DeclRefType, Nested, Kind, EllipsisLoc, 12690 /*IsTopScope*/I == N - 1, *this)) 12691 return true; 12692 Nested = true; 12693 } 12694 } 12695 return false; 12696 } 12697 12698 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc, 12699 TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc) { 12700 QualType CaptureType; 12701 QualType DeclRefType; 12702 return tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Kind, EllipsisLoc, 12703 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/true, CaptureType, 12704 DeclRefType, nullptr); 12705 } 12706 12707 bool Sema::NeedToCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) { 12708 QualType CaptureType; 12709 QualType DeclRefType; 12710 return !tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(), 12711 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType, 12712 DeclRefType, nullptr); 12713 } 12714 12715 QualType Sema::getCapturedDeclRefType(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) { 12716 QualType CaptureType; 12717 QualType DeclRefType; 12718 12719 // Determine whether we can capture this variable. 12720 if (tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(), 12721 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType, 12722 DeclRefType, nullptr)) 12723 return QualType(); 12724 12725 return DeclRefType; 12726 } 12727 12728 12729 12730 // If either the type of the variable or the initializer is dependent, 12731 // return false. Otherwise, determine whether the variable is a constant 12732 // expression. Use this if you need to know if a variable that might or 12733 // might not be dependent is truly a constant expression. 12734 static inline bool IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(VarDecl *Var, 12735 ASTContext &Context) { 12736 12737 if (Var->getType()->isDependentType()) 12738 return false; 12739 const VarDecl *DefVD = nullptr; 12740 Var->getAnyInitializer(DefVD); 12741 if (!DefVD) 12742 return false; 12743 EvaluatedStmt *Eval = DefVD->ensureEvaluatedStmt(); 12744 Expr *Init = cast<Expr>(Eval->Value); 12745 if (Init->isValueDependent()) 12746 return false; 12747 return IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, Context); 12748 } 12749 12750 12751 void Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Expr *E) { 12752 // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it is 12753 // an object that satisfies the requirements for appearing in a 12754 // constant expression (5.19) and the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1) 12755 // is immediately applied." This function handles the lvalue-to-rvalue 12756 // conversion part. 12757 MaybeODRUseExprs.erase(E->IgnoreParens()); 12758 12759 // If we are in a lambda, check if this DeclRefExpr or MemberExpr refers 12760 // to a variable that is a constant expression, and if so, identify it as 12761 // a reference to a variable that does not involve an odr-use of that 12762 // variable. 12763 if (LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda()) { 12764 Expr *SansParensExpr = E->IgnoreParens(); 12765 VarDecl *Var = nullptr; 12766 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(SansParensExpr)) 12767 Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getFoundDecl()); 12768 else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(SansParensExpr)) 12769 Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 12770 12771 if (Var && IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, Context)) 12772 LSI->markVariableExprAsNonODRUsed(SansParensExpr); 12773 } 12774 } 12775 12776 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res) { 12777 Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Res); 12778 12779 if (!Res.isUsable()) 12780 return Res; 12781 12782 // If a constant-expression is a reference to a variable where we delay 12783 // deciding whether it is an odr-use, just assume we will apply the 12784 // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion. In the one case where this doesn't happen 12785 // (a non-type template argument), we have special handling anyway. 12786 UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Res.get()); 12787 return Res; 12788 } 12789 12790 void Sema::CleanupVarDeclMarking() { 12791 for (llvm::SmallPtrSetIterator<Expr*> i = MaybeODRUseExprs.begin(), 12792 e = MaybeODRUseExprs.end(); 12793 i != e; ++i) { 12794 VarDecl *Var; 12795 SourceLocation Loc; 12796 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(*i)) { 12797 Var = cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 12798 Loc = DRE->getLocation(); 12799 } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(*i)) { 12800 Var = cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 12801 Loc = ME->getMemberLoc(); 12802 } else { 12803 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected expression"); 12804 } 12805 12806 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, *this, 12807 /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex Pointer*/ nullptr); 12808 } 12809 12810 MaybeODRUseExprs.clear(); 12811 } 12812 12813 12814 static void DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, 12815 VarDecl *Var, Expr *E) { 12816 assert((!E || isa<DeclRefExpr>(E) || isa<MemberExpr>(E)) && 12817 "Invalid Expr argument to DoMarkVarDeclReferenced"); 12818 Var->setReferenced(); 12819 12820 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind(); 12821 bool MarkODRUsed = true; 12822 12823 // If the context is not potentially evaluated, this is not an odr-use and 12824 // does not trigger instantiation. 12825 if (!IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(SemaRef)) { 12826 if (SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext()) 12827 return; 12828 12829 // If we don't yet know whether this context is going to end up being an 12830 // evaluated context, and we're referencing a variable from an enclosing 12831 // scope, add a potential capture. 12832 // 12833 // FIXME: Is this necessary? These contexts are only used for default 12834 // arguments, where local variables can't be used. 12835 const bool RefersToEnclosingScope = 12836 (SemaRef.CurContext != Var->getDeclContext() && 12837 Var->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && Var->hasLocalStorage()); 12838 if (RefersToEnclosingScope) { 12839 if (LambdaScopeInfo *const LSI = SemaRef.getCurLambda()) { 12840 // If a variable could potentially be odr-used, defer marking it so 12841 // until we finish analyzing the full expression for any 12842 // lvalue-to-rvalue 12843 // or discarded value conversions that would obviate odr-use. 12844 // Add it to the list of potential captures that will be analyzed 12845 // later (ActOnFinishFullExpr) for eventual capture and odr-use marking 12846 // unless the variable is a reference that was initialized by a constant 12847 // expression (this will never need to be captured or odr-used). 12848 assert(E && "Capture variable should be used in an expression."); 12849 if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType() || 12850 !IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context)) 12851 LSI->addPotentialCapture(E->IgnoreParens()); 12852 } 12853 } 12854 12855 if (!isTemplateInstantiation(TSK)) 12856 return; 12857 12858 // Instantiate, but do not mark as odr-used, variable templates. 12859 MarkODRUsed = false; 12860 } 12861 12862 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec = 12863 dyn_cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var); 12864 assert(!isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Var) && 12865 "Can't instantiate a partial template specialization."); 12866 12867 // Perform implicit instantiation of static data members, static data member 12868 // templates of class templates, and variable template specializations. Delay 12869 // instantiations of variable templates, except for those that could be used 12870 // in a constant expression. 12871 if (isTemplateInstantiation(TSK)) { 12872 bool TryInstantiating = TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation; 12873 12874 if (TryInstantiating && !isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var)) { 12875 if (Var->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) { 12876 // This is a modification of an existing AST node. Notify listeners. 12877 if (ASTMutationListener *L = SemaRef.getASTMutationListener()) 12878 L->StaticDataMemberInstantiated(Var); 12879 } else if (!Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context)) 12880 // Don't bother trying to instantiate it again, unless we might need 12881 // its initializer before we get to the end of the TU. 12882 TryInstantiating = false; 12883 } 12884 12885 if (Var->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) 12886 Var->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, Loc); 12887 12888 if (TryInstantiating) { 12889 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Var->getPointOfInstantiation(); 12890 bool InstantiationDependent = false; 12891 bool IsNonDependent = 12892 VarSpec ? !TemplateSpecializationType::anyDependentTemplateArguments( 12893 VarSpec->getTemplateArgsInfo(), InstantiationDependent) 12894 : true; 12895 12896 // Do not instantiate specializations that are still type-dependent. 12897 if (IsNonDependent) { 12898 if (Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context)) { 12899 // Do not defer instantiations of variables which could be used in a 12900 // constant expression. 12901 SemaRef.InstantiateVariableDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Var); 12902 } else { 12903 SemaRef.PendingInstantiations 12904 .push_back(std::make_pair(Var, PointOfInstantiation)); 12905 } 12906 } 12907 } 12908 } 12909 12910 if(!MarkODRUsed) return; 12911 12912 // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it satisfies 12913 // the requirements for appearing in a constant expression (5.19) and, if 12914 // it is an object, the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1) 12915 // is immediately applied." We check the first part here, and 12916 // Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue deals with the second part. 12917 // Note that we use the C++11 definition everywhere because nothing in 12918 // C++03 depends on whether we get the C++03 version correct. The second 12919 // part does not apply to references, since they are not objects. 12920 if (E && IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context)) { 12921 // A reference initialized by a constant expression can never be 12922 // odr-used, so simply ignore it. 12923 if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType()) 12924 SemaRef.MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(E); 12925 } else 12926 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, SemaRef, 12927 /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex ptr*/ nullptr); 12928 } 12929 12930 /// \brief Mark a variable referenced, and check whether it is odr-used 12931 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3). Note that this should not be 12932 /// used directly for normal expressions referring to VarDecl. 12933 void Sema::MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, VarDecl *Var) { 12934 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(*this, Loc, Var, nullptr); 12935 } 12936 12937 static void MarkExprReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, 12938 Decl *D, Expr *E, bool OdrUse) { 12939 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 12940 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(SemaRef, Loc, Var, E); 12941 return; 12942 } 12943 12944 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, OdrUse); 12945 12946 // If this is a call to a method via a cast, also mark the method in the 12947 // derived class used in case codegen can devirtualize the call. 12948 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E); 12949 if (!ME) 12950 return; 12951 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 12952 if (!MD) 12953 return; 12954 // Only attempt to devirtualize if this is truly a virtual call. 12955 bool IsVirtualCall = MD->isVirtual() && !ME->hasQualifier(); 12956 if (!IsVirtualCall) 12957 return; 12958 const Expr *Base = ME->getBase(); 12959 const CXXRecordDecl *MostDerivedClassDecl = Base->getBestDynamicClassType(); 12960 if (!MostDerivedClassDecl) 12961 return; 12962 CXXMethodDecl *DM = MD->getCorrespondingMethodInClass(MostDerivedClassDecl); 12963 if (!DM || DM->isPure()) 12964 return; 12965 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, DM, OdrUse); 12966 } 12967 12968 /// \brief Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a DeclRefExpr. 12969 void Sema::MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr *E) { 12970 // TODO: update this with DR# once a defect report is filed. 12971 // C++11 defect. The address of a pure member should not be an ODR use, even 12972 // if it's a qualified reference. 12973 bool OdrUse = true; 12974 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getDecl())) 12975 if (Method->isVirtual()) 12976 OdrUse = false; 12977 MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getLocation(), E->getDecl(), E, OdrUse); 12978 } 12979 12980 /// \brief Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a MemberExpr. 12981 void Sema::MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr *E) { 12982 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p2: 12983 // A non-overloaded function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated 12984 // expression or a member of a set of candidate functions, if selected by 12985 // overload resolution when referred to from a potentially-evaluated 12986 // expression, is odr-used, unless it is a pure virtual function and its 12987 // name is not explicitly qualified. 12988 bool OdrUse = true; 12989 if (!E->hasQualifier()) { 12990 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl())) 12991 if (Method->isPure()) 12992 OdrUse = false; 12993 } 12994 SourceLocation Loc = E->getMemberLoc().isValid() ? 12995 E->getMemberLoc() : E->getLocStart(); 12996 MarkExprReferenced(*this, Loc, E->getMemberDecl(), E, OdrUse); 12997 } 12998 12999 /// \brief Perform marking for a reference to an arbitrary declaration. It 13000 /// marks the declaration referenced, and performs odr-use checking for 13001 /// functions and variables. This method should not be used when building a 13002 /// normal expression which refers to a variable. 13003 void Sema::MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D, bool OdrUse) { 13004 if (OdrUse) { 13005 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 13006 MarkVariableReferenced(Loc, VD); 13007 return; 13008 } 13009 } 13010 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 13011 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, FD, OdrUse); 13012 return; 13013 } 13014 D->setReferenced(); 13015 } 13016 13017 namespace { 13018 // Mark all of the declarations referenced 13019 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding 13020 // of when we're entering 13021 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> { 13022 Sema &S; 13023 SourceLocation Loc; 13024 13025 public: 13026 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited; 13027 13028 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { } 13029 13030 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg); 13031 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T); 13032 }; 13033 } 13034 13035 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument( 13036 const TemplateArgument &Arg) { 13037 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) { 13038 if (Decl *D = Arg.getAsDecl()) 13039 S.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, true); 13040 } 13041 13042 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg); 13043 } 13044 13045 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) { 13046 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec 13047 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) { 13048 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs(); 13049 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size()); 13050 } 13051 13052 return true; 13053 } 13054 13055 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) { 13056 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc); 13057 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T)); 13058 } 13059 13060 namespace { 13061 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by 13062 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced". 13063 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> { 13064 Sema &S; 13065 bool SkipLocalVariables; 13066 13067 public: 13068 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited; 13069 13070 EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S, bool SkipLocalVariables) 13071 : Inherited(S.Context), S(S), SkipLocalVariables(SkipLocalVariables) { } 13072 13073 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 13074 // If we were asked not to visit local variables, don't. 13075 if (SkipLocalVariables) { 13076 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(E->getDecl())) 13077 if (VD->hasLocalStorage()) 13078 return; 13079 } 13080 13081 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(E); 13082 } 13083 13084 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 13085 S.MarkMemberReferenced(E); 13086 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E); 13087 } 13088 13089 void VisitCXXBindTemporaryExpr(CXXBindTemporaryExpr *E) { 13090 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), 13091 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(E->getTemporary()->getDestructor())); 13092 Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13093 } 13094 13095 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) { 13096 if (E->getOperatorNew()) 13097 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew()); 13098 if (E->getOperatorDelete()) 13099 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete()); 13100 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E); 13101 } 13102 13103 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) { 13104 if (E->getOperatorDelete()) 13105 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete()); 13106 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType()); 13107 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) { 13108 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl()); 13109 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), 13110 S.LookupDestructor(Record)); 13111 } 13112 13113 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E); 13114 } 13115 13116 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) { 13117 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor()); 13118 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E); 13119 } 13120 13121 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) { 13122 Visit(E->getExpr()); 13123 } 13124 13125 void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 13126 Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E); 13127 13128 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) 13129 S.UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E->getSubExpr()); 13130 } 13131 }; 13132 } 13133 13134 /// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any 13135 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced". 13136 /// 13137 /// \param SkipLocalVariables If true, don't mark local variables as 13138 /// 'referenced'. 13139 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E, 13140 bool SkipLocalVariables) { 13141 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this, SkipLocalVariables).Visit(E); 13142 } 13143 13144 /// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior 13145 /// of the program being compiled. 13146 /// 13147 /// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being 13148 /// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a 13149 /// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof() 13150 /// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not 13151 /// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or, 13152 /// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated 13153 /// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it 13154 /// later. 13155 /// 13156 /// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time 13157 /// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis. 13158 /// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures 13159 /// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid. 13160 bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement, 13161 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) { 13162 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 13163 case Unevaluated: 13164 case UnevaluatedAbstract: 13165 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain. 13166 break; 13167 13168 case ConstantEvaluated: 13169 // Relevant diagnostics should be produced by constant evaluation. 13170 break; 13171 13172 case PotentiallyEvaluated: 13173 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 13174 if (Statement && getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) { 13175 FunctionScopes.back()->PossiblyUnreachableDiags. 13176 push_back(sema::PossiblyUnreachableDiag(PD, Loc, Statement)); 13177 } 13178 else 13179 Diag(Loc, PD); 13180 13181 return true; 13182 } 13183 13184 return false; 13185 } 13186 13187 bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc, 13188 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) { 13189 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType()) 13190 return false; 13191 13192 // If we're inside a decltype's expression, don't check for a valid return 13193 // type or construct temporaries until we know whether this is the last call. 13194 if (ExprEvalContexts.back().IsDecltype) { 13195 ExprEvalContexts.back().DelayedDecltypeCalls.push_back(CE); 13196 return false; 13197 } 13198 13199 class CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser : public TypeDiagnoser { 13200 FunctionDecl *FD; 13201 CallExpr *CE; 13202 13203 public: 13204 CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, CallExpr *CE) 13205 : FD(FD), CE(CE) { } 13206 13207 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 13208 if (!FD) { 13209 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_incomplete_return) 13210 << T << CE->getSourceRange(); 13211 return; 13212 } 13213 13214 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return) 13215 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() << T; 13216 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 13217 << FD->getDeclName(); 13218 } 13219 } Diagnoser(FD, CE); 13220 13221 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType, Diagnoser)) 13222 return true; 13223 13224 return false; 13225 } 13226 13227 // Diagnose the s/=/==/ and s/\|=/!=/ typos. Note that adding parentheses 13228 // will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want. 13229 void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) { 13230 SourceLocation Loc; 13231 13232 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment; 13233 bool IsOrAssign = false; 13234 13235 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 13236 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign && Op->getOpcode() != BO_OrAssign) 13237 return; 13238 13239 IsOrAssign = Op->getOpcode() == BO_OrAssign; 13240 13241 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory. 13242 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME 13243 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 13244 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector(); 13245 13246 // self = [<foo> init...] 13247 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS()) && ME->getMethodFamily() == OMF_init) 13248 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment; 13249 13250 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject] 13251 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() && Sel.getNameForSlot(0) == "nextObject") 13252 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment; 13253 } 13254 13255 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc(); 13256 } else if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) { 13257 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal && Op->getOperator() != OO_PipeEqual) 13258 return; 13259 13260 IsOrAssign = Op->getOperator() == OO_PipeEqual; 13261 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc(); 13262 } else if (PseudoObjectExpr *POE = dyn_cast<PseudoObjectExpr>(E)) 13263 return DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(POE->getSyntacticForm()); 13264 else { 13265 // Not an assignment. 13266 return; 13267 } 13268 13269 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange(); 13270 13271 SourceLocation Open = E->getLocStart(); 13272 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 13273 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence) 13274 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(") 13275 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")"); 13276 13277 if (IsOrAssign) 13278 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_or_assign_to_comparison) 13279 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "!="); 13280 else 13281 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison) 13282 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "=="); 13283 } 13284 13285 /// \brief Redundant parentheses over an equality comparison can indicate 13286 /// that the user intended an assignment used as condition. 13287 void Sema::DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr *ParenE) { 13288 // Don't warn if the parens came from a macro. 13289 SourceLocation parenLoc = ParenE->getLocStart(); 13290 if (parenLoc.isInvalid() || parenLoc.isMacroID()) 13291 return; 13292 // Don't warn for dependent expressions. 13293 if (ParenE->isTypeDependent()) 13294 return; 13295 13296 Expr *E = ParenE->IgnoreParens(); 13297 13298 if (BinaryOperator *opE = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) 13299 if (opE->getOpcode() == BO_EQ && 13300 opE->getLHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->isModifiableLvalue(Context) 13301 == Expr::MLV_Valid) { 13302 SourceLocation Loc = opE->getOperatorLoc(); 13303 13304 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_equality_with_extra_parens) << E->getSourceRange(); 13305 SourceRange ParenERange = ParenE->getSourceRange(); 13306 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_silence) 13307 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getBegin()) 13308 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getEnd()); 13309 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_to_assign) 13310 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "="); 13311 } 13312 } 13313 13314 ExprResult Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 13315 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E); 13316 if (ParenExpr *parenE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) 13317 DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(parenE); 13318 13319 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 13320 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13321 E = result.get(); 13322 13323 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) { 13324 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13325 return CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E); // C++ 6.4p4 13326 13327 ExprResult ERes = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E); 13328 if (ERes.isInvalid()) 13329 return ExprError(); 13330 E = ERes.get(); 13331 13332 QualType T = E->getType(); 13333 if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1 13334 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar) 13335 << T << E->getSourceRange(); 13336 return ExprError(); 13337 } 13338 CheckBoolLikeConversion(E, Loc); 13339 } 13340 13341 return E; 13342 } 13343 13344 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc, 13345 Expr *SubExpr) { 13346 if (!SubExpr) 13347 return ExprError(); 13348 13349 return CheckBooleanCondition(SubExpr, Loc); 13350 } 13351 13352 namespace { 13353 /// A visitor for rebuilding a call to an __unknown_any expression 13354 /// to have an appropriate type. 13355 struct RebuildUnknownAnyFunction 13356 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyFunction, ExprResult> { 13357 13358 Sema &S; 13359 13360 RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 13361 13362 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) { 13363 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!"); 13364 } 13365 13366 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) { 13367 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_call) 13368 << E->getSourceRange(); 13369 return ExprError(); 13370 } 13371 13372 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another 13373 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of. 13374 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) { 13375 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13376 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13377 13378 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 13379 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 13380 E->setType(SubExpr->getType()); 13381 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind()); 13382 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13383 return E; 13384 } 13385 13386 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) { 13387 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 13388 } 13389 13390 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) { 13391 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 13392 } 13393 13394 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) { 13395 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13396 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13397 13398 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 13399 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 13400 E->setType(S.Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType())); 13401 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13402 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13403 return E; 13404 } 13405 13406 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) { 13407 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(VD)) return VisitExpr(E); 13408 13409 E->setType(VD->getType()); 13410 13411 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13412 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 13413 !(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VD) && 13414 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isInstance())) 13415 E->setValueKind(VK_LValue); 13416 13417 return E; 13418 } 13419 13420 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 13421 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl()); 13422 } 13423 13424 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 13425 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl()); 13426 } 13427 }; 13428 } 13429 13430 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it 13431 /// to have a function type. 13432 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *FunctionExpr) { 13433 ExprResult Result = RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(S).Visit(FunctionExpr); 13434 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13435 return S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Result.get()); 13436 } 13437 13438 namespace { 13439 /// A visitor for rebuilding an expression of type __unknown_anytype 13440 /// into one which resolves the type directly on the referring 13441 /// expression. Strict preservation of the original source 13442 /// structure is not a goal. 13443 struct RebuildUnknownAnyExpr 13444 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyExpr, ExprResult> { 13445 13446 Sema &S; 13447 13448 /// The current destination type. 13449 QualType DestType; 13450 13451 RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, QualType CastType) 13452 : S(S), DestType(CastType) {} 13453 13454 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) { 13455 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!"); 13456 } 13457 13458 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) { 13459 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr) 13460 << E->getSourceRange(); 13461 return ExprError(); 13462 } 13463 13464 ExprResult VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E); 13465 ExprResult VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E); 13466 13467 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another 13468 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of. 13469 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) { 13470 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13471 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13472 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 13473 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 13474 E->setType(SubExpr->getType()); 13475 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind()); 13476 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13477 return E; 13478 } 13479 13480 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) { 13481 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 13482 } 13483 13484 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) { 13485 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 13486 } 13487 13488 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) { 13489 const PointerType *Ptr = DestType->getAs<PointerType>(); 13490 if (!Ptr) { 13491 S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof) 13492 << E->getSourceRange(); 13493 return ExprError(); 13494 } 13495 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13496 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13497 E->setType(DestType); 13498 13499 // Build the sub-expression as if it were an object of the pointee type. 13500 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 13501 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13502 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13503 E->setSubExpr(SubResult.get()); 13504 return E; 13505 } 13506 13507 ExprResult VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E); 13508 13509 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD); 13510 13511 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 13512 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl()); 13513 } 13514 13515 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 13516 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl()); 13517 } 13518 }; 13519 } 13520 13521 /// Rebuilds a call expression which yielded __unknown_anytype. 13522 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) { 13523 Expr *CalleeExpr = E->getCallee(); 13524 13525 enum FnKind { 13526 FK_MemberFunction, 13527 FK_FunctionPointer, 13528 FK_BlockPointer 13529 }; 13530 13531 FnKind Kind; 13532 QualType CalleeType = CalleeExpr->getType(); 13533 if (CalleeType == S.Context.BoundMemberTy) { 13534 assert(isa<CXXMemberCallExpr>(E) || isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)); 13535 Kind = FK_MemberFunction; 13536 CalleeType = Expr::findBoundMemberType(CalleeExpr); 13537 } else if (const PointerType *Ptr = CalleeType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 13538 CalleeType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 13539 Kind = FK_FunctionPointer; 13540 } else { 13541 CalleeType = CalleeType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 13542 Kind = FK_BlockPointer; 13543 } 13544 const FunctionType *FnType = CalleeType->castAs<FunctionType>(); 13545 13546 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a function. 13547 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) { 13548 unsigned diagID = diag::err_func_returning_array_function; 13549 if (Kind == FK_BlockPointer) 13550 diagID = diag::err_block_returning_array_function; 13551 13552 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diagID) 13553 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType; 13554 return ExprError(); 13555 } 13556 13557 // Otherwise, go ahead and set DestType as the call's result. 13558 E->setType(DestType.getNonLValueExprType(S.Context)); 13559 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType)); 13560 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13561 13562 // Rebuild the function type, replacing the result type with DestType. 13563 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FnType); 13564 if (Proto) { 13565 // __unknown_anytype(...) is a special case used by the debugger when 13566 // it has no idea what a function's signature is. 13567 // 13568 // We want to build this call essentially under the K&R 13569 // unprototyped rules, but making a FunctionNoProtoType in C++ 13570 // would foul up all sorts of assumptions. However, we cannot 13571 // simply pass all arguments as variadic arguments, nor can we 13572 // portably just call the function under a non-variadic type; see 13573 // the comment on IR-gen's TargetInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic. 13574 // However, it turns out that in practice it is generally safe to 13575 // call a function declared as "A foo(B,C,D);" under the prototype 13576 // "A foo(B,C,D,...);". The only known exception is with the 13577 // Windows ABI, where any variadic function is implicitly cdecl 13578 // regardless of its normal CC. Therefore we change the parameter 13579 // types to match the types of the arguments. 13580 // 13581 // This is a hack, but it is far superior to moving the 13582 // corresponding target-specific code from IR-gen to Sema/AST. 13583 13584 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes = Proto->getParamTypes(); 13585 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes; 13586 if (ParamTypes.empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { // the special case 13587 ArgTypes.reserve(E->getNumArgs()); 13588 for (unsigned i = 0, e = E->getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i) { 13589 Expr *Arg = E->getArg(i); 13590 QualType ArgType = Arg->getType(); 13591 if (E->isLValue()) { 13592 ArgType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArgType); 13593 } else if (E->isXValue()) { 13594 ArgType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(ArgType); 13595 } 13596 ArgTypes.push_back(ArgType); 13597 } 13598 ParamTypes = ArgTypes; 13599 } 13600 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionType(DestType, ParamTypes, 13601 Proto->getExtProtoInfo()); 13602 } else { 13603 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(DestType, 13604 FnType->getExtInfo()); 13605 } 13606 13607 // Rebuild the appropriate pointer-to-function type. 13608 switch (Kind) { 13609 case FK_MemberFunction: 13610 // Nothing to do. 13611 break; 13612 13613 case FK_FunctionPointer: 13614 DestType = S.Context.getPointerType(DestType); 13615 break; 13616 13617 case FK_BlockPointer: 13618 DestType = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(DestType); 13619 break; 13620 } 13621 13622 // Finally, we can recurse. 13623 ExprResult CalleeResult = Visit(CalleeExpr); 13624 if (!CalleeResult.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13625 E->setCallee(CalleeResult.get()); 13626 13627 // Bind a temporary if necessary. 13628 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 13629 } 13630 13631 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) { 13632 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a call. 13633 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) { 13634 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_func_returning_array_function) 13635 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType; 13636 return ExprError(); 13637 } 13638 13639 // Rewrite the method result type if available. 13640 if (ObjCMethodDecl *Method = E->getMethodDecl()) { 13641 assert(Method->getReturnType() == S.Context.UnknownAnyTy); 13642 Method->setReturnType(DestType); 13643 } 13644 13645 // Change the type of the message. 13646 E->setType(DestType.getNonReferenceType()); 13647 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType)); 13648 13649 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 13650 } 13651 13652 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 13653 // The only case we should ever see here is a function-to-pointer decay. 13654 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_FunctionToPointerDecay) { 13655 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13656 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13657 13658 E->setType(DestType); 13659 13660 // Rebuild the sub-expression as the pointee (function) type. 13661 DestType = DestType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 13662 13663 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13664 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13665 13666 E->setSubExpr(Result.get()); 13667 return E; 13668 } else if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) { 13669 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13670 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13671 13672 assert(isa<BlockPointerType>(E->getType())); 13673 13674 E->setType(DestType); 13675 13676 // The sub-expression has to be a lvalue reference, so rebuild it as such. 13677 DestType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DestType); 13678 13679 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13680 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13681 13682 E->setSubExpr(Result.get()); 13683 return E; 13684 } else { 13685 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled cast type!"); 13686 } 13687 } 13688 13689 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) { 13690 ExprValueKind ValueKind = VK_LValue; 13691 QualType Type = DestType; 13692 13693 // We know how to make this work for certain kinds of decls: 13694 13695 // - functions 13696 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)) { 13697 if (const PointerType *Ptr = Type->getAs<PointerType>()) { 13698 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 13699 ExprResult Result = resolveDecl(E, VD); 13700 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13701 return S.ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(), Type, 13702 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, VK_RValue); 13703 } 13704 13705 if (!Type->isFunctionType()) { 13706 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_function) 13707 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 13708 return ExprError(); 13709 } 13710 if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = Type->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 13711 // We must match the FunctionDecl's type to the hack introduced in 13712 // RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr to vararg functions of unknown 13713 // type. See the lengthy commentary in that routine. 13714 QualType FDT = FD->getType(); 13715 const FunctionType *FnType = FDT->castAs<FunctionType>(); 13716 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FnType); 13717 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 13718 if (DRE && Proto && Proto->getParamTypes().empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { 13719 SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation(); 13720 FunctionDecl *NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create(FD->getASTContext(), 13721 FD->getDeclContext(), 13722 Loc, Loc, FD->getNameInfo().getName(), 13723 DestType, FD->getTypeSourceInfo(), 13724 SC_None, false/*isInlineSpecified*/, 13725 FD->hasPrototype(), 13726 false/*isConstexprSpecified*/); 13727 13728 if (FD->getQualifier()) 13729 NewFD->setQualifierInfo(FD->getQualifierLoc()); 13730 13731 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 13732 for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) { 13733 ParmVarDecl *Param = 13734 S.BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(FD, Loc, AI); 13735 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 13736 Params.push_back(Param); 13737 } 13738 NewFD->setParams(Params); 13739 DRE->setDecl(NewFD); 13740 VD = DRE->getDecl(); 13741 } 13742 } 13743 13744 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 13745 if (MD->isInstance()) { 13746 ValueKind = VK_RValue; 13747 Type = S.Context.BoundMemberTy; 13748 } 13749 13750 // Function references aren't l-values in C. 13751 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13752 ValueKind = VK_RValue; 13753 13754 // - variables 13755 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(VD)) { 13756 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 13757 Type = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 13758 } else if (Type->isFunctionType()) { 13759 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_var_function_type) 13760 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 13761 return ExprError(); 13762 } 13763 13764 // - nothing else 13765 } else { 13766 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_decl) 13767 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 13768 return ExprError(); 13769 } 13770 13771 // Modifying the declaration like this is friendly to IR-gen but 13772 // also really dangerous. 13773 VD->setType(DestType); 13774 E->setType(Type); 13775 E->setValueKind(ValueKind); 13776 return E; 13777 } 13778 13779 /// Check a cast of an unknown-any type. We intentionally only 13780 /// trigger this for C-style casts. 13781 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange, QualType CastType, 13782 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &CastKind, 13783 ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path) { 13784 // Rewrite the casted expression from scratch. 13785 ExprResult result = RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, CastType).Visit(CastExpr); 13786 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13787 13788 CastExpr = result.get(); 13789 VK = CastExpr->getValueKind(); 13790 CastKind = CK_NoOp; 13791 13792 return CastExpr; 13793 } 13794 13795 ExprResult Sema::forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr *E, QualType ToType) { 13796 return RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, ToType).Visit(E); 13797 } 13798 13799 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc, 13800 Expr *arg, QualType ¶mType) { 13801 // If the syntactic form of the argument is not an explicit cast of 13802 // any sort, just do default argument promotion. 13803 ExplicitCastExpr *castArg = dyn_cast<ExplicitCastExpr>(arg->IgnoreParens()); 13804 if (!castArg) { 13805 ExprResult result = DefaultArgumentPromotion(arg); 13806 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13807 paramType = result.get()->getType(); 13808 return result; 13809 } 13810 13811 // Otherwise, use the type that was written in the explicit cast. 13812 assert(!arg->hasPlaceholderType()); 13813 paramType = castArg->getTypeAsWritten(); 13814 13815 // Copy-initialize a parameter of that type. 13816 InitializedEntity entity = 13817 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, paramType, 13818 /*consumed*/ false); 13819 return PerformCopyInitialization(entity, callLoc, arg); 13820 } 13821 13822 static ExprResult diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 13823 Expr *orig = E; 13824 unsigned diagID = diag::err_uncasted_use_of_unknown_any; 13825 while (true) { 13826 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 13827 if (CallExpr *call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) { 13828 E = call->getCallee(); 13829 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any; 13830 } else { 13831 break; 13832 } 13833 } 13834 13835 SourceLocation loc; 13836 NamedDecl *d; 13837 if (DeclRefExpr *ref = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 13838 loc = ref->getLocation(); 13839 d = ref->getDecl(); 13840 } else if (MemberExpr *mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 13841 loc = mem->getMemberLoc(); 13842 d = mem->getMemberDecl(); 13843 } else if (ObjCMessageExpr *msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) { 13844 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any; 13845 loc = msg->getSelectorStartLoc(); 13846 d = msg->getMethodDecl(); 13847 if (!d) { 13848 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_uncasted_send_to_unknown_any_method) 13849 << static_cast<unsigned>(msg->isClassMessage()) << msg->getSelector() 13850 << orig->getSourceRange(); 13851 return ExprError(); 13852 } 13853 } else { 13854 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr) 13855 << E->getSourceRange(); 13856 return ExprError(); 13857 } 13858 13859 S.Diag(loc, diagID) << d << orig->getSourceRange(); 13860 13861 // Never recoverable. 13862 return ExprError(); 13863 } 13864 13865 /// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found. 13866 /// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible. 13867 ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E) { 13868 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13869 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it 13870 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 13871 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 13872 ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(E); 13873 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13874 E = Result.get(); 13875 } 13876 13877 const BuiltinType *placeholderType = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType(); 13878 if (!placeholderType) return E; 13879 13880 switch (placeholderType->getKind()) { 13881 13882 // Overloaded expressions. 13883 case BuiltinType::Overload: { 13884 // Try to resolve a single function template specialization. 13885 // This is obligatory. 13886 ExprResult result = E; 13887 if (ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(result, false)) { 13888 return result; 13889 13890 // If that failed, try to recover with a call. 13891 } else { 13892 tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_unresolvable), 13893 /*complain*/ true); 13894 return result; 13895 } 13896 } 13897 13898 // Bound member functions. 13899 case BuiltinType::BoundMember: { 13900 ExprResult result = E; 13901 tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PDiag(diag::err_bound_member_function), 13902 /*complain*/ true); 13903 return result; 13904 } 13905 13906 // ARC unbridged casts. 13907 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: { 13908 Expr *realCast = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 13909 diagnoseARCUnbridgedCast(realCast); 13910 return realCast; 13911 } 13912 13913 // Expressions of unknown type. 13914 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny: 13915 return diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(*this, E); 13916 13917 // Pseudo-objects. 13918 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject: 13919 return checkPseudoObjectRValue(E); 13920 13921 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: { 13922 // Accept __noop without parens by implicitly converting it to a call expr. 13923 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 13924 if (DRE) { 13925 auto *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 13926 if (FD->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__noop) { 13927 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(FD->getType()), 13928 CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get(); 13929 return new (Context) CallExpr(Context, E, None, Context.IntTy, 13930 VK_RValue, SourceLocation()); 13931 } 13932 } 13933 13934 Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_builtin_fn_use); 13935 return ExprError(); 13936 } 13937 13938 // Everything else should be impossible. 13939 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) \ 13940 case BuiltinType::Id: 13941 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) 13942 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 13943 break; 13944 } 13945 13946 llvm_unreachable("invalid placeholder type!"); 13947 } 13948 13949 bool Sema::CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E) { 13950 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 13951 return true; 13952 if (E->isValueDependent() || E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) 13953 return E->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType(); 13954 return false; 13955 } 13956 13957 /// ActOnObjCBoolLiteral - Parse {__objc_yes,__objc_no} literals. 13958 ExprResult 13959 Sema::ActOnObjCBoolLiteral(SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind) { 13960 assert((Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes || Kind == tok::kw___objc_no) && 13961 "Unknown Objective-C Boolean value!"); 13962 QualType BoolT = Context.ObjCBuiltinBoolTy; 13963 if (!Context.getBOOLDecl()) { 13964 LookupResult Result(*this, &Context.Idents.get("BOOL"), OpLoc, 13965 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 13966 if (LookupName(Result, getCurScope()) && Result.isSingleResult()) { 13967 NamedDecl *ND = Result.getFoundDecl(); 13968 if (TypedefDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefDecl>(ND)) 13969 Context.setBOOLDecl(TD); 13970 } 13971 } 13972 if (Context.getBOOLDecl()) 13973 BoolT = Context.getBOOLType(); 13974 return new (Context) 13975 ObjCBoolLiteralExpr(Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes, BoolT, OpLoc); 13976 } 13977